]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/calc.texi
Merge from emacs--devo--0
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../../info/calc
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc 2.1 Manual
7 @setchapternewpage odd
8 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
9
10 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
11 @c @texline foo
12 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
13 @c @infoline foo
14 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
15
16 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
17 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
18
19 @iftex
20 @macro texline
21 @end macro
22 @alias infoline=comment
23 @alias expr=math
24 @alias tfn=code
25 @alias mathit=expr
26 @macro cpi{}
27 @math{@pi{}}
28 @end macro
29 @macro cpiover{den}
30 @math{@pi/\den\}
31 @end macro
32 @end iftex
33
34 @ifnottex
35 @alias texline=comment
36 @macro infoline{stuff}
37 \stuff\
38 @end macro
39 @alias expr=samp
40 @alias tfn=t
41 @alias mathit=i
42 @macro cpi{}
43 @expr{pi}
44 @end macro
45 @macro cpiover{den}
46 @expr{pi/\den\}
47 @end macro
48 @end ifnottex
49
50
51 @tex
52 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
53 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
54 @end tex
55
56 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
57 @iftex
58 @finalout
59 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
60 @tex
61 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
62
63 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
64 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
65 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
66 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
67 @end tex
68 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
69 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
70 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
71 @ignore
72 @newcount@calcpageno
73 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
74 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
75 @ifx@turnoffactive@undefinedzzz@def@turnoffactive{}@fi
76 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
77 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
78 \r@ggedbottomtrue
79 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
80 @end ignore
81 @end iftex
82
83 @copying
84 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
85
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
87 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
88
89 @quotation
90 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
91 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
92 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
93 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
94 Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
95 Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
96 entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
97
98 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
99 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
100 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
101 @end quotation
102 @end copying
103
104 @dircategory Emacs
105 @direntry
106 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
107 @end direntry
108
109 @titlepage
110 @sp 6
111 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
112 @sp 4
113 @center GNU Emacs Calc Version 2.1
114 @c [volume]
115 @sp 5
116 @center Dave Gillespie
117 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
118 @page
119
120 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
121 Copyright @copyright{} 1990, 1991, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004,
122 2005, 2006, 2007 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123 @insertcopying
124 @end titlepage
125
126
127 @summarycontents
128
129 @c [end]
130
131 @contents
132
133 @c [begin]
134 @ifnottex
135 @node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
136 @chapter The GNU Emacs Calculator
137
138 @noindent
139 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
140 written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
141
142 This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
143 three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
144 ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
145 Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
146 a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
147 @end ifnottex
148
149 @ifinfo
150 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
151 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
152 longer Info tutorial.)
153 @end ifinfo
154
155 @menu
156 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
157 @ifinfo
158 * Interactive Tutorial::
159 @end ifinfo
160 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
161
162 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
163 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
164 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
165 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
166 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
167 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
168 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
169 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
170 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
171 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
172 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
173 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
174 * Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
175 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
176 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
177
178 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
179 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
180 * Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
181 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
182
183 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
184
185 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
186 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
187 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
188 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
189 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
190 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
191 @end menu
192
193 @ifinfo
194 @node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
195 @end ifinfo
196 @ifnotinfo
197 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
198 @end ifnotinfo
199 @chapter Getting Started
200 @noindent
201 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
202 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
203 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
204
205 @menu
206 * What is Calc::
207 * About This Manual::
208 * Notations Used in This Manual::
209 * Demonstration of Calc::
210 * Using Calc::
211 * History and Acknowledgements::
212 @end menu
213
214 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
215 @section What is Calc?
216
217 @noindent
218 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
219 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
220 series of calculators, its many features include:
221
222 @itemize @bullet
223 @item
224 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
225
226 @item
227 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
228
229 @item
230 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
231 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
232 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
233 and algebraic formulas.
234
235 @item
236 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
237
238 @item
239 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
240
241 @item
242 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
243
244 @item
245 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
246 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
247
248 @item
249 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
250
251 @item
252 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
253
254 @item
255 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
256 inside any editing buffer.
257
258 @item
259 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
260
261 @item
262 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
263 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
264 @end itemize
265
266 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
267 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
268 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
269 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
270 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
271 the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
272 have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
273 but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
274
275 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
276 @section About This Manual
277
278 @noindent
279 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
280 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices, and as
281 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
282 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
283 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
284 regularly.
285
286 The manual is divided into three major parts:@: the ``Getting
287 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial (chapter 2),
288 and the Calc reference manual (the remaining chapters and appendices).
289 @c [when-split]
290 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
291 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
292 @c chapter.
293
294 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
295 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
296 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
297 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
298 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
299
300 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
301 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
302 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
303 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
304 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
305 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
306 to use its features.
307
308 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
309 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
310 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
311 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
312 need to know.
313
314 @cindex Marginal notes
315 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
316 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
317 variables also have their own indices.
318 @texline Each
319 @infoline In the printed manual, each
320 paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
321 in the margin with its index entry.
322
323 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
324 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by
325 pressing the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window,
326 you can press @kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. Also, you
327 can jump directly to the Tutorial by pressing @kbd{h t} or @kbd{C-x * t},
328 or to the Summary by pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s}. Within Calc,
329 you can also go to the part of the manual describing any Calc key,
330 function, or variable using @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v},
331 respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
332
333 @ifnottex
334 The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
335 should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
336 manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
337 program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
338 @file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
339 be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
340 To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
341 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
342 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
343 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
344 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
345 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
346 The result will be a device-independent output file called
347 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
348 for your system. On many systems, the command is
349
350 @example
351 lpr -d calc.dvi
352 @end example
353
354 @noindent
355 or
356
357 @example
358 dvips calc.dvi
359 @end example
360 @end ifnottex
361 @c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
362 @c Foundation.
363
364 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
365 @section Notations Used in This Manual
366
367 @noindent
368 This section describes the various notations that are used
369 throughout the Calc manual.
370
371 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
372 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
373 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
374 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
375 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
376 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
377 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
378 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
379 regularly using Emacs.
380
381 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
382 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
383 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
384 also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
385 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
386
387 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
388 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
389 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
390
391 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
392 or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
393 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
394 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
395
396 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
397 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
398 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
399 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
400 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
401
402 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
403 [@code{sincos}].
404
405 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
406 @section A Demonstration of Calc
407
408 @noindent
409 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
410 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
411 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
412 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
413 Tutorial.
414
415 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
416 does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
417 Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
418 @xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
419
420 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
421 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
422 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
423 Delete, and Space keys.
424
425 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
426 then the command to operate on the numbers.
427
428 @noindent
429 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
430 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
431 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
432
433 @noindent
434 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
435 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
436 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
437
438 @noindent
439 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
440
441 @noindent
442 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
443 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
444
445 @noindent
446 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
447
448 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
449 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
450 use the apostrophe key.
451
452 @noindent
453 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
454 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
455 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
456
457 @noindent
458 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
459 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
460 @infoline `pi' squared.
461 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
462
463 @noindent
464 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
465 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
466
467 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
468 @w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
469 the next section.)
470
471 @noindent
472 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
473 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
474
475 @noindent
476 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
477
478 @noindent
479 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
480
481 @noindent
482 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
483
484 @noindent
485 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
486 the Keypad Calculator off.
487
488 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
489 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
490 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
491 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
492 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
493 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
494 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
495
496 @example
497 @group
498 1.23 1.97
499 1.6 2
500 1.19 1.08
501 @end group
502 @end example
503
504 @noindent
505 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
506 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
507
508 @noindent
509 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
510 the product of the numbers.
511
512 @noindent
513 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
514 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
515 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
516
517 @noindent
518 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
519 @texline @math{3\times2}
520 @infoline 3x2
521 matrix into a
522 @texline @math{2\times3}
523 @infoline 2x3
524 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
525 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
526 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
527 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
528
529 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
530 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
531 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
532
533 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
534 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
535 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
536 many weeks have passed since then.
537
538 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
539 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
540 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
541 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
542 between @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
543 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
544
545 @noindent
546 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
547 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
548 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
549 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the La@TeX{} typesetting
550 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
551
552 @noindent
553 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
554 (That's a letter @kbd{l}, not a numeral @kbd{1}.)
555
556 @ifnotinfo
557 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
558 manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
559 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
560 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
561 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
562 @end ifnotinfo
563 @ifinfo
564 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
565 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
566 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
567 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
568 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
569 @end ifinfo
570
571 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
572 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
573
574 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgements, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
575 @section Using Calc
576
577 @noindent
578 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
579 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
580 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
581
582 @menu
583 * Starting Calc::
584 * The Standard Interface::
585 * Quick Mode Overview::
586 * Keypad Mode Overview::
587 * Standalone Operation::
588 * Embedded Mode Overview::
589 * Other C-x * Commands::
590 @end menu
591
592 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
593 @subsection Starting Calc
594
595 @noindent
596 On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
597 The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
598 which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
599
600 When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
601 complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
602 letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
603 which Calc interface you want to use.
604
605 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
606 Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
607 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
608 a complete list.
609
610 To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
611 same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
612 used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
613
614 If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
615 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
616 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
617 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
618 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
619
620 The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
621 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
622
623 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
624 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
625
626 @noindent
627 @cindex Standard user interface
628 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
629 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
630 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
631 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
632
633 @smallexample
634 @group
635
636 ...
637 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
638 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
639 2: 17.3 | 17.3
640 1: -5 | 3
641 . | 2
642 | 4
643 | * 8
644 | ->-5
645 |
646 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%%-Emacs: *Calc Trail*
647 @end group
648 @end smallexample
649
650 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
651 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
652 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
653 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
654 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
655 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
656 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
657 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
658 you do.
659
660 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
661 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
662 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
663 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
664 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
665
666 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
667 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
668 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
669
670 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
671 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
672 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
673 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
674 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
675 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
676 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
677
678 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
679 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
680 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
681 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
682 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
683 as Calc commands.
684
685 When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
686 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
687 hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
688 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
689 Calculator.
690
691 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
692 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
693 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
694 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
695 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
696 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
697 always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
698
699 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
700
701 If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
702 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
703 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
704 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
705 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
706 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
707 normal partial-screen mode.
708
709 Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
710 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
711 editing before remains selected instead. @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
712 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; type
713 @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
714
715 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
716 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
717
718 @noindent
719 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
720 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
721 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
722
723 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
724 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
725 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
726 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
727 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
728 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
729 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
730 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
731
732 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
733 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
734
735 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
736 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
737
738 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
739 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
740
741 @noindent
742 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
743 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
744 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
745 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
746
747 Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
748 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
749 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
750 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
751
752 @tex
753 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
754 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
755 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
756 \medskip
757 @end tex
758 @smallexample
759 @group
760 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
761 |2: 17.3
762 |1: -5
763 | .
764 |--%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
765 |----+-----Calc 2.1------+----1
766 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
767 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
768 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
769 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
770 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
771 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
772 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
773 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
774 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
775 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
776 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
777 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
778 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
779 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
780 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
781 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
782 @end group
783 @end smallexample
784
785 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
786 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
787 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
788 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
789 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
790 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
791
792 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
793 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
794 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
795 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
796 the stack).
797
798 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
799 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
800 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
801 numbers.
802
803 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
804 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
805 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
806 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
807 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
808
809 If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
810 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
811 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
812
813 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
814 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
815
816 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
817 @subsection Standalone Operation
818
819 @noindent
820 @cindex Standalone Operation
821 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
822 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
823 can give the commands:
824
825 @example
826 emacs -f full-calc
827 @end example
828
829 @noindent
830 or
831
832 @example
833 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
834 @end example
835
836 @noindent
837 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
838 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
839 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
840 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
841 itself.
842
843 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
844 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
845
846 @noindent
847 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
848 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
849 document like this:
850
851 @smallexample
852 @group
853 The derivative of
854
855 ln(ln(x))
856
857 is
858 @end group
859 @end smallexample
860
861 @noindent
862 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
863 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
864 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
865 you want the result to be:
866
867 @smallexample
868 @group
869 The derivative of
870
871 ln(ln(x))
872
873 is
874
875 ln(ln(x))
876 @end group
877 @end smallexample
878
879 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
880 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to
881 tell how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly)
882 onto the Calc stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the
883 editing buffer, but the buffer's mode line will change to look
884 like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like @samp{12 Deg}
885 and so on). Even though you are still in your editing buffer,
886 the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
887 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take
888 the derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
889
890 @smallexample
891 @group
892 The derivative of
893
894 ln(ln(x))
895
896 is
897
898 1 / ln(x) x
899 @end group
900 @end smallexample
901
902 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
903 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
904
905 @smallexample
906 @group
907 The derivative of
908
909 ln(ln(x))
910
911 is
912 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
913 % [calc-mode: language: big]
914
915 1
916 -------
917 ln(x) x
918 @end group
919 @end smallexample
920
921 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
922 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
923 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
924 La@TeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
925 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
926 out of the way.)
927
928 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
929 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
930
931 @smallexample
932 @group
933 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
934 % [calc-mode: language: big]
935 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
936
937 1
938 ------- (1)
939 ln(x) x
940 @end group
941 @end smallexample
942
943 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
944 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
945
946 The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
947 generally means a single number, inside text. It uses any
948 non-numeric characters rather than blank lines to delimit the
949 formula it reads. Here's an example of its use:
950
951 @smallexample
952 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
953 @end smallexample
954
955 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
956 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
957 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
958 then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
959
960 @smallexample
961 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
962 @end smallexample
963
964 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
965 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
966
967 @node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
968 @subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
969
970 @noindent
971 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
972 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
973 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
974 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
975 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
976
977 The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
978 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
979 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
980 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
981 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
982 @kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
983 formula.
984
985 The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
986 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
987 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
988
989 Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
990 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
991 If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
992 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
993 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
994 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
995 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
996 is something on the Calc stack.
997
998 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
999 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1000 following @kbd{C-x *}.
1001
1002 @noindent
1003 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1004
1005 @table @kbd
1006 @item *
1007 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1008
1009 @item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1010 Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1011
1012 @item C
1013 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1014 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1015 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1016
1017 @item O
1018 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1019 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1020 move it out of that window.
1021
1022 @item B
1023 Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1024
1025 @item Q
1026 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1027
1028 @item K
1029 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1030
1031 @item E
1032 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1033
1034 @item J
1035 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1036
1037 @item W
1038 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1039
1040 @item Z
1041 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1042
1043 @item X
1044 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1045 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1046 @end table
1047 @iftex
1048 @sp 2
1049 @end iftex
1050
1051 @noindent
1052 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1053
1054 @table @kbd
1055 @item G
1056 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1057
1058 @item R
1059 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1060
1061 @item :
1062 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1063
1064 @item _
1065 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1066
1067 @item Y
1068 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1069 @end table
1070 @iftex
1071 @sp 2
1072 @end iftex
1073
1074 @noindent
1075 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1076
1077 @table @kbd
1078 @item A
1079 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1080 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1081 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1082
1083 @item D
1084 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1085 the duplicate.
1086
1087 @item F
1088 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1089
1090 @item N
1091 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1092
1093 @item P
1094 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1095
1096 @item U
1097 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1098
1099 @item `
1100 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1101 @end table
1102 @iftex
1103 @sp 2
1104 @end iftex
1105
1106 @noindent
1107 Miscellaneous commands:
1108
1109 @table @kbd
1110 @item I
1111 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1112 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1113
1114 @item T
1115 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1116
1117 @item S
1118 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1119
1120 @item L
1121 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1122 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1123
1124 @item M
1125 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1126 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1127
1128 @item 0
1129 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1130 its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1131 @end table
1132
1133 @node History and Acknowledgements, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1134 @section History and Acknowledgements
1135
1136 @noindent
1137 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1138 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1139 the value of
1140 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1141 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1142 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1143 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1144 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1145 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1146 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1147 all.
1148
1149 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1150 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1151 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1152 got too far out of hand.
1153
1154 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1155 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1156 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1157
1158 Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
1159 this had to be
1160 simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers will only comfortably
1161 fit six decimal digits or so---not enough for a decent calculator. So
1162 I had to write my own high-precision integer code as well, and once I had
1163 this I figured that arbitrary-size integers were just as easy as large
1164 integers. Arbitrary floating-point precision was the logical next step.
1165 Also, since the large integer arithmetic was there anyway it seemed only
1166 fair to give the user direct access to it, which in turn made it practical
1167 to support fractions as well as floats. All these features inspired me
1168 to look around for other data types that might be worth having.
1169
1170 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1171 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1172 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1173 decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1174 things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1175 serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1176 far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1177 rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1178 implement what they needed for themselves.
1179
1180 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1181 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1182 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1183
1184 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1185 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1186 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1187
1188 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1189 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1190 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1191 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1192 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1193 algebra system for microcomputers.
1194
1195 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1196 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1197 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1198 rules, and many other algebra features;
1199 @texline Fran\c{c}ois
1200 @infoline Francois
1201 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1202 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1203 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1204 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1205 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1206 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1207 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
1208 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1209 parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1210 Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1211 well as many other things.
1212
1213 @cindex Bibliography
1214 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1215 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1216 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1217 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1218 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1219 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1220 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1221 for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1222 Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1223 @emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1224 Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1225 Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1226 the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1227 Dan LaLiberte.
1228
1229 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1230 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1231 finished in two weeks.
1232
1233 @c [tutorial]
1234
1235 @ifinfo
1236 @c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1237 @node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1238 @chapter Tutorial
1239
1240 @noindent
1241 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1242
1243 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1244 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1245 for this).
1246
1247 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1248 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1249 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1250 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1251
1252 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1253 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1254 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1255 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1256 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1257
1258 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1259
1260 Press @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1261
1262 @menu
1263 * Tutorial::
1264 @end menu
1265
1266 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1267 @end ifinfo
1268 @ifnotinfo
1269 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1270 @end ifnotinfo
1271 @chapter Tutorial
1272
1273 @noindent
1274 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1275 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1276 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1277 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1278 @c [not-split]
1279 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1280 @c [when-split]
1281 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1282
1283 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1284 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1285 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1286 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1287 the Embedded mode interface.
1288
1289 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1290 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. (If you
1291 have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead.) Press
1292 @kbd{C-x * c} to turn Calc on or to switch into the Calc window, and
1293 press @kbd{C-x * i} to start the Info system or to switch into its window.
1294
1295 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1296 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1297 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1298 general areas.
1299
1300 @ifnottex
1301 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1302 it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1303 printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1304 @end ifnottex
1305 @iftex
1306 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1307 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1308 Calc.
1309 @end iftex
1310
1311 @menu
1312 * Basic Tutorial::
1313 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1314 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1315 * Types Tutorial::
1316 * Algebra Tutorial::
1317 * Programming Tutorial::
1318
1319 * Answers to Exercises::
1320 @end menu
1321
1322 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1323 @section Basic Tutorial
1324
1325 @noindent
1326 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1327 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1328 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1329
1330 @menu
1331 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1332 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1333 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1334 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1335 @end menu
1336
1337 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1338 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1339
1340 @cindex RPN notation
1341 @ifnottex
1342 @noindent
1343 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1344 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1345 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1346 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1347 @end ifnottex
1348 @tex
1349 \noindent
1350 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1351 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1352 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1353 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1354 @end tex
1355
1356 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1357 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1358 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1359 from the top of the stack.
1360
1361 @cindex Operators
1362 @cindex Operands
1363 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1364 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1365 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1366 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1367 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1368 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1369
1370 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1371 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1372 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1373 you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1374 @kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1375 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1376 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1377 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1378 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1379
1380 @smallexample
1381 @group
1382 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1383 . 1: 3 .
1384 .
1385
1386 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1387 @end group
1388 @end smallexample
1389
1390 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1391 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1392 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1393 less distracting in regular use.
1394
1395 @cindex Stack levels
1396 @cindex Levels of stack
1397 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1398 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1399 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1400 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1401 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1402 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1403 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1404
1405 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1406 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1407 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1408 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1409 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1410 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1411 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1412 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1413 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1414 if you are interested.
1415
1416 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1417 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1418 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1419 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1420 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1421
1422 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1423 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1424
1425 @smallexample
1426 @group
1427 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1428 . 1: 3 .
1429 .
1430
1431 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1432 @end group
1433 @end smallexample
1434
1435 @noindent
1436 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1437 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1438 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1439
1440 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1441 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1442 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1443 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1444 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1445 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1446 return to where you were.)
1447
1448 @noindent
1449 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1450 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1451 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1452 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1453
1454 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1455 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.4) + {5\over4}}
1456 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1457 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1458
1459 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1460 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1461 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1462 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1463 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1464 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1465 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1466 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1467 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1468
1469 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1470 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1471 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1472
1473 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1474 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1475 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1476 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1477 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1478
1479 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1480 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1481 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1482
1483 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1484 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1485 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1486
1487 @smallexample
1488 @group
1489 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1490 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1491 . .
1492
1493 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1494 @end group
1495 @end smallexample
1496
1497 @noindent
1498 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1499 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1500
1501 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1502 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1503 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1504
1505 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1506 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1507 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1508 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1509 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1510
1511 @smallexample
1512 @group
1513 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1514 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1515 . .
1516
1517 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1518 @end group
1519 @end smallexample
1520
1521 @noindent
1522 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1523
1524 @smallexample
1525 @group
1526 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1527 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1528 . 1: 3 .
1529 .
1530
1531 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1532 @end group
1533 @end smallexample
1534
1535 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1536 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1537 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1538
1539 @smallexample
1540 @group
1541 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1542 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1543 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1544 . . .
1545
1546 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1547 @end group
1548 @end smallexample
1549
1550 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1551 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1552 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1553 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1554
1555 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1556 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1557 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1558 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1559
1560 @smallexample
1561 @group
1562 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1563 . . 1: 16 . .
1564 .
1565
1566 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1567 @end group
1568 @end smallexample
1569
1570 @noindent
1571 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1572 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1573
1574 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1575 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1576 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1577 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1578 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1579
1580 @smallexample
1581 @group
1582 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1583 . 1: 4 .
1584 .
1585
1586 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1587 @end group
1588 @end smallexample
1589
1590 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1591 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1592 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1593 prefix for you:
1594
1595 @smallexample
1596 @group
1597 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1598 . 1: 4 .
1599 .
1600
1601 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1602 @end group
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1606
1607 @smallexample
1608 @group
1609 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1610 . . .
1611
1612 4 @key{RET} n Q
1613 @end group
1614 @end smallexample
1615
1616 @noindent
1617 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1618 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1619 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1620 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1621
1622 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1623 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1624 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1625 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1626 complex result.)
1627
1628 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1629 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1630
1631 @smallexample
1632 @group
1633 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1634 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1635 . .
1636
1637 ( 2 , 3 )
1638 @end group
1639 @end smallexample
1640
1641 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1642 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1643
1644 @smallexample
1645 @group
1646 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1647 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1648 . 1: 3 . .
1649 .
1650 (error)
1651 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1652 @end group
1653 @end smallexample
1654
1655 @noindent
1656 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1657 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1658
1659 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1660 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1661
1662 @smallexample
1663 @group
1664 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1665 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1666 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1667 . . .
1668
1669 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1670 @end group
1671 @end smallexample
1672
1673 @noindent
1674 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1675 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1676 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1677 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1678
1679 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1680 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1681 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1682 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1683 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1684
1685 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1686 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1687 the tutorial.
1688
1689 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1690 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1691 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1692 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1693 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1694 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1695 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1696
1697 @smallexample
1698 @group
1699 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1700 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1701 . 1: 30 1: 30
1702 . .
1703
1704 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1705 @end group
1706 @end smallexample
1707
1708 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1709 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1710 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1711 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1712 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1713
1714 @smallexample
1715 @group
1716 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1717 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1718 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1719 . . 1: 20
1720 .
1721
1722 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1723 @end group
1724 @end smallexample
1725
1726 @cindex Clearing the stack
1727 @cindex Emptying the stack
1728 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1729 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1730 entire stack.)
1731
1732 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1733 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1734
1735 @noindent
1736 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1737 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1738 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1739 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1740
1741 @strong{Warning:} Note that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
1742 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}. See
1743 below for details.
1744
1745 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1746 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1747 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1748 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1749 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1750 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1751 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1752
1753 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1754 The result should be the number 9.
1755
1756 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1757 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1758 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1759 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1760 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1761
1762 @example
1763 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1764 @end example
1765
1766 @noindent
1767 is equivalent to
1768
1769 @example
1770 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1771 @end example
1772
1773 @noindent
1774 or, in large mathematical notation,
1775
1776 @ifnottex
1777 @example
1778 @group
1779 3 * 4 * 5
1780 2 + --------- - 9
1781 8
1782 6 * 7
1783 @end group
1784 @end example
1785 @end ifnottex
1786 @tex
1787 \turnoffactive
1788 \beforedisplay
1789 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1790 \afterdisplay
1791 @end tex
1792
1793 @noindent
1794 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1795
1796 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1797 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1798 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1799 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1800
1801 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1802 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1803 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1804 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1805
1806 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1807 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1808 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1809 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1810 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1811
1812 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1813
1814 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1815 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1816 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1817 an algebraic entry.
1818
1819 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1820 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1821 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1822 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1823 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1824
1825 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1826 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1827
1828 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1829 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1830 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1831 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1832 rule to use!
1833
1834 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1835 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1836 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1837
1838 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1839
1840 @smallexample
1841 @group
1842 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1843 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1844 . .
1845
1846 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1847 @end group
1848 @end smallexample
1849
1850 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1851 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1852 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1853
1854 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1855 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1856 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1857 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1858 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1859 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1860 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1861
1862 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1863
1864 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1865 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1866 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1867 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1868 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1869 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1870 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1871 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1872 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1873 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1874 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1875 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1876 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1877
1878 @smallexample
1879 @group
1880 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1881 . . .
1882
1883 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1884 @end group
1885 @end smallexample
1886
1887 @noindent
1888 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1889 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1890
1891 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1892 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1893 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1894 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1895
1896 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1897 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1898
1899 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1900 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1901 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1902 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1903 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1904 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1905 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1906
1907 @smallexample
1908 @group
1909 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1910 . . .
1911
1912 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1913 @end group
1914 @end smallexample
1915
1916 @noindent
1917 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1918 variables by the values that were stored in them.
1919
1920 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1921 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1922 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1923
1924 @smallexample
1925 @group
1926 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1927 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1928 . 1: 2 .
1929 .
1930
1931 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1932 @end group
1933 @end smallexample
1934
1935 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1936 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1937 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1938 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1939 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1940 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1941
1942 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1943 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1944
1945 @smallexample
1946 @group
1947 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 34 + 2 b
1948 . .
1949
1950 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1951 @end group
1952 @end smallexample
1953
1954 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1955 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1956
1957 @smallexample
1958 @group
1959 1: 2 + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3)
1960 .
1961
1962 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1963 @end group
1964 @end smallexample
1965
1966 @noindent
1967 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1968 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1969 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1970 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1971 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1972 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1973 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1974 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1975 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1976 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1977 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
1978 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
1979 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
1980 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
1981
1982 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
1983 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
1984 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
1985 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
1986 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1987
1988 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
1989 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
1990 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1991
1992 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
1993 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
1994 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
1995 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
1996 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
1997 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
1998 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
1999 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2000
2001 @smallexample
2002 @group
2003 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2004 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2005 . .
2006
2007 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2008 @end group
2009 @end smallexample
2010
2011 @noindent
2012 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2013 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2014 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2015 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2016 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2017
2018 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2019
2020 @smallexample
2021 @group
2022 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2023 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2024 .
2025
2026 s u a @key{RET}
2027 @end group
2028 @end smallexample
2029
2030 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2031 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2032
2033 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2034 @subsection Undo and Redo
2035
2036 @noindent
2037 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2038 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2039 and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2040 with a clean slate. Now:
2041
2042 @smallexample
2043 @group
2044 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2045 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2046 . .
2047
2048 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2049 @end group
2050 @end smallexample
2051
2052 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2053 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2054 above example, you could type:
2055
2056 @smallexample
2057 @group
2058 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2059 . 1: 3 .
2060 .
2061 (error)
2062 U U U U
2063 @end group
2064 @end smallexample
2065
2066 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2067 mistakenly.
2068
2069 @smallexample
2070 @group
2071 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2072 . 1: 3 . .
2073 .
2074 (error)
2075 D D D D
2076 @end group
2077 @end smallexample
2078
2079 @noindent
2080 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2081 by something other than an undo command.
2082
2083 @cindex Time travel
2084 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2085 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2086 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2087 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2088 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2089 was an earlier undo command.
2090
2091 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2092 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2093 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2094 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2095
2096 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2097 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2098 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2099 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2100 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2101 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2102 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2103 stack.
2104
2105 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2106 went into the trail.
2107
2108 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2109 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2110 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2111 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2112 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2113 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2114 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2115 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2116
2117 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2118 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2119 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2120 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2121 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2122
2123 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2124 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2125 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2126 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2127 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2128 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2129 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2130 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2131 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2132 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2133 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2134
2135 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2136
2137 @smallexample
2138 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2139 @end smallexample
2140
2141 @noindent
2142 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2143 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2144 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2145 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2146 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2147 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2148 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2149
2150 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2151 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2152 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2153 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2154 the prefix.
2155
2156 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2157 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2158 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2159 to edit a stack entry.
2160
2161 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2162 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2163 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2164 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2165 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2166 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2167 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2168 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2169
2170 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2171 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2172
2173 @noindent
2174 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2175 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2176 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2177 try some of the most common ones here.
2178
2179 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2180 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2181
2182 @smallexample
2183 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2184 @end smallexample
2185
2186 @noindent
2187 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2188 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2189 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2190 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2191 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2192 leading and trailing zeros.
2193
2194 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2195 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2196 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2197
2198 @smallexample
2199 @group
2200 1: 0.142857142857
2201 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2202 .
2203 @end group
2204 @end smallexample
2205
2206 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2207 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2208 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2209 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2210
2211 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2212 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2213
2214 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2215 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2216 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2217 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2218 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2219 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2220 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2221
2222 @smallexample
2223 @group
2224 1: 0.142857142857
2225 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2226 3: 1.14285714286
2227 .
2228 @end group
2229 @end smallexample
2230
2231 @noindent
2232 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2233 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2234
2235 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2236 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2237 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2238 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2239 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2240 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2241 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2242 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2243 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2244 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2245 arithmetic.
2246
2247 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2248 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2249 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2250
2251 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2252
2253 @smallexample
2254 @group
2255 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2256 . 1: 10000 .
2257 .
2258
2259 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2260 @end group
2261 @end smallexample
2262
2263 @noindent
2264 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2265 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2266 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2267 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2268 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2269
2270 @smallexample
2271 @group
2272 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2273 . 1: 10000. .
2274 .
2275
2276 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2277 @end group
2278 @end smallexample
2279
2280 @cindex Round-off errors
2281 @noindent
2282 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2283 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2284 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2285 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2286 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2287 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2288 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2289 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2290 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2291 out:
2292
2293 @smallexample
2294 @group
2295 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2296 . 1: 10000. .
2297 .
2298
2299 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2300 @end group
2301 @end smallexample
2302
2303 @noindent
2304 @cindex Guard digits
2305 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2306 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2307 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2308 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2309 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2310 last place.
2311
2312 @cindex Guard digits
2313 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2314 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2315 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2316 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2317 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2318 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2319 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2320
2321 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2322 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2323 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2324 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2325 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2326 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2327 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2328 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2329 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2330 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2331 numbers shown here:
2332
2333 @smallexample
2334 @group
2335 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2336 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2337 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2338 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2339 . . . . .
2340
2341 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2342 @end group
2343 @end smallexample
2344
2345 @noindent
2346 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2347 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2348 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2349 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2350 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2351 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2352
2353 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2354 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2355 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2356 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2357
2358 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2359 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2360 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2361 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2362 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2363
2364 @smallexample
2365 @group
2366 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2367 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2368 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2369 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2370 . . . . .
2371
2372 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2373 @end group
2374 @end smallexample
2375
2376 @noindent
2377 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2378 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2379 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2380 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2381 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2382 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2383 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2384
2385 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2386 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2387 displayed exactly.
2388
2389 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2390 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2391 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2392
2393 @example
2394 2417851639229258349412352
2395 @end example
2396
2397 @noindent
2398 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2399
2400 @example
2401 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2402 @end example
2403
2404 @noindent
2405 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2406 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2407 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2408
2409 @example
2410 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2411 @end example
2412
2413 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2414 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2415 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2416
2417 @example
2418 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2419 @end example
2420
2421 @noindent
2422 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2423 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2424
2425 @example
2426 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2427 @end example
2428
2429 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2430 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2431
2432 @example
2433 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2434 @end example
2435
2436 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2437 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2438 restore the default precision.
2439
2440 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2441 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2442 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2443 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2444
2445 @example
2446 16#200000000000000000000
2447 @end example
2448
2449 @noindent
2450 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2451 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2452 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2453 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2454 form:
2455
2456 @example
2457 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2458 @end example
2459
2460 @noindent
2461 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2462 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2463 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2464 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2465 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2466 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2467
2468 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2469 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2470 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2471 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2472 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2473
2474 @example
2475 2#101,1111,1110
2476 @end example
2477
2478 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2479 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2480 other radix.
2481
2482 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2483
2484 @example
2485 1,534
2486 @end example
2487
2488 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2489 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2490 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2491 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2492
2493 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2494 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2495 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2496 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2497 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2498 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2499 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2500 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2501 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2502
2503 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2504 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2505 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2506 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2507 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2508 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2509 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2510 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2511
2512 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2513 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2514 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2515 the way they are actually computed.
2516
2517 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2518 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2519 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2520 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2521
2522 @smallexample
2523 @group
2524 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2525 . . . .
2526
2527 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2528 @end group
2529 @end smallexample
2530
2531 @noindent
2532 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2533 of 45 degrees is
2534 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2535 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2536 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2537 roundoff error because the representation of
2538 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2539 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2540 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2541 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2542 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2543
2544 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2545 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2546 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2547 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2548 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2549
2550 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2551 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2552 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2553 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2554 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2555
2556 @smallexample
2557 @group
2558 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2559 . . .
2560
2561 P 4 / m r S
2562 @end group
2563 @end smallexample
2564
2565 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2566 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 @group
2570 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2571 . . .
2572
2573 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2574 @end group
2575 @end smallexample
2576
2577 @noindent
2578 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2579 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2580 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2581 first in radians, then in degrees.
2582
2583 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2584 and vice-versa.
2585
2586 @smallexample
2587 @group
2588 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2589 . . .
2590
2591 45 c r c d
2592 @end group
2593 @end smallexample
2594
2595 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2596 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2597 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2598 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2599 number, instead.
2600
2601 @smallexample
2602 @group
2603 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2604 1: 9 . .
2605 .
2606
2607 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2608 @end group
2609 @end smallexample
2610
2611 @noindent
2612 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2613 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2614
2615 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2616 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2617 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2618 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2619 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2620 what to do when dividing two integers.
2621
2622 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2623 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2624 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2625 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2626 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2627
2628 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2629 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2630 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2631 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2632 recompute for you.
2633
2634 @smallexample
2635 @group
2636 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2637 . . .
2638
2639 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2640 @end group
2641 @end smallexample
2642
2643 @noindent
2644 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2645 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2646 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2647 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2648 might affect their values.
2649
2650 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2651 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2652
2653 @noindent
2654 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2655 available in the Calculator.
2656
2657 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2658 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2659 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2660 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2661
2662 @smallexample
2663 @group
2664 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2665 . . . . .
2666
2667 5 & & n n
2668 @end group
2669 @end smallexample
2670
2671 @cindex Binary operators
2672 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2673 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2674 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2675 a negative prefix.
2676
2677 @smallexample
2678 @group
2679 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2680 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2681 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2682 . . 1: 10 .
2683 .
2684
2685 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2686 @end group
2687 @end smallexample
2688
2689 @cindex Unary operators
2690 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2691 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2692
2693 @smallexample
2694 @group
2695 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2696 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2697 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2698 . . .
2699
2700 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2701 @end group
2702 @end smallexample
2703
2704 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2705 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2706 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2707 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2708 integer.
2709
2710 @smallexample
2711 @group
2712 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2713 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2714 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2715 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2716 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2717 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2718 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2719 . . .
2720
2721 M-7 F U M-7 R
2722 @end group
2723 @end smallexample
2724
2725 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2726 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2727 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2728 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2729 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2730
2731 @smallexample
2732 @group
2733 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2734 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2735 . .
2736
2737 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2738 @end group
2739 @end smallexample
2740
2741 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2742
2743 @smallexample
2744 @group
2745 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2746 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2747 . .
2748
2749 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2750 @end group
2751 @end smallexample
2752
2753 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2754 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2755 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2756 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2757 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2758
2759 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2760 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2761 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2762 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2763 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2764
2765 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2766 identity
2767 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2768 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2769 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2770 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2771
2772 @smallexample
2773 @group
2774 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2775 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2776 . . . .
2777
2778 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2779 @end group
2780 @end smallexample
2781
2782 @noindent
2783 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2784 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2785
2786 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2787 of squares, command.
2788
2789 Another identity is
2790 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2791 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2792 @smallexample
2793 @group
2794
2795 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2796 1: 0.43837 . .
2797 .
2798
2799 U / I T
2800 @end group
2801 @end smallexample
2802
2803 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2804 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2805 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2806 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2807
2808 @smallexample
2809 @group
2810 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2811 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2812 . .
2813
2814 U U M-2 n / I T
2815 @end group
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 @noindent
2819 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2820 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2821 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2822 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2823 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2824 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2825 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2826
2827 @smallexample
2828 @group
2829 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
2830 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2831 . 1: 0.43837 .
2832 .
2833
2834 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2835 @end group
2836 @end smallexample
2837
2838 @noindent
2839 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2840 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2841
2842 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2843 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2844 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2845 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2846 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2847 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2848 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2849 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2850
2851 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2852 except that it is the @emph{difference}
2853 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2854 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2855 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2856
2857 @smallexample
2858 @group
2859 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
2860 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2861 . . . . .
2862
2863 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2864 @end group
2865 @end smallexample
2866
2867 @noindent
2868 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2869 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2870 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2871 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2872 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2873 error.
2874
2875 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2876 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2877 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
2878 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2879
2880 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2881 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2882
2883 @cindex Common logarithm
2884 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2885 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2886 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2887 prefix.
2888
2889 @smallexample
2890 @group
2891 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2892 . . . .
2893
2894 1000 L U H L
2895 @end group
2896 @end smallexample
2897
2898 @noindent
2899 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2900 and compute a common logarithm instead.
2901
2902 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2903 value of @var{b}.
2904
2905 @smallexample
2906 @group
2907 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
2908 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2909 . .
2910
2911 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2912 @end group
2913 @end smallexample
2914
2915 @noindent
2916 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2917 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
2918 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2919 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2920 onto the stack.
2921
2922 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2923 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2924 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2925 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2926 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2927 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2928 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2929 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2930 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2931 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2932
2933 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2934 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2935 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2936
2937 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2938 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2939 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2940
2941 @smallexample
2942 @group
2943 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2944 . . . .
2945
2946 100 ! U c f !
2947 @end group
2948 @end smallexample
2949
2950 @noindent
2951 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2952 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2953 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2954 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2955 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2956 in this case).
2957
2958 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2959 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2960 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2961 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2962 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2963
2964 @smallexample
2965 @group
2966 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
2967 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
2968 1: 5. 1: 120.
2969 . .
2970
2971 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2972 @end group
2973 @end smallexample
2974
2975 @noindent
2976 Here we verify the identity
2977 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
2978 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
2979
2980 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
2981 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
2982 is defined by
2983 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
2984 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
2985 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
2986 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
2987 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
2988 large intermediate values.
2989
2990 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
2991 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
2992 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
2993
2994 @smallexample
2995 @group
2996 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
2997 1: 20 . .
2998 .
2999
3000 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3001 @end group
3002 @end smallexample
3003
3004 @noindent
3005 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{v u} to ``unpack''
3006 this vector into 8 separate stack entries, then @kbd{M-8 *} to
3007 multiply them back together. The result is the original number,
3008 30045015.
3009
3010 @cindex Hash tables
3011 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3012 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3013 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3014
3015 @smallexample
3016 @group
3017 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3018 . . .
3019
3020 10000 k n I k n
3021 @end group
3022 @end smallexample
3023
3024 @noindent
3025 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3026 10000.
3027
3028 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3029 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3030 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3031 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3032
3033 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3034 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3035 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3036
3037 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3038 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3039
3040 @noindent
3041 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3042 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3043 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3044 a vector as a list of objects.
3045
3046 @menu
3047 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3048 * Matrix Tutorial::
3049 * List Tutorial::
3050 @end menu
3051
3052 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3053 @subsection Vector Analysis
3054
3055 @noindent
3056 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3057 elements, taken pairwise.
3058
3059 @smallexample
3060 @group
3061 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3062 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3063 .
3064
3065 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3066 @end group
3067 @end smallexample
3068
3069 @noindent
3070 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3071 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3072 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3073 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3074
3075 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3076 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3077 of the vectors.
3078
3079 @smallexample
3080 @group
3081 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3082 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3083 .
3084
3085 r 1 r 2 *
3086 @end group
3087 @end smallexample
3088
3089 @cindex Dot product
3090 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3091 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3092 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3093 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3094 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3095 vector.
3096
3097 @smallexample
3098 @group
3099 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3100 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3101 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3102 . .
3103
3104 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3105 @end group
3106 @end smallexample
3107
3108 @noindent
3109 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3110 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3111 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3112 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3113 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3114 is about 56 degrees.
3115
3116 @cindex Cross product
3117 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3118 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3119 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3120 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3121 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3122 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3123 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3124
3125 @smallexample
3126 @group
3127 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3128 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3129 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3130 .
3131
3132 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3133 @end group
3134 @end smallexample
3135
3136 @noindent
3137 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3138 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3139 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3140 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3141
3142 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3143 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3144 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3145 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3146 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3147 prefix keys have this property.)
3148
3149 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3150 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3151 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3152
3153 @smallexample
3154 @group
3155 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3156 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3157 . .
3158
3159 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3160 @end group
3161 @end smallexample
3162
3163 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3164 @cindex Unit vectors
3165 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3166 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3167 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3168 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3169
3170 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3171 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3172 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3173 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3174 Find the average position of the particle.
3175 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3176
3177 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3178 @subsection Matrices
3179
3180 @noindent
3181 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3182 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3183 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3184 both methods here:
3185
3186 @smallexample
3187 @group
3188 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3189 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3190 . .
3191
3192 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3193 @end group
3194 @end smallexample
3195
3196 @noindent
3197 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3198
3199 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3200 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3201 the second example.
3202
3203 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3204 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3205 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3206 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3207 of the right matrix.
3208
3209 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3210 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3211
3212 @smallexample
3213 @group
3214 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3215 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3216 .
3217
3218 @key{RET} *
3219 @end group
3220 @end smallexample
3221
3222 @noindent
3223 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3224 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3225 been left in symbolic form.
3226
3227 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3228
3229 @smallexample
3230 @group
3231 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3232 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3233 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3234 [ 2, 5 ] .
3235 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3236 .
3237
3238 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3239 @end group
3240 @end smallexample
3241
3242 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3243 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3244 matrix, as happened here!
3245
3246 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3247 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3248 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3249 as a row or column as appropriate.
3250
3251 @smallexample
3252 @group
3253 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3254 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3255 1: [1, 2, 3]
3256 .
3257
3258 r 4 r 1 *
3259 @end group
3260 @end smallexample
3261
3262 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3263 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3264 vector.
3265
3266 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3267 of the above
3268 @texline @math{2\times3}
3269 @infoline 2x3
3270 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3271 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3272 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3273
3274 @cindex Identity matrix
3275 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3276 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3277 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3278 the original matrix.
3279
3280 @smallexample
3281 @group
3282 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3283 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3284 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3285 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3286 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3287 .
3288
3289 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3290 @end group
3291 @end smallexample
3292
3293 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3294 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3295 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3296 inverse of a matrix.
3297
3298 @smallexample
3299 @group
3300 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3301 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3302 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3303 . .
3304
3305 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3306 @end group
3307 @end smallexample
3308
3309 @noindent
3310 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3311 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3312 our matrix to make it square.
3313
3314 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3315
3316 @smallexample
3317 @group
3318 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3319 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3320 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3321 . .
3322
3323 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3324 @end group
3325 @end smallexample
3326
3327 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3328 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3329 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3330 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3331
3332 @ifnottex
3333 @group
3334 @example
3335 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3336 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3337 7a + 6b = 3
3338 @end example
3339 @end group
3340 @end ifnottex
3341 @tex
3342 \turnoffactive
3343 \beforedisplayh
3344 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3345 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3346 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3347 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3348 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3349 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3350 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3351 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3352 $$
3353 \afterdisplayh
3354 @end tex
3355
3356 @noindent
3357 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3358
3359 @ifnottex
3360 @group
3361 @example
3362 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3363 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3364 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3365 @end example
3366 @end group
3367 @end ifnottex
3368 @tex
3369 \turnoffactive
3370 \beforedisplay
3371 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3372 \times
3373 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3374 $$
3375 \afterdisplay
3376 @end tex
3377
3378 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3379 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3380
3381 @smallexample
3382 @group
3383 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3384 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3385 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3386 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3387 .
3388
3389 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3390 @end group
3391 @end smallexample
3392
3393 @noindent
3394 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3395 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3396 inverse.)
3397
3398 Let's verify this solution:
3399
3400 @smallexample
3401 @group
3402 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3403 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3404 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3405 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3406 .
3407
3408 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3409 @end group
3410 @end smallexample
3411
3412 @noindent
3413 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3414 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3415 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3416 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3417 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3418 vectors, use explicit
3419 @texline @math{N\times1}
3420 @infoline Nx1
3421 or
3422 @texline @math{1\times N}
3423 @infoline 1xN
3424 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3425 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3426
3427 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3428 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3429 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3430 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3431
3432 @ifnottex
3433 @group
3434 @example
3435 x + a y = 6
3436 x + b y = 10
3437 @end example
3438 @end group
3439 @end ifnottex
3440 @tex
3441 \turnoffactive
3442 \beforedisplay
3443 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3444 x &+ b y = 10}
3445 $$
3446 \afterdisplay
3447 @end tex
3448
3449 @noindent
3450 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3451
3452 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3453 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3454 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3455 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3456 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3457 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3458 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3459 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3460 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3461 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3462 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3463 @ifnottex
3464 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3465 @end ifnottex
3466 @tex
3467 \turnoffactive
3468 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3469 @end tex
3470 Now
3471 @texline @math{A^T A}
3472 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3473 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3474 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3475 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3476 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3477 system:
3478
3479 @ifnottex
3480 @group
3481 @example
3482 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3483 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3484 7a + 6b = 3
3485 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3486 @end example
3487 @end group
3488 @end ifnottex
3489 @tex
3490 \turnoffactive
3491 \beforedisplayh
3492 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3493 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3494 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3495 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3496 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3497 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3498 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3499 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3500 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3501 $$
3502 \afterdisplayh
3503 @end tex
3504
3505 @noindent
3506 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3507
3508 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3509 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3510
3511 @noindent
3512 @cindex Lists
3513 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3514 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3515 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3516 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3517 number.
3518
3519 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3520
3521 @smallexample
3522 @group
3523 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3524 2: 20 . 2: 20
3525 1: 30 1: 30
3526 . .
3527
3528 M-3 v p v u
3529 @end group
3530 @end smallexample
3531
3532 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3533 of many copies of a given value:
3534
3535 @smallexample
3536 @group
3537 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3538 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3539 . .
3540
3541 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3542 @end group
3543 @end smallexample
3544
3545 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3546 @dfn{map} command.
3547
3548 @smallexample
3549 @group
3550 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3551 . . .
3552
3553 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3554 @end group
3555 @end smallexample
3556
3557 @noindent
3558 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3559 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3560 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3561 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3562 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3563 of each element.
3564
3565 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3566 from
3567 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3568 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3569 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3570
3571 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3572 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3573 elements in the vector:
3574
3575 @smallexample
3576 @group
3577 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3578 . . .
3579
3580 123123 k f V R *
3581 @end group
3582 @end smallexample
3583
3584 @noindent
3585 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3586 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3587
3588 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3589 reduction:
3590
3591 @smallexample
3592 @group
3593 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3594 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3595 .
3596
3597 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3598 @end group
3599 @end smallexample
3600
3601 @noindent
3602 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3603 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3604 for the dot product as before.
3605
3606 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3607 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3608 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3609
3610 @smallexample
3611 @group
3612 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3613 . .
3614
3615 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3616 @end group
3617 @end smallexample
3618
3619 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3620 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3621 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3622 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3623 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3624 vector size).
3625
3626 @smallexample
3627 @group
3628 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3629 . .
3630
3631 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3632 @end group
3633 @end smallexample
3634
3635 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3636 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3637 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3638
3639 @smallexample
3640 @group
3641 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3642 . .
3643
3644 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3645 @end group
3646 @end smallexample
3647
3648 @noindent
3649 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3650 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3651 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3652 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3653 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3654 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3655 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3656
3657 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3658 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3659 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3660
3661 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3662 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3663 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3664 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3665 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3666 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3667 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3668 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3669 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3670 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3671
3672 @smallexample
3673 x y
3674 --- ---
3675 1.34 0.234
3676 1.41 0.298
3677 1.49 0.402
3678 1.56 0.412
3679 1.64 0.466
3680 1.73 0.473
3681 1.82 0.601
3682 1.91 0.519
3683 2.01 0.603
3684 2.11 0.637
3685 2.22 0.645
3686 2.33 0.705
3687 2.45 0.917
3688 2.58 1.009
3689 2.71 0.971
3690 2.85 1.062
3691 3.00 1.148
3692 3.15 1.157
3693 3.32 1.354
3694 @end smallexample
3695
3696 @noindent
3697 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3698 easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3699 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3700 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3701
3702 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3703 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3704 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3705 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3706 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3707 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3708 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3709 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3710
3711 @smallexample
3712 @group
3713 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3714 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3715 @dots{}
3716 @end group
3717 @end smallexample
3718
3719 @noindent
3720 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3721 large matrix.)
3722
3723 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3724 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3725 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3726 of row vectors on the stack.
3727
3728 @smallexample
3729 @group
3730 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3731 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3732 . .
3733
3734 v t v u
3735 @end group
3736 @end smallexample
3737
3738 @noindent
3739 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3740
3741 @smallexample
3742 @group
3743 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3744 .
3745
3746 t 2 t 1
3747 @end group
3748 @end smallexample
3749
3750 @noindent
3751 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3752 stored value from the stack.)
3753
3754 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3755
3756 @ifnottex
3757 @example
3758 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3759 @end example
3760 @end ifnottex
3761 @tex
3762 \turnoffactive
3763 \beforedisplay
3764 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3765 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3766 \afterdisplay
3767 @end tex
3768
3769 @noindent
3770 where
3771 @texline @math{\sum x}
3772 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3773 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3774 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3775 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3776 this formula uses.
3777
3778 @smallexample
3779 @group
3780 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3781 . .
3782
3783 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3784
3785 @end group
3786 @end smallexample
3787 @noindent
3788 @smallexample
3789 @group
3790 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3791 . .
3792
3793 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3794 @end group
3795 @end smallexample
3796
3797 @ifnottex
3798 @noindent
3799 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3800 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3801 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
3802 @end ifnottex
3803 @tex
3804 \turnoffactive
3805 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3806 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3807 $\sum x y$.)
3808 @end tex
3809
3810 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3811 the length of either of our lists.
3812
3813 @smallexample
3814 @group
3815 1: 19
3816 .
3817
3818 r 1 v l t 7
3819 @end group
3820 @end smallexample
3821
3822 @noindent
3823 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3824
3825 Now we grind through the formula:
3826
3827 @smallexample
3828 @group
3829 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3830 . 1: 566.70919 .
3831 .
3832
3833 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3834
3835 @end group
3836 @end smallexample
3837 @noindent
3838 @smallexample
3839 @group
3840 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
3841 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3842 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3843 .
3844
3845 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3846 @end group
3847 @end smallexample
3848
3849 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3850 be found with the simple formula,
3851
3852 @ifnottex
3853 @example
3854 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3855 @end example
3856 @end ifnottex
3857 @tex
3858 \turnoffactive
3859 \beforedisplay
3860 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3861 \afterdisplay
3862 \vskip10pt
3863 @end tex
3864
3865 @smallexample
3866 @group
3867 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3868 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3869 .
3870
3871 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3872 @end group
3873 @end smallexample
3874
3875 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3876 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3877 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
3878 and compare it with the original data.
3879
3880 @smallexample
3881 @group
3882 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3883 . .
3884
3885 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3886 @end group
3887 @end smallexample
3888
3889 @noindent
3890 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3891 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3892 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3893 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3894
3895 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3896 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3897
3898 @smallexample
3899 @group
3900 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3901 . . .
3902
3903 r 2 - V M A V R X
3904 @end group
3905 @end smallexample
3906
3907 @noindent
3908 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3909 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3910 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3911 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3912 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3913 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3914 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3915 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3916 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3917
3918 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3919 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3920 GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3921 of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3922 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3923
3924 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3925 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3926 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3927 plotting of data.
3928
3929 @smallexample
3930 @group
3931 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3932 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3933 .
3934
3935 r 1 r 2 g f
3936 @end group
3937 @end smallexample
3938
3939 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3940 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3941 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3942 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3943 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3944 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3945
3946 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3947 @ifinfo
3948 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3949 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3950 replaced by a buffer named @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3951 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3952 @end ifinfo
3953
3954 @smallexample
3955 @group
3956 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3957 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3958 .
3959
3960 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3961 @end group
3962 @end smallexample
3963
3964 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3965 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3966 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3967
3968 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3969 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3970 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3971 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3972 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3973 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3974
3975 @cindex Geometric mean
3976 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3977 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3978 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3979 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3980 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
3981 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
3982
3983 @example
3984 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
3985 15 14 7.5
3986 2.5
3987 @end example
3988
3989 @noindent
3990 The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
3991 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
3992 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3993
3994 @ifnottex
3995 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
3996 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
3997 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
3998 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
3999 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4000 for @expr{n=6}.
4001 @end ifnottex
4002 @tex
4003 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4004 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4005 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4006 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4007 for \cite{n=6}.
4008 @end tex
4009
4010 @smallexample
4011 @group
4012 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4013 . .
4014
4015 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4016
4017 @end group
4018 @end smallexample
4019 @noindent
4020 @smallexample
4021 @group
4022 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4023 . .
4024
4025 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4026 @end group
4027 @end smallexample
4028
4029 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4030 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4031 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4032 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4033 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4034
4035 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4036 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4037 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4038 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4039 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4040 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4041
4042 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4043 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4044 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4045 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4046 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4047 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4048 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4049 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4050 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4051 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4052 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4053 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4054 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4055 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4056 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4057
4058 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4059 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4060 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4061 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4062
4063 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4064 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4065 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4066 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4067 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4068 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4069
4070 @cindex Divisor functions
4071 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4072 @tex
4073 $\sigma_k(n)$
4074 @end tex
4075 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4076 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4077 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4078 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4079 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4080
4081 @cindex Square-free numbers
4082 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4083 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4084 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4085 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4086 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4087 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4088 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4089 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4090
4091 @cindex Triangular lists
4092 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4093 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4094 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4095
4096 @smallexample
4097 @group
4098 1: [ [1],
4099 [1, 2],
4100 [1, 2, 3],
4101 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4102 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4103 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4104 @end group
4105 @end smallexample
4106
4107 @noindent
4108 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4109
4110 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4111
4112 @smallexample
4113 @group
4114 1: [ [0],
4115 [1, 2],
4116 [3, 4, 5],
4117 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4118 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4119 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4120 @end group
4121 @end smallexample
4122
4123 @noindent
4124 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4125
4126 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4127 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4128 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4129 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4130 @infoline @expr{J1}
4131 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4132 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4133 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4134 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4135 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4136 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4137 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4138
4139 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4140 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4141 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4142 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4143 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4144 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4145 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4146 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4147 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4148 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4149 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4150
4151 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4152 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4153 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4154
4155 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4156 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4157 @texline @math{2\times2}
4158 @infoline 2x2
4159 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4160 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4161 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4162 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4163 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4164 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4165 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4166 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4167 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4168 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4169
4170 @cindex Matchstick problem
4171 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4172 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4173 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4174 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4175 a line turns out to be
4176 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4177 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4178 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4179 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4180 one turns out to be
4181 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4182 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4183 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4184 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4185
4186 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4187 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4188 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4189 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4190 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4191 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4192 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4193 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4194 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4195 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4196 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4197 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4198 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4199 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4200 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4201 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4202 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4203 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4204
4205 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4206 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4207 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4208 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4209 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4210 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4211 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4212 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4213 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4214 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4215 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4216 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4217
4218 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4219 @section Types Tutorial
4220
4221 @noindent
4222 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4223 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4224
4225 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4226 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4227 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4228 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4229 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4230
4231 @smallexample
4232 @group
4233 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4234 . 1: 49 . . .
4235 .
4236
4237 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4238 @end group
4239 @end smallexample
4240
4241 @noindent
4242 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4243 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4244 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4245 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4246 fraction beginning with 49.
4247
4248 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4249 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4250
4251 @smallexample
4252 @group
4253 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4254 . .
4255
4256 c f c F
4257 @end group
4258 @end smallexample
4259
4260 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4261 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4262 same, to within the current precision.
4263
4264 @smallexample
4265 @group
4266 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4267 . . . .
4268
4269 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4270 @end group
4271 @end smallexample
4272
4273 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4274 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4275 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4276 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4277
4278 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4279
4280 @smallexample
4281 @group
4282 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4283 . . . . .
4284
4285 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4286 @end group
4287 @end smallexample
4288
4289 @noindent
4290 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4291 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4292 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4293 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4294
4295 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4296 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4297 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4298 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4299 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4300 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4301 algebraic entry.
4302
4303 @smallexample
4304 @group
4305 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4306 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4307 . . . .
4308
4309 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4310 @end group
4311 @end smallexample
4312
4313 @noindent
4314 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4315 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4316 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4317 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4318 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4319 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4320 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4321 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4322 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4323 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4324 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4325 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4326 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4327
4328 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4329 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4330 to turn on Infinite mode.
4331
4332 @smallexample
4333 @group
4334 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4335 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4336 1: 0 . . .
4337 .
4338
4339 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4340 @end group
4341 @end smallexample
4342
4343 @noindent
4344 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4345 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4346 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4347 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4348 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4349 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4350 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4351 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4352 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4353 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4354 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4355 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4356 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4357 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4358 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4359 that matter, with anything else.
4360
4361 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4362 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4363 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4364 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4365 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4366
4367 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4368 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4369 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4370 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4371
4372 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4373 seconds.
4374
4375 @smallexample
4376 @group
4377 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4378 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4379 .
4380
4381 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4382 @end group
4383 @end smallexample
4384
4385 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4386 seconds.
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 @group
4390 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4391 . . . .
4392
4393 0.5 I T c h S
4394 @end group
4395 @end smallexample
4396
4397 @noindent
4398 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4399 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4400 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4401
4402 @cindex Beatles
4403 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4404 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4405 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4406 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4407 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4408
4409 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4410 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4411 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4412
4413 @smallexample
4414 @group
4415 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4416 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4417 .
4418
4419 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4420 @end group
4421 @end smallexample
4422
4423 @noindent
4424 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4425 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4426 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4427 date form.
4428
4429 @smallexample
4430 @group
4431 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4432 . .
4433
4434 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4435 @end group
4436 @end smallexample
4437
4438 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4439 @noindent
4440 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4441 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4442 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4443 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4444 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4445 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4446
4447 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4448 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4449
4450 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4451 between now and the year 10001 A.D.? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4452
4453 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4454 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4455 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4456 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4457 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4458 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4459 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4460 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4461
4462 @smallexample
4463 @group
4464 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4465 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4466 .
4467
4468 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4469 @end group
4470 @end smallexample
4471
4472 @noindent
4473 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4474 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4475 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4476
4477 @cindex Torus, volume of
4478 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4479 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4480 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4481 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4482 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4483 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4484 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4485 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4486
4487 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4488 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4489 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4490 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4491 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4492
4493 @smallexample
4494 @group
4495 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4496 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4497 .
4498
4499 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4500 @end group
4501 @end smallexample
4502
4503 @noindent
4504 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4505 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4506
4507 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4508 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4509 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4510 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4511 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4512 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4513 the other.
4514
4515 @smallexample
4516 @group
4517 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4518 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4519 .
4520
4521 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4522 @end group
4523 @end smallexample
4524
4525 @noindent
4526 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4527 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4528 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4529 or both endpoints.
4530
4531 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4532 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4533 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4534 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4535 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4536
4537 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4538 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4539 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4540 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4541 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4542
4543 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4544 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4545 or 24 hours.
4546
4547 @smallexample
4548 @group
4549 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4550 . . . .
4551
4552 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4553 @end group
4554 @end smallexample
4555
4556 @noindent
4557 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4558 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4559 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4560 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4561 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4562
4563 @smallexample
4564 @group
4565 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4566 . . . .
4567
4568 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4569 @end group
4570 @end smallexample
4571
4572 @noindent
4573 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4574 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4575 that arises in the second one.
4576
4577 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4578 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4579 says that
4580 @texline @w{@math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}}
4581 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4582 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4583 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4584 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4585 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4586 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4587 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4588
4589 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4590 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4591 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4592 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4593
4594 @smallexample
4595 @group
4596 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4597 . .
4598
4599 x time @key{RET} n
4600 @end group
4601 @end smallexample
4602
4603 @noindent
4604 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4605
4606 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4607 is about
4608 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4609 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4610 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4611 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4612
4613 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4614 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4615 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4616 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4617 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4618 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4619
4620 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4621 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4622 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4623 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4624 like centimeters and inches.
4625
4626 @smallexample
4627 @group
4628 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4629 . . . .
4630
4631 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4632 @end group
4633 @end smallexample
4634
4635 @noindent
4636 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4637 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4638 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4639 which in this case means meters.
4640
4641 @smallexample
4642 @group
4643 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4644 . . . .
4645
4646 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4647
4648 @end group
4649 @end smallexample
4650 @noindent
4651 @smallexample
4652 @group
4653 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4654 . . .
4655
4656 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4657 @end group
4658 @end smallexample
4659
4660 @noindent
4661 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4662 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4663 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4664 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4665 being interpreted as unit names.
4666
4667 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4668 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4669 as its standard unit of length.
4670
4671 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4672
4673 @smallexample
4674 @group
4675 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4676 . . . .
4677
4678 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4679 @end group
4680 @end smallexample
4681
4682 @noindent
4683 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4684 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4685 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4686
4687 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4688 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4689 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4690 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4691 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4692 for them.
4693
4694 @smallexample
4695 @group
4696 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -20:3 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4697 . . . .
4698
4699 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET} c f
4700 @end group
4701 @end smallexample
4702
4703 @noindent
4704 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4705 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4706 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius. Since
4707 this comes out as an exact fraction, we then convert to floating-point
4708 for easier comparison with the other result.
4709
4710 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4711 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4712 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4713 numbers are in which units:
4714
4715 @smallexample
4716 @group
4717 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4718 . . .
4719
4720 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4721 @end group
4722 @end smallexample
4723
4724 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4725 @w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4726 at the units table.
4727
4728 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4729 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4730
4731 @cindex Speed of light
4732 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4733 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4734 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4735 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4736 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4737
4738 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4739 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4740 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4741 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4742 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4743
4744 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4745 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4746
4747 @noindent
4748 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4749 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4750 formulas.
4751
4752 @menu
4753 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4754 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4755 @end menu
4756
4757 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4758 @subsection Basic Algebra
4759
4760 @noindent
4761 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4762 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4763 formulas as regular data objects.
4764
4765 @smallexample
4766 @group
4767 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (6 - 2 x^2) (3 x^2 + y)
4768 . . .
4769
4770 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4771 @end group
4772 @end smallexample
4773
4774 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4775 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4776 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4777
4778 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4779 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4780
4781 @smallexample
4782 @group
4783 1: 18 x^2 + 6 y - 6 x^4 - 2 x^2 y 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4784 . .
4785
4786 a x a c x @key{RET}
4787 @end group
4788 @end smallexample
4789
4790 @noindent
4791 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4792 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4793
4794 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4795 is one-half.
4796
4797 @smallexample
4798 @group
4799 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4800 . .
4801
4802 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4803 @end group
4804 @end smallexample
4805
4806 @noindent
4807 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4808 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4809 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4810 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4811 back to its original value, if any.
4812
4813 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4814 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4815 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4816 properly.)
4817
4818 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4819 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4820 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4821 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4822 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4823 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4824 the function has a local maximum there.
4825
4826 @smallexample
4827 @group
4828 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4829 . .
4830
4831 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4832 @end group
4833 @end smallexample
4834
4835 @noindent
4836 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4837 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4838
4839 @smallexample
4840 @group
4841 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 x / x - 24 x^3 / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4842 . . .
4843
4844 ' x @key{RET} / a x a s
4845
4846 @end group
4847 @end smallexample
4848 @noindent
4849 @smallexample
4850 @group
4851 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023
4852 . .
4853
4854 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4855 @end group
4856 @end smallexample
4857
4858 @noindent
4859 Notice the use of @kbd{a s} to ``simplify'' the formula. When the
4860 default algebraic simplifications don't do enough, you can use
4861 @kbd{a s} to tell Calc to spend more time on the job.
4862
4863 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4864
4865 @smallexample
4866 @group
4867 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4868 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4869 . .
4870
4871 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4872 @end group
4873 @end smallexample
4874
4875 @noindent
4876 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4877 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4878 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4879 to delete the @samp{x}.)
4880
4881 @smallexample
4882 @group
4883 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
4884 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4885 . .
4886
4887 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4888 @end group
4889 @end smallexample
4890
4891 @noindent
4892 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4893 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4894 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4895
4896 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4897 @expr{34 - 24 x^2 = 0} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4898 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4899 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4900 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4901 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4902 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4903
4904 @smallexample
4905 @group
4906 1: 34 - 24 x^2 = 0 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4907 . . .
4908
4909 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4910 @end group
4911 @end smallexample
4912
4913 @noindent
4914 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4915 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4916 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4917 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4918 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4919
4920 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4921 into the original formula.
4922
4923 @smallexample
4924 @group
4925 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
4926 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4927 .
4928
4929 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4930 @end group
4931 @end smallexample
4932
4933 @noindent
4934 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4935 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4936 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4937
4938 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4939 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4940
4941 @smallexample
4942 @group
4943 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
4944 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4945 .
4946
4947 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4948 @end group
4949 @end smallexample
4950
4951 @noindent
4952 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4953 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4954 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4955 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4956 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4957 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4958 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4959 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4960 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4961 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4962
4963 If there had been several different values, we could have used
4964 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4965
4966 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4967 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4968 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4969 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4970 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4971 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4972 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4973 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4974
4975 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4976 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4977 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4978 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4979 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4980 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4981
4982 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
4983 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
4984 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
4985 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
4986
4987 @smallexample
4988 @group
4989 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
4990 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
4991 . .
4992
4993 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
4994 @end group
4995 @end smallexample
4996
4997 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
4998
4999 @smallexample
5000 @group
5001 3
5002 2: 34 x - 24 x
5003
5004 ____ ____
5005 V 51 V 51
5006 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5007 6 -6
5008
5009 .
5010
5011 d B
5012 @end group
5013 @end smallexample
5014
5015 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5016 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5017 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5018 and La@TeX{} mode.
5019
5020 @smallexample
5021 @group
5022 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5023 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5024 . .
5025
5026 d C d F
5027
5028 @end group
5029 @end smallexample
5030 @noindent
5031 @smallexample
5032 @group
5033 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5034 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5035 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5036 .
5037
5038 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5039 @end group
5040 @end smallexample
5041
5042 @noindent
5043 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5044 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5045 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5046 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5047
5048 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5049 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5050 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5051 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5052 correct.
5053
5054 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5055 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5056 are shown in normal mode.)
5057
5058 @cindex Area under a curve
5059 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5060 This is simply the integral of the function:
5061
5062 @smallexample
5063 @group
5064 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5065 . .
5066
5067 r 1 a i x
5068 @end group
5069 @end smallexample
5070
5071 @noindent
5072 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5073 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5074
5075 @smallexample
5076 @group
5077 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5078 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5079
5080 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5081 @end group
5082 @end smallexample
5083
5084 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5085 of
5086 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5087 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5088 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5089 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5090 3}. (@bullet{})
5091
5092 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5093 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5094 under the curve
5095 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5096 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5097 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5098 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5099 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5100 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5101
5102 @cindex Integration, numerical
5103 @cindex Numerical integration
5104 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5105 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5106 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5107 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5108
5109 @smallexample
5110 @group
5111 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5112 2: 1 .
5113 1: 0.1
5114 .
5115
5116 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5117 @end group
5118 @end smallexample
5119
5120 @noindent
5121 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5122 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5123
5124 @smallexample
5125 @group
5126 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5127 1: sin(x) ln(x) .
5128 .
5129
5130 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5131
5132 @end group
5133 @end smallexample
5134 @noindent
5135 @smallexample
5136 @group
5137 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5138 . .
5139
5140 V R + 0.1 *
5141 @end group
5142 @end smallexample
5143
5144 @noindent
5145 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5146 to Radians mode?)
5147
5148 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5149 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5150 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5151 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5152 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5153 is the same for every box.)
5154
5155 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5156 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5157
5158 @smallexample
5159 @group
5160 1: sin(x) ln(x) 1: 0.84147 x - 0.84147 + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5161 . .
5162
5163 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5164 @end group
5165 @end smallexample
5166
5167 @noindent
5168 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5169 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5170 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5171
5172 @smallexample
5173 @group
5174 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5175 . . .
5176
5177 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5178 @end group
5179 @end smallexample
5180
5181 @noindent
5182 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5183 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5184 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5185 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5186 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5187 of @expr{x=1}.)
5188
5189 @cindex Simpson's rule
5190 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5191 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5192 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5193 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5194 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5195 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5196 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5197 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5198 down to the formula,
5199
5200 @ifnottex
5201 @example
5202 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5203 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5204 @end example
5205 @end ifnottex
5206 @tex
5207 \turnoffactive
5208 \beforedisplay
5209 $$ \displaylines{
5210 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5211 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5212 } $$
5213 \afterdisplay
5214 @end tex
5215
5216 @noindent
5217 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5218 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5219 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5220 method:
5221
5222 @ifnottex
5223 @example
5224 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5225 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5226 @end example
5227 @end ifnottex
5228 @tex
5229 \turnoffactive
5230 \beforedisplay
5231 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5232 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5233 \afterdisplay
5234 @end tex
5235
5236 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5237 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5238 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5239 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5240 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5241
5242 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5243 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5244 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5245 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5246
5247 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5248 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5249 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5250 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5251 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5252 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5253 details and examples.
5254
5255 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5256 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5257
5258 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5259 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5260
5261 @noindent
5262 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5263 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5264 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5265 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5266
5267 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5268
5269 @smallexample
5270 @group
5271 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x)
5272 .
5273
5274 ' 1/cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) @key{RET} s 1
5275 @end group
5276 @end smallexample
5277
5278 @noindent
5279 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably replace the
5280 @samp{tan} with a @samp{sin/cos} first, then combine over a common
5281 denominator. There is no Calc command to do the former; the @kbd{a n}
5282 algebra command will do the latter but we'll do both with rewrite
5283 rules just for practice.
5284
5285 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5286
5287 @smallexample
5288 @group
5289 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x)
5290 .
5291
5292 a r tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a) @key{RET}
5293 @end group
5294 @end smallexample
5295
5296 @noindent
5297 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5298 by itself the formula @samp{tan(a) := sin(a)/cos(a)} doesn't do anything,
5299 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5300 it as a rewrite rule.)
5301
5302 The lefthand side, @samp{tan(a)}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5303 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5304 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5305 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5306 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5307 the actual variable @samp{x}.
5308
5309 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5310 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5311 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5312 @samp{sin(x) / cos(x)}. Calc's normal algebraic simplifications then
5313 mix this in with the rest of the original formula.
5314
5315 To merge over a common denominator, we can use another simple rule:
5316
5317 @smallexample
5318 @group
5319 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5320 .
5321
5322 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5323 @end group
5324 @end smallexample
5325
5326 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5327 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5328 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5329 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5330 denominators.
5331
5332 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5333 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5334 the subformula @samp{cos(x)}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5335 @samp{x}.
5336
5337 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5338 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5339 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5340 @samp{a = 1}, @samp{b = -sin(x)^2}, and @samp{x = cos(x)}.
5341
5342 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5343 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5344 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5345 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5346 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5347 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5348
5349 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5350 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}, but of course we must first rearrange
5351 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5352 would be @samp{@w{1 - sin(x)^2} := cos(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5353 that the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2} will also work. The
5354 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5355 situations, too.
5356
5357 @smallexample
5358 @group
5359 1: (1 + cos(x)^2 - 1) / cos(x) 1: cos(x)
5360 . .
5361
5362 a r sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} a s
5363 @end group
5364 @end smallexample
5365
5366 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5367 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5368 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5369 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5370 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5371 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5372 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5373 having to retype it.
5374
5375 @smallexample
5376 @group
5377 ' tan(x) := sin(x)/cos(x) @key{RET} s t tsc @key{RET}
5378 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5379 ' sin(x)^2 := 1 - cos(x)^2 @key{RET} s t sinsqr @key{RET}
5380
5381 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5382 . .
5383
5384 r 1 a r tsc @key{RET} a r merge @key{RET} a r sinsqr @key{RET} a s
5385 @end group
5386 @end smallexample
5387
5388 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5389 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5390 the edited value back into the variable.
5391 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5392
5393 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5394 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5395 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5396 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5397 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5398 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5399 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5400 entering them on the fly.
5401
5402 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5403 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5404 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5405 bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5406 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5407 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5408
5409 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5410 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5411
5412 @smallexample
5413 @group
5414 1: [tsc, merge, sinsqr] 1: [tan(x) := sin(x) / cos(x), ... ]
5415 . .
5416
5417 ' [tsc,merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5418
5419 @end group
5420 @end smallexample
5421 @noindent
5422 @smallexample
5423 @group
5424 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x) tan(x) 1: cos(x)
5425 . .
5426
5427 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET} a s
5428 @end group
5429 @end smallexample
5430
5431 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5432 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5433 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5434 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5435 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5436 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5437
5438 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5439 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5440 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5441 only one rewrite at a time.
5442
5443 @smallexample
5444 @group
5445 1: 1 / cos(x) - sin(x)^2 / cos(x) 1: (1 - sin(x)^2) / cos(x)
5446 . .
5447
5448 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5449 @end group
5450 @end smallexample
5451
5452 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5453 of rewrites that occur.
5454
5455 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5456 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5457
5458 @smallexample
5459 @group
5460 1: exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i)
5461 .
5462
5463 ' exp(2 pi i) + exp(3 pi i) + exp(4 pi i) @key{RET}
5464
5465 @end group
5466 @end smallexample
5467 @noindent
5468 @smallexample
5469 @group
5470 1: 1 + exp(3 pi i) + 1
5471 .
5472
5473 a r exp(k pi i) := 1 :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5474 @end group
5475 @end smallexample
5476
5477 @noindent
5478 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5479 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5480
5481 An interesting point is that the variables @samp{pi} and @samp{i}
5482 were matched literally rather than acting as meta-variables.
5483 This is because they are special-constant variables. The special
5484 constants @samp{e}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5485 A common error with rewrite
5486 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5487 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5488 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5489
5490 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5491 @ignore
5492 @starindex
5493 @end ignore
5494 @tindex fib
5495 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5496 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5497 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5498 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5499 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5500
5501 @smallexample
5502 @group
5503 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5504
5505 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5506 . .
5507
5508 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5509 @end group
5510 @end smallexample
5511
5512 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5513 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5514 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5515 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5516 be used preferentially.
5517
5518 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5519 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5520 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5521 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5522 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5523 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5524 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5525
5526 @smallexample
5527 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5528 @end smallexample
5529
5530 @noindent
5531 Now:
5532
5533 @smallexample
5534 @group
5535 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: 8 + fib(x) + fib(0)
5536 . .
5537
5538 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5539 @end group
5540 @end smallexample
5541
5542 @noindent
5543 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5544 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5545 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5546 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5547 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5548
5549 @smallexample
5550 @group
5551 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5552 . .
5553
5554 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5555 @end group
5556 @end smallexample
5557
5558 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5559 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5560 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5561
5562 @smallexample
5563 @group
5564 fib(6) =
5565 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5566 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5567 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5568 @end group
5569 @end smallexample
5570
5571 @noindent
5572 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5573 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5574 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5575 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5576 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5577 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5578
5579 @smallexample
5580 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5581 @end smallexample
5582
5583 @noindent
5584 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5585 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5586 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5587 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5588 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5589 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5590
5591 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5592 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5593
5594 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5595 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5596 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5597 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5598 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5599
5600 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5601 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5602 un-store the variable.
5603
5604 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5605 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5606 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5607 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5608 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5609 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5610 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5611 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5612 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5613
5614 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5615 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5616 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5617 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5618
5619 @example
5620 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5621 @end example
5622
5623 @noindent
5624 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5625 to 1.''
5626
5627 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5628 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5629 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5630 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5631 and one for @samp{b}.
5632
5633 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5634 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5635 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5636 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5637
5638 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5639 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5640 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5641 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5642 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5643 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5644 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5645 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5646 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5647 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5648 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5649 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5650 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5651 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5652
5653 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5654 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5655 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5656 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5657 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5658 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5659
5660 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5661 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5662 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5663
5664 @ifnottex
5665 @example
5666 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5667 @end example
5668 @end ifnottex
5669 @tex
5670 \turnoffactive
5671 \beforedisplay
5672 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5673 \afterdisplay
5674 @end tex
5675
5676 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5677 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5678 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5679 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5680 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5681
5682 @ifnottex
5683 @example
5684 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5685 @end example
5686 @end ifnottex
5687 @tex
5688 \turnoffactive
5689 \beforedisplay
5690 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5691 \afterdisplay
5692 @end tex
5693
5694 @noindent
5695 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5696 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5697
5698 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5699 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5700 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5701 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5702 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5703 rearranged or if @kbd{a s} needs to be typed after rewriting. (This one
5704 is rather tricky; the solution at the end of this chapter uses 6 rewrite
5705 rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)} condition tests whether @samp{x} is
5706 a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5707
5708 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5709 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5710 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5711
5712 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5713
5714 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5715 @section Programming Tutorial
5716
5717 @noindent
5718 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5719 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5720 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5721 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5722 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5723 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5724
5725 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5726 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5727 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5728 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5729 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5730
5731 @smallexample
5732 @group
5733 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 1: 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6
5734 . .
5735
5736 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5737 @end group
5738 @end smallexample
5739
5740 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5741 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5742 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5743 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5744 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5745 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5746 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5747 arguments?''
5748
5749 @smallexample
5750 @group
5751 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5752 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5753 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5754 .
5755
5756 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5757 @end group
5758 @end smallexample
5759
5760 @noindent
5761 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5762 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5763 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5764 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5765 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5766 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5767 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5768
5769 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5770 @ignore
5771 @starindex
5772 @end ignore
5773 @tindex Si
5774 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5775 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5776 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5777 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5778 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5779 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5780 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5781 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5782 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5783 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5784 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5785 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5786 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5787 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5788 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5789 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5790
5791 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5792 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5793 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5794 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5795 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5796
5797 @smallexample
5798 @group
5799 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5800 . .
5801
5802 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5803
5804 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 pi n1
5805 . .
5806
5807 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5808 @end group
5809 @end smallexample
5810
5811 @noindent
5812 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5813 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5814 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5815 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5816 re-execute the same keystrokes.
5817
5818 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5819
5820 @smallexample
5821 @group
5822 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5823 . .
5824
5825 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5826 @end group
5827 @end smallexample
5828
5829 @noindent
5830 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5831 @kbd{z} to call it up.
5832
5833 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5834
5835 @smallexample
5836 @group
5837 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5838 . . . .
5839
5840 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5841 @end group
5842 @end smallexample
5843
5844 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5845 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5846 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5847
5848 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5849 the following functions:
5850
5851 @enumerate
5852 @item
5853 Compute
5854 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5855 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5856 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5857
5858 @item
5859 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5860 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5861
5862 @item
5863 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5864 the stack.
5865 @end enumerate
5866 @noindent
5867 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5868
5869 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5870 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5871 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5872
5873 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5874 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5875 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5876
5877 @smallexample
5878 @group
5879 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5880 . 1: 4 .
5881 .
5882
5883 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5884 @end group
5885 @end smallexample
5886
5887 @noindent
5888 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5889 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5890 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5891 executes the body of the loop that many times.
5892
5893 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5894 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5895
5896 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5897 Here's another example:
5898
5899 @smallexample
5900 @group
5901 3: 1 2: 10946
5902 2: 1 1: 17711
5903 1: 20 .
5904 .
5905
5906 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5907 @end group
5908 @end smallexample
5909
5910 @noindent
5911 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5912 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5913 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5914 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5915
5916 @cindex Golden ratio
5917 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
5918 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5919 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5920 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5921 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5922 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5923 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5924 @infoline @expr{phi},
5925 the ``golden ratio,'' is
5926 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5927 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5928 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5929 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5930
5931 @smallexample
5932 @group
5933 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5934 . . . .
5935
5936 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5937 @end group
5938 @end smallexample
5939
5940 @cindex Continued fractions
5941 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5942 representation of
5943 @texline @math{\phi}
5944 @infoline @expr{phi}
5945 is
5946 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5947 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5948 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5949 and then replacing the innermost
5950 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5951 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5952 by 1. Approximate
5953 @texline @math{\phi}
5954 @infoline @expr{phi}
5955 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5956 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5957
5958 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5959 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5960 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5961 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5962 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5963 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5964 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5965
5966 @cindex Harmonic numbers
5967 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5968 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5969 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5970
5971 @smallexample
5972 @group
5973 3: 0 1: 3.597739
5974 2: 1 .
5975 1: 20
5976 .
5977
5978 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5979 @end group
5980 @end smallexample
5981
5982 @noindent
5983 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
5984 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
5985 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
5986 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
5987 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
5988 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
5989 uses a step of one.
5990
5991 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
5992 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
5993 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
5994
5995 @smallexample
5996 @group
5997 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
5998 . 1: 20 .
5999 .
6000
6001 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
6002 @end group
6003 @end smallexample
6004
6005 @noindent
6006 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
6007 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
6008
6009 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6010 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6011 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6012 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6013 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6014 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6015 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6016
6017 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6018 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6019 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6020
6021 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6022 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6023 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6024 fix, though:
6025
6026 @smallexample
6027 @group
6028 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6029 . . 2: 3.597739
6030 1: 0.6667
6031 .
6032
6033 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6034 @end group
6035 @end smallexample
6036
6037 @noindent
6038 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6039 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6040 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6041 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6042 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6043 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6044 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6045 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6046 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6047
6048 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6049 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6050 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6051 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6052 by the formula
6053 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6054 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6055 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6056 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6057 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6058 numbers are very large fractions.)
6059
6060 @smallexample
6061 @group
6062 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6063 . .
6064
6065 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6066 @end group
6067 @end smallexample
6068
6069 @noindent
6070 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6071 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6072 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6073 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6074 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6075 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6076 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6077
6078 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6079
6080 @smallexample
6081 @group
6082 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6083 2: 5:66 . . . .
6084 1: 0.0757575
6085 .
6086
6087 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6088 @end group
6089 @end smallexample
6090
6091 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6092 Bernoulli numbers.
6093
6094 @smallexample
6095 @group
6096 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6097 2: 2 .
6098 1: 30
6099 .
6100
6101 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6102 @end group
6103 @end smallexample
6104
6105 @noindent
6106 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6107 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6108 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6109 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6110 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6111 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6112 sequence of keystrokes.)
6113
6114 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6115 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6116 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6117 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6118 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6119
6120 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6121 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6122 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6123 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6124
6125 @smallexample
6126 @group
6127 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6128 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6129
6130 1 ;; calc digits
6131 RET ;; calc-enter
6132 2 ;; calc digits
6133 + ;; calc-plus
6134
6135 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6136 @end group
6137 @end smallexample
6138
6139 @noindent
6140 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6141 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6142 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6143 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6144 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6145 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6146 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6147 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6148 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6149 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6150
6151 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6152 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6153 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6154 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6155 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6156
6157 @smallexample
6158 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6159 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6160 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6161 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6162 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6163 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6164 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6165 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6166 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6167 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6168 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6169 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6170 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6171 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6172 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6173 @end smallexample
6174
6175 @noindent
6176 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6177
6178 @smallexample
6179 @group
6180 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6181 . .
6182
6183 20 z h
6184 @end group
6185 @end smallexample
6186
6187 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6188 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6189 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6190 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6191 command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6192 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6193 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6194
6195 @example
6196 @group
6197 Z ` 0 t 1
6198 1 TAB
6199 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6200 r 1
6201 Z '
6202 @end group
6203 @end example
6204
6205 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6206 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6207 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6208 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6209 this formula over and over:
6210
6211 @ifnottex
6212 @example
6213 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6214 @end example
6215 @end ifnottex
6216 @tex
6217 \beforedisplay
6218 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f'(x)} $$
6219 \afterdisplay
6220 @end tex
6221
6222 @noindent
6223 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6224 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6225 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6226 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6227 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6228 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6229 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6230 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6231 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6232 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6233 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6234 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6235 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6236 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6237
6238 @cindex Digamma function
6239 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6240 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6241 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6242 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6243 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6244 is defined as the derivative of
6245 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6246 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6247 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6248
6249 @ifnottex
6250 @example
6251 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6252 @end example
6253 @end ifnottex
6254 @tex
6255 \beforedisplay
6256 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6257 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6258 $$
6259 \afterdisplay
6260 @end tex
6261
6262 @noindent
6263 where
6264 @texline @math{\sum}
6265 @infoline @expr{sum}
6266 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6267 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6268 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6269 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6270 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6271 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6272 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6273 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6274 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6275 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6276 Fortunately, we can compute
6277 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6278 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6279 from
6280 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6281 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6282 using the recurrence
6283 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6284 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6285 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6286 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6287 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6288 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6289 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6290 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6291 to compute
6292 @texline @math{\gamma}
6293 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6294 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6295 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6296 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6297
6298 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6299 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6300 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6301 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6302 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6303 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6304 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6305 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6306 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6307
6308 @cindex Recursion
6309 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6310 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6311
6312 @ifnottex
6313 @example
6314 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6315 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6316 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6317 @end example
6318 @end ifnottex
6319 @tex
6320 \turnoffactive
6321 \beforedisplay
6322 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6323 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6324 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6325 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6326 $$
6327 \afterdisplay
6328 \vskip5pt
6329 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6330 @end tex
6331
6332 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6333 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6334 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6335 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6336 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6337 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6338 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6339 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6340 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6341 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6342 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6343 or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6344 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6345 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6346 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6347 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6348 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6349 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6350
6351 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6352 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6353 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6354 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6355 program can:
6356
6357 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6358 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6359 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6360 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6361
6362 @example
6363
6364 @end example
6365 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6366 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6367 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6368 @c [not-split]
6369 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6370 @c [when-split]
6371 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6372
6373 @page
6374 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6375 @section Answers to Exercises
6376
6377 @noindent
6378 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6379
6380 @menu
6381 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6382 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6383 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6384 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6385 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6386 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6387 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6388 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6389 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6390 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6391 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6392 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6393 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6394 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6395 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6396 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6397 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6398 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6399 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6400 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6401 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6402 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6403 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6404 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6405 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6406 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6407 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6408 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6409 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6410 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6411 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6412 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6413 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6414 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6415 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6416 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6417 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6418 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6419 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6420 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6421 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6422 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6423 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6424 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6425 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6426 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6427 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6428 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6429 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6430 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6431 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6432 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6433 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6434 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6435 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6436 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6437 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6438 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6439 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6440 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6441 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6442 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6443 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6444 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6445 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6446 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6447 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6448 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6449 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6450 @end menu
6451
6452 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6453 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6454 @tex
6455 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6456 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6457 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6458 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6459 @end tex
6460
6461 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6462 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6463
6464 @noindent
6465 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6466
6467 The result is
6468 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6469 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6470
6471 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6472 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6473
6474 @noindent
6475 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6476 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6477
6478 After computing the intermediate term
6479 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6480 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6481 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6482 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6483 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6484
6485 @smallexample
6486 @group
6487 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6488 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6489 . 1: 9.5 .
6490 .
6491
6492 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6493
6494 @end group
6495 @end smallexample
6496 @noindent
6497 @smallexample
6498 @group
6499 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6500 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6501 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6502 1: 4 .
6503 .
6504
6505 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6506 @end group
6507 @end smallexample
6508
6509 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6510 with the third term.
6511
6512 @smallexample
6513 @group
6514 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6515 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6516 . 1: 4 .
6517 .
6518
6519 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6520 @end group
6521 @end smallexample
6522
6523 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6524 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6525 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6526 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6527
6528 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6529 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6530
6531 @noindent
6532 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6533
6534 @smallexample
6535 @group
6536 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6537 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6538 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6539 . . 1: 1 . .
6540 .
6541
6542 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6543 @end group
6544 @end smallexample
6545
6546 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6547
6548 @smallexample
6549 @group
6550 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6551 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6552 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6553 . . . . .
6554
6555 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6556 @end group
6557 @end smallexample
6558
6559 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6560 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6561
6562 @noindent
6563 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6564 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6565
6566 @smallexample
6567 @group
6568 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6569 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6570 . . .
6571
6572 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6573 @end group
6574 @end smallexample
6575
6576 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6577 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6578 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6579 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6580 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6581
6582 @smallexample
6583 @group
6584 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6585 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6586 . . .
6587
6588 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6589 @end group
6590 @end smallexample
6591
6592 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6593 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6594 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6595 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6596
6597 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6598 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6599
6600 @noindent
6601 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6602
6603 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6604 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6605
6606 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6607 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6608 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6609
6610 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6611 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6612
6613 @noindent
6614 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6615 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6616 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6617 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6618
6619 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6620 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6621
6622 @noindent
6623 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6624 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6625 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6626 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6627 times anything is zero.''
6628
6629 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6630 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6631 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6632 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6633 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6634 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6635
6636 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6637 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6638
6639 @noindent
6640 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6641 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6642 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6643 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6644 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6645 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6646
6647 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6648 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6649 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6650 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6651 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6652 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6653 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6654 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6655 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6656 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6657 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6658
6659 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6660 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6661 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6662 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6663 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6664 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6665 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6666 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6667 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6668 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6669
6670 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6671 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6672 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6673 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6674 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6675 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6676 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6677 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6678 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6679 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6680
6681 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6682 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6683 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6684 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6685 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6686 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6687 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6688 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6689 in decimal display mode.
6690
6691 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6692 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6693 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6694 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6695
6696 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6697 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6698
6699 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6700 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6701 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6702 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6703 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6704 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6705 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6706 way to enter this number.
6707
6708 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6709 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6710 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6711 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6712 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6713 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6714 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6715
6716 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6717 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6718
6719 @noindent
6720 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6721
6722 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6723 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6724 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6725 their inputs.
6726
6727 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6728 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6729 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6730 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6731 determining facts like this.
6732
6733 @smallexample
6734 @group
6735 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6736 . .
6737
6738 45 S 2 ^
6739
6740 @end group
6741 @end smallexample
6742 @noindent
6743 @smallexample
6744 @group
6745 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6746 . . .
6747
6748 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6749 @end group
6750 @end smallexample
6751
6752 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6753 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6754 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6755 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6756 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6757
6758 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6759 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6760
6761 @noindent
6762 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6763 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6764 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6765 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6766 of time.
6767
6768 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6769 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6770 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6771 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6772 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6773 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6774
6775 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6776 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6777 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6778
6779 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6780 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6781
6782 @noindent
6783 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6784 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6785 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6786 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6787 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6788 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6789 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6790 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6791
6792 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6793 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6794 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6795 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6796 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6797 format.
6798
6799 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6800 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6801
6802 @noindent
6803 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6804 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6805
6806 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6807 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6808 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6809 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6810
6811 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6812 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6813
6814 @noindent
6815 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6816 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6817
6818 @smallexample
6819 @group
6820 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6821 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6822 .
6823
6824 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6825 @end group
6826 @end smallexample
6827
6828 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6829 indeed have unit length.
6830
6831 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6832 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6833
6834 @noindent
6835 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6836 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6837 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6838 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6839
6840 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6841 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6842
6843 @noindent
6844 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6845 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6846
6847 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6848 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6849
6850 @ifnottex
6851 @example
6852 @group
6853 x + a y = 6
6854 x + b y = 10
6855 @end group
6856 @end example
6857 @end ifnottex
6858 @tex
6859 \turnoffactive
6860 \beforedisplay
6861 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6862 x &+ b y = 10}
6863 $$
6864 \afterdisplay
6865 @end tex
6866
6867 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6868 matrix as usual.
6869
6870 @smallexample
6871 @group
6872 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [6 - 4 a / (b - a), 4 / (b - a) ]
6873 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6874 [ 1, b ] ]
6875 .
6876
6877 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6878 @end group
6879 @end smallexample
6880
6881 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6882 mode:
6883
6884 @smallexample
6885 @group
6886 4 a 4
6887 1: [6 - -----, -----]
6888 b - a b - a
6889 @end group
6890 @end smallexample
6891
6892 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6893
6894 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6895 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6896
6897 @noindent
6898 To solve
6899 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6900 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6901 first we compute
6902 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6903 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6904 and
6905 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6906 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6907 now, we have a system
6908 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
6909 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6910 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6911
6912 @ifnottex
6913 @example
6914 @group
6915 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6916 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6917 7a + 6b = 3
6918 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6919 @end group
6920 @end example
6921 @end ifnottex
6922 @tex
6923 \turnoffactive
6924 \beforedisplayh
6925 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6926 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6927 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6928 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6929 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6930 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6931 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6932 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6933 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6934 $$
6935 \afterdisplayh
6936 @end tex
6937
6938 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6939 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6940 @texline @math{B'}
6941 @infoline @expr{B2}
6942 vector.
6943
6944 @smallexample
6945 @group
6946 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6947 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6948 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6949 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6950 . .
6951
6952 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6953 @end group
6954 @end smallexample
6955
6956 @noindent
6957 Now we compute the matrix
6958 @texline @math{A'}
6959 @infoline @expr{A2}
6960 and divide.
6961
6962 @smallexample
6963 @group
6964 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
6965 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6966 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6967 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6968 .
6969
6970 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6971 @end group
6972 @end smallexample
6973
6974 @noindent
6975 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6976 round-off error.)
6977
6978 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6979 @texline @math{3\times3}
6980 @infoline 3x3
6981 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
6982 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
6983 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
6984 answer since the
6985 @texline @math{4\times3}
6986 @infoline 4x3
6987 system would be equivalent to the original
6988 @texline @math{3\times3}
6989 @infoline 3x3
6990 system.)
6991
6992 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
6993 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
6994 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
6995
6996 @smallexample
6997 @group
6998 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
6999 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
7000 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
7001 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
7002 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
7003 .
7004
7005 r 7 @key{TAB} *
7006 @end group
7007 @end smallexample
7008
7009 @noindent
7010 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
7011 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
7012
7013 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7014 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7015
7016 @noindent
7017 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7018 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7019 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7020 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7021
7022 @smallexample
7023 @group
7024 2: 2 2: 2
7025 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7026 . .
7027
7028 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7029 @end group
7030 @end smallexample
7031
7032 @noindent
7033 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7034 vector.
7035
7036 @smallexample
7037 @group
7038 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7039 .
7040
7041 V M ^
7042 @end group
7043 @end smallexample
7044
7045 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7046 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7047
7048 @noindent
7049 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7050 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7051
7052 @ifnottex
7053 @example
7054 m*x + b*1 = y
7055 @end example
7056 @end ifnottex
7057 @tex
7058 \turnoffactive
7059 \beforedisplay
7060 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7061 \afterdisplay
7062 @end tex
7063
7064 Thus we want a
7065 @texline @math{19\times2}
7066 @infoline 19x2
7067 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7068 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7069 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7070
7071 @smallexample
7072 @group
7073 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7074 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7075 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7076 @dots{}
7077
7078 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7079 @end group
7080 @end smallexample
7081
7082 @noindent
7083 Now we compute
7084 @texline @math{A^T y}
7085 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7086 and
7087 @texline @math{A^T A}
7088 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7089 and divide.
7090
7091 @smallexample
7092 @group
7093 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7094 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7095 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7096 .
7097
7098 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7099 @end group
7100 @end smallexample
7101
7102 @noindent
7103 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7104
7105 @smallexample
7106 @group
7107 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7108 .
7109
7110 /
7111 @end group
7112 @end smallexample
7113
7114 Since we were solving equations of the form
7115 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7116 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7117 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7118 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7119 @kbd{V R}!
7120
7121 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7122 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7123 arithmetic functions!
7124
7125 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7126 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7127 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7128
7129 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7130 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7131
7132 @noindent
7133 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7134 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7135 and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7136
7137 @smallexample
7138 @group
7139 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7140 .
7141 @end group
7142 @end smallexample
7143
7144 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7145 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7146
7147 @smallexample
7148 @group
7149 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7150 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7151 . .
7152
7153 @key{RET} V R *
7154
7155 @end group
7156 @end smallexample
7157 @noindent
7158 @smallexample
7159 @group
7160 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7161 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7162 . .
7163
7164 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7165 @end group
7166 @end smallexample
7167
7168 @noindent
7169 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7170 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7171 then raise the number to that power.)
7172
7173 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7174 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7175
7176 @noindent
7177 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7178 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7179 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7180 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7181
7182 @smallexample
7183 @group
7184 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7185 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7186 . .
7187
7188 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7189 @end group
7190 @end smallexample
7191
7192 @noindent
7193 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7194
7195 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7196 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7197
7198 @smallexample
7199 @group
7200 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7201 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7202 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7203 .
7204
7205 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7206 @end group
7207 @end smallexample
7208
7209 @noindent
7210 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7211 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7212
7213 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7214 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7215
7216 @noindent
7217 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7218 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7219 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7220 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7221
7222 @smallexample
7223 @group
7224 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7225 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7226 . .
7227
7228 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7229
7230 @end group
7231 @end smallexample
7232 @noindent
7233 @smallexample
7234 @group
7235 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7236 . . .
7237
7238 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7239 @end group
7240 @end smallexample
7241
7242 @noindent
7243 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7244 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7245 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7246 the job is pretty straightforward.
7247
7248 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7249 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7250 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7251 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7252 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7253
7254 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7255 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7256
7257 @noindent
7258 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7259 to get a list of lists of integers!
7260
7261 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7262 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7263
7264 @noindent
7265 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7266 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7267
7268 @smallexample
7269 @group
7270 1: [ [0],
7271 [0, 1],
7272 [0, 1, 2],
7273 @dots{}
7274
7275 1 -
7276 @end group
7277 @end smallexample
7278
7279 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7280 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7281 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7282 can be computed directly by the formula
7283 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7284 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7285
7286 @smallexample
7287 @group
7288 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7289 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7290 . .
7291
7292 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7293 @end group
7294 @end smallexample
7295
7296 @noindent
7297 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7298 result:
7299
7300 @smallexample
7301 @group
7302 1: [ [0],
7303 [1, 2],
7304 [3, 4, 5],
7305 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7306 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7307 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7308 .
7309
7310 V M +
7311 @end group
7312 @end smallexample
7313
7314 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7315 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7316 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7317 triangular list.
7318
7319 @smallexample
7320 @group
7321 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7322 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7323 . .
7324
7325 @key{RET} V M V R +
7326 @end group
7327 @end smallexample
7328
7329 @noindent
7330 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7331 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7332 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7333
7334 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7335 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7336
7337 @noindent
7338 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7339
7340 @smallexample
7341 @group
7342 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7343 . . .
7344
7345 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7346 @end group
7347 @end smallexample
7348
7349 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7350
7351 @smallexample
7352 @group
7353 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7354 .
7355
7356 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7357 @end group
7358 @end smallexample
7359
7360 @noindent
7361 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7362
7363 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7364 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7365
7366 @smallexample
7367 @group
7368 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7369 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7370 . .
7371
7372 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7373 @end group
7374 @end smallexample
7375
7376 @noindent
7377 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7378 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7379 @texline @math{\sin x}
7380 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7381 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7382
7383 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7384 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7385 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7386
7387 @smallexample
7388 @group
7389 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7390 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7391 .
7392
7393 r 1 V M * V R +
7394 @end group
7395 @end smallexample
7396
7397 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7398 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7399 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7400 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7401 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7402 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7403
7404 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7405 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7406 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7407
7408 @smallexample
7409 @group
7410 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7411 1: [0 .. 5] .
7412 .
7413
7414 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7415 @end group
7416 @end smallexample
7417
7418 @noindent
7419 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7420 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7421 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7422
7423 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7424 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7425
7426 @noindent
7427 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7428
7429 @smallexample
7430 @group
7431 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7432 . 2: 10
7433 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7434 .
7435
7436 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7437
7438 @end group
7439 @end smallexample
7440 @noindent
7441 @smallexample
7442 @group
7443 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7444 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7445 .
7446
7447 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7448 @end group
7449 @end smallexample
7450
7451 @noindent
7452 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7453
7454 @smallexample
7455 @group
7456 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7457 .
7458
7459 10 V M % s 2
7460 @end group
7461 @end smallexample
7462
7463 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7464 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7465 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7466 the right of it are nines.
7467
7468 @smallexample
7469 @group
7470 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7471 . .
7472
7473 9 V M a = v v
7474
7475 @end group
7476 @end smallexample
7477 @noindent
7478 @smallexample
7479 @group
7480 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7481 . .
7482
7483 V U * v v 1 |
7484 @end group
7485 @end smallexample
7486
7487 @noindent
7488 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7489 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7490 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7491 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7492 rightmost digit.
7493
7494 @smallexample
7495 @group
7496 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7497 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7498 .
7499
7500 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7501 @end group
7502 @end smallexample
7503
7504 @noindent
7505 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7506 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7507 digits that generated them.
7508
7509 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7510
7511 @smallexample
7512 @group
7513 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7514 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7515 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7516 .
7517
7518 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7519
7520 @end group
7521 @end smallexample
7522 @noindent
7523 @smallexample
7524 @group
7525 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7526 . .
7527
7528 V M * V R +
7529 @end group
7530 @end smallexample
7531
7532 @noindent
7533 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7534 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7535
7536 @smallexample
7537 @group
7538 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7539 . .
7540
7541 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7542 @end group
7543 @end smallexample
7544
7545 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7546 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7547
7548 @noindent
7549 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7550 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7551 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7552 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7553
7554 Here's a more correct method:
7555
7556 @smallexample
7557 @group
7558 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7559 . 1: 7
7560 .
7561
7562 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7563
7564 @end group
7565 @end smallexample
7566 @noindent
7567 @smallexample
7568 @group
7569 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7570 . .
7571
7572 V M a = V R *
7573 @end group
7574 @end smallexample
7575
7576 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7577 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7578
7579 @noindent
7580 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7581 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7582 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7583
7584 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7585 commands.
7586
7587 @smallexample
7588 @group
7589 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7590 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7591 . .
7592
7593 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7594
7595 @end group
7596 @end smallexample
7597 @noindent
7598 @smallexample
7599 @group
7600 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7601 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7602 . .
7603
7604 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7605 @end group
7606 @end smallexample
7607
7608 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7609 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7610
7611 @smallexample
7612 @group
7613 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7614 . . .
7615
7616 + 1 V M a < V R +
7617 @end group
7618 @end smallexample
7619
7620 @noindent
7621 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7622
7623 @smallexample
7624 @group
7625 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7626 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7627
7628 100 / 4 * P /
7629 @end group
7630 @end smallexample
7631
7632 @noindent
7633 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7634 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7635 not very efficient!
7636
7637 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7638 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7639
7640 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7641 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7642
7643 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7644 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7645
7646 @noindent
7647 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7648 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7649 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7650 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7651 @texline @math{\theta},
7652 @infoline @expr{theta},
7653 and see if @expr{x} and
7654 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7655 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7656 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7657 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7658 numbers surround an integer.
7659
7660 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7661 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7662 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7663 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7664 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7665
7666 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7667 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7668 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7669 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7670 Pick random @expr{x} and
7671 @texline @math{\theta},
7672 @infoline @expr{theta},
7673 compute
7674 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7675 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7676 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7677
7678 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7679 commands.
7680
7681 @smallexample
7682 @group
7683 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7684 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7685 .
7686
7687 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7688 @end group
7689 @end smallexample
7690
7691 @noindent
7692 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7693
7694 @smallexample
7695 @group
7696 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7697 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7698 .
7699
7700 m d V M C +
7701
7702 @end group
7703 @end smallexample
7704 @noindent
7705 @smallexample
7706 @group
7707 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7708 . . .
7709
7710 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7711 @end group
7712 @end smallexample
7713
7714 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7715 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7716 a random integer.
7717
7718 @smallexample
7719 @group
7720 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7721 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7722 . .
7723
7724 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7725
7726 @end group
7727 @end smallexample
7728 @noindent
7729 @smallexample
7730 @group
7731 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7732 . . .
7733
7734 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7735
7736 @end group
7737 @end smallexample
7738 @noindent
7739 @smallexample
7740 @group
7741 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7742 . .
7743
7744 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7745 @end group
7746 @end smallexample
7747
7748 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7749 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7750
7751 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7752 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7753
7754 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7755 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7756
7757 @noindent
7758 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7759
7760 @smallexample
7761 @group
7762 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7763 .
7764
7765 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7766 @end group
7767 @end smallexample
7768
7769 @noindent
7770 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7771 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7772 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7773 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7774
7775 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7776 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7777 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7778 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7779
7780 @smallexample
7781 @group
7782 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7783 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7784 . .
7785
7786 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7787
7788 @end group
7789 @end smallexample
7790 @noindent
7791 @smallexample
7792 @group
7793 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7794 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7795 .
7796
7797 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7798 @end group
7799 @end smallexample
7800
7801 @noindent
7802 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7803 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7804 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7805 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7806 plus its second argument.
7807
7808 @smallexample
7809 @group
7810 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7811 . .
7812
7813 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7814 @end group
7815 @end smallexample
7816
7817 @noindent
7818 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7819 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7820 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7821
7822 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7823 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7824 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7825 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7826 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7827 the operations are faster.
7828
7829 @smallexample
7830 @group
7831 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7832 . .
7833
7834 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7835 @end group
7836 @end smallexample
7837
7838 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7839 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7840 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7841 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7842
7843 @ifnottex
7844 @example
7845 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7846 @end example
7847 @end ifnottex
7848 @tex
7849 \turnoffactive
7850 \beforedisplay
7851 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7852 \afterdisplay
7853 @end tex
7854
7855 @noindent
7856 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7857 the distributive law yields
7858
7859 @ifnottex
7860 @example
7861 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7862 @end example
7863 @end ifnottex
7864 @tex
7865 \turnoffactive
7866 \beforedisplay
7867 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7868 \afterdisplay
7869 @end tex
7870
7871 @noindent
7872 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7873 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7874 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7875 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
7876
7877 @ifnottex
7878 @example
7879 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7880 @end example
7881 @end ifnottex
7882 @tex
7883 \turnoffactive
7884 \beforedisplay
7885 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n' $$
7886 \afterdisplay
7887 @end tex
7888
7889 @noindent
7890 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7891 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7892
7893 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7894 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7895 modulo some value @var{m}.
7896
7897 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7898 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7899
7900 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7901 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7902 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7903
7904 @smallexample
7905 @group
7906 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7907 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7908 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7909 ...
7910
7911 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7912 @end group
7913 @end smallexample
7914
7915 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7916 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7917 before nesting even begins.
7918
7919 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7920 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7921 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7922
7923 @smallexample
7924 @group
7925 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
7926 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7927 .
7928
7929 v t v u g f
7930 @end group
7931 @end smallexample
7932
7933 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7934 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7935 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7936
7937 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7938 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7939 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7940 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7941
7942 @smallexample
7943 @group
7944 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7945 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7946 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7947 ...
7948
7949 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7950 @end group
7951 @end smallexample
7952
7953 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7954
7955 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7956 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7957 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7958 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7959 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7960 Schwartz.)
7961
7962 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7963 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7964
7965 @noindent
7966 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7967 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7968
7969 @smallexample
7970 @group
7971 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7972 . . .
7973
7974 2 ^ P / c F
7975 @end group
7976 @end smallexample
7977
7978 @noindent
7979 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7980 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
7981 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
7982 irrational number to within 12 digits.
7983
7984 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
7985 precision slightly and try again:
7986
7987 @smallexample
7988 @group
7989 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
7990 . .
7991
7992 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
7993 @end group
7994 @end smallexample
7995
7996 @noindent
7997 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
7998 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
7999 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
8000 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
8001
8002 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
8003 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
8004 to the current precision before they begin.
8005
8006 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8007 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
8008
8009 @noindent
8010 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
8011 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
8012
8013 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
8014 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
8015 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are as just as big.
8016 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8017 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8018 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8019
8020 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8021 the input is infinite.
8022
8023 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8024 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8025 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8026 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8027 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8028
8029 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8030 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8031 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8032 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8033
8034 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8035 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8036
8037 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8038 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8039 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8040 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8041
8042 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8043 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8044
8045 @noindent
8046 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8047 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8048 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8049 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8050 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8051 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8052
8053 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8054 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8055 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8056 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8057
8058 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8059 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8060 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8061 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8062 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8063
8064 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8065 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8066
8067 @smallexample
8068 @group
8069 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8070 1: 17 .
8071 .
8072
8073 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8074 @end group
8075 @end smallexample
8076
8077 @noindent
8078 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8079
8080 @smallexample
8081 @group
8082 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8083 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8084 .
8085
8086 20" + 17 *
8087 @end group
8088 @end smallexample
8089
8090 @noindent
8091 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8092
8093 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8094 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8095
8096 @noindent
8097 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8098 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8099 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8100
8101 @smallexample
8102 @group
8103 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8104 . . .
8105
8106 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8107 @end group
8108 @end smallexample
8109
8110 @noindent
8111 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8112
8113 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8114 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8115 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8116 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8117 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8118
8119 @smallexample
8120 @group
8121 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8122 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8123 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8124 .
8125
8126 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8127 @end group
8128 @end smallexample
8129
8130 @noindent
8131 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8132
8133 @smallexample
8134 @group
8135 1: 242
8136 .
8137
8138 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8139 @end group
8140 @end smallexample
8141
8142 @noindent
8143 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8144
8145 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8146 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8147
8148 @noindent
8149 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8150 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8151 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8152 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8153 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8154 don't know the leap year rule.
8155
8156 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8157 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8158 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8159 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8160 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8161
8162 @smallexample
8163 @group
8164 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8165 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8166 .
8167
8168 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8169
8170 @end group
8171 @end smallexample
8172 @noindent
8173 @smallexample
8174 @group
8175 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8176 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8177 1: 1991 . .
8178 .
8179
8180 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8181 @end group
8182 @end smallexample
8183
8184 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8185 @noindent
8186 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8187 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8188 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8189 background information in that regard.)
8190
8191 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8192 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8193
8194 @noindent
8195 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8196 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8197
8198 @smallexample
8199 @group
8200 1: 1. 2: 1.
8201 . 1: 0.2
8202 .
8203
8204 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8205 @end group
8206 @end smallexample
8207
8208 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8209
8210 @smallexample
8211 @group
8212 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8213 . . .
8214
8215 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8216 @end group
8217 @end smallexample
8218
8219 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8220 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8221
8222 @smallexample
8223 @group
8224 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8225 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8226 1: 706.21 .
8227 .
8228
8229 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8230 @end group
8231 @end smallexample
8232
8233 @noindent
8234 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8235
8236 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8237 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8238
8239 @noindent
8240 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8241 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8242 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8243 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8244 but with no upper bound.
8245
8246 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8247
8248 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8249 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8250 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8251 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8252
8253 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8254 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8255 as a possible value.
8256
8257 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8258 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8259 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8260 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8261 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8262 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8263 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8264 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8265 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8266 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8267
8268 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8269 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8270
8271 @smallexample
8272 @group
8273 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8274 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8275 . .
8276
8277 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8278 @end group
8279 @end smallexample
8280
8281 @noindent
8282 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8283 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8284 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8285
8286 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8287 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8288 for different numbers.
8289
8290 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8291
8292 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8293 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8294
8295 @noindent
8296 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8297
8298 @smallexample
8299 @group
8300 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8301 . 811749612 .
8302 .
8303
8304 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8305 @end group
8306 @end smallexample
8307
8308 @noindent
8309 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8310 must not be prime.
8311
8312 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8313 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8314 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8315 use this method to test the second number.
8316
8317 @smallexample
8318 @group
8319 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8320 1: 15485863 .
8321 .
8322
8323 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8324 @end group
8325 @end smallexample
8326
8327 @noindent
8328 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8329 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8330
8331 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8332 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8333 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8334
8335 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8336 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8337 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8338 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8339
8340 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8341 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8342
8343 @noindent
8344 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8345 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8346 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8347
8348 @smallexample
8349 @group
8350 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8351 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8352 .
8353
8354 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8355
8356 @end group
8357 @end smallexample
8358 @noindent
8359 @smallexample
8360 @group
8361 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8362 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8363 .
8364
8365 x time @key{RET} +
8366 @end group
8367 @end smallexample
8368
8369 @noindent
8370 It will be just after six in the morning.
8371
8372 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8373 HMS form:
8374
8375 @smallexample
8376 @group
8377 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8378 . .
8379
8380 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8381 @end group
8382 @end smallexample
8383
8384 @noindent
8385 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8386 the actual number 3.14159...
8387
8388 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8389 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8390
8391 @noindent
8392 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8393 each.
8394
8395 @smallexample
8396 @group
8397 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8398 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8399 .
8400
8401 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8402
8403 @end group
8404 @end smallexample
8405 @noindent
8406 @smallexample
8407 @group
8408 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8409 .
8410
8411 17 *
8412 @end group
8413 @end smallexample
8414
8415 @noindent
8416 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8417
8418 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8419 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8420
8421 @noindent
8422 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8423
8424 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8425 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8426
8427 @noindent
8428 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8429 to the other?
8430
8431 @smallexample
8432 @group
8433 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8434 . .
8435
8436 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8437 @end group
8438 @end smallexample
8439
8440 @noindent
8441 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8442
8443 @smallexample
8444 @group
8445 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356 ns / ns 1: 0.81356
8446 2: 4.1 ns . .
8447 .
8448
8449 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} / u s
8450 @end group
8451 @end smallexample
8452
8453 @noindent
8454 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8455 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8456 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8457
8458 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8459 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8460
8461 @noindent
8462 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8463 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8464
8465 @smallexample
8466 @group
8467 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8468 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8469 .
8470
8471 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8472 @end group
8473 @end smallexample
8474
8475 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8476 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8477 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8478
8479 @smallexample
8480 @group
8481 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8482 . 1: 2 .
8483 .
8484
8485 u s 2 B
8486 @end group
8487 @end smallexample
8488
8489 @noindent
8490 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8491
8492 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8493 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8494
8495 @noindent
8496 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8497 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8498 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8499 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8500 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8501 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8502 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8503
8504 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8505 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8506
8507 @noindent
8508 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8509 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8510 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8511 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8512 familiar form.
8513
8514 @smallexample
8515 @group
8516 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8517 . .
8518
8519 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8520
8521 @end group
8522 @end smallexample
8523 @noindent
8524 @smallexample
8525 @group
8526 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: (x - 1.19023) (x + 1.19023) x
8527 . .
8528
8529 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8530
8531 @end group
8532 @end smallexample
8533 @noindent
8534 @smallexample
8535 @group
8536 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8537 . .
8538
8539 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8540 @end group
8541 @end smallexample
8542
8543 @noindent
8544 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8545 same as the original polynomial.
8546
8547 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8548 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8549
8550 @smallexample
8551 @group
8552 1: x sin(pi x) 1: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8553 . .
8554
8555 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8556
8557 @end group
8558 @end smallexample
8559 @noindent
8560 @smallexample
8561 @group
8562 1: [y, 1]
8563 2: (sin(pi x) - pi x cos(pi x)) / pi^2
8564 .
8565
8566 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8567
8568 @end group
8569 @end smallexample
8570 @noindent
8571 @smallexample
8572 @group
8573 1: [(sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2, (sin(pi) - pi cos(pi)) / pi^2]
8574 .
8575
8576 V M $ @key{RET}
8577
8578 @end group
8579 @end smallexample
8580 @noindent
8581 @smallexample
8582 @group
8583 1: (sin(pi y) - pi y cos(pi y)) / pi^2 + (pi cos(pi) - sin(pi)) / pi^2
8584 .
8585
8586 V R -
8587
8588 @end group
8589 @end smallexample
8590 @noindent
8591 @smallexample
8592 @group
8593 1: (sin(3.14159 y) - 3.14159 y cos(3.14159 y)) / 9.8696 - 0.3183
8594 .
8595
8596 =
8597
8598 @end group
8599 @end smallexample
8600 @noindent
8601 @smallexample
8602 @group
8603 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8604 .
8605
8606 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8607 @end group
8608 @end smallexample
8609
8610 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8611 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8612
8613 @noindent
8614 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8615 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8616 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8617 coefficients. Here's one way:
8618
8619 @smallexample
8620 @group
8621 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8622 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8623 . .
8624
8625 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8626
8627 @end group
8628 @end smallexample
8629 @noindent
8630 @smallexample
8631 @group
8632 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8633 . .
8634
8635 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8636 @end group
8637 @end smallexample
8638
8639 @noindent
8640 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8641 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8642
8643 @smallexample
8644 @group
8645 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8646 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8647 .
8648
8649 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8650
8651 @end group
8652 @end smallexample
8653 @noindent
8654 @smallexample
8655 @group
8656 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8657 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8658 .
8659
8660 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8661 @end group
8662 @end smallexample
8663
8664 @noindent
8665 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8666 same thing.
8667
8668 @smallexample
8669 @group
8670 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8671 . . .
8672
8673 * .1 * 3 /
8674 @end group
8675 @end smallexample
8676
8677 @noindent
8678 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8679
8680 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8681 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8682
8683 @noindent
8684 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 @group
8688 ___
8689 2 + V 2
8690 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: --------
8691 . ___
8692 1 + V 2
8693
8694 .
8695
8696 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8697 @end group
8698 @end smallexample
8699
8700 @noindent
8701 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8702
8703 @smallexample
8704 @group
8705 ___ ___
8706 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8707 .
8708
8709 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8710
8711 @end group
8712 @end smallexample
8713 @noindent
8714 @smallexample
8715 @group
8716 ___ ___
8717 1: 2 + V 2 - 2 1: V 2
8718 . .
8719
8720 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c a s
8721 @end group
8722 @end smallexample
8723
8724 @noindent
8725 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8726 second step.)
8727
8728 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8729 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8730 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8731
8732 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8733 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8734
8735 @noindent
8736 Here is the rule set:
8737
8738 @smallexample
8739 @group
8740 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8741 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8742 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8743 @end group
8744 @end smallexample
8745
8746 @noindent
8747 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8748 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8749 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8750 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8751 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8752 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8753 numbers.
8754
8755 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8756 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8757 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8758 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8759 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8760
8761 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8762 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8763 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8764 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8765 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8766 function.
8767
8768 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8769 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8770
8771 @noindent
8772 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8773 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8774 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8775 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8776 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8777 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8778 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8779
8780 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8781 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8782 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8783 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8784 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8785 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8786 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8787 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8788 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8789
8790 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8791 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8792
8793 @noindent
8794 @ignore
8795 @starindex
8796 @end ignore
8797 @tindex seq
8798 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8799
8800 @smallexample
8801 @group
8802 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8803 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8804 @end group
8805 @end smallexample
8806
8807 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8808 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8809
8810 @example
8811 seq( 3, 1)
8812 seq(10, 2)
8813 seq( 5, 3)
8814 seq(16, 4)
8815 seq( 8, 5)
8816 seq( 4, 6)
8817 seq( 2, 7)
8818 seq( 1, 8)
8819 @end example
8820
8821 @noindent
8822 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8823
8824 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8825
8826 @smallexample
8827 @group
8828 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8829 seq(1, c) := c,
8830 ... ]
8831 @end group
8832 @end smallexample
8833
8834 @noindent
8835 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8836 as the result.
8837
8838 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8839
8840 @smallexample
8841 @group
8842 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8843 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8844 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8845 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8846 @end group
8847 @end smallexample
8848
8849 @noindent
8850 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8851
8852 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8853 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8854 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8855 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8856
8857 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8858 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8859 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8860 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8861 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8862
8863 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8864 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8865
8866 @noindent
8867 @ignore
8868 @starindex
8869 @end ignore
8870 @tindex nterms
8871 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8872 be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8873 is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8874
8875 @smallexample
8876 @group
8877 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8878 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8879 @end group
8880 @end smallexample
8881
8882 @noindent
8883 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8884 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8885 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8886
8887 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8888 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8889
8890 @noindent
8891 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8892
8893 @smallexample
8894 @group
8895 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8896 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8897 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8898 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8899 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8900 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8901 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8902 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8903 @end group
8904 @end smallexample
8905
8906 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8907 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8908 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8909 say, @code{O}, first.
8910
8911 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8912 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8913 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8914 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8915 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8916
8917 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O.
8918 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8919 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8920 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8921
8922 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8923
8924 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8925 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8926 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8927
8928 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8929 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8930 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8931 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8932 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8933
8934 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8935
8936 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8937 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8938 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8939 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8940 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8941 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8942 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8943 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8944 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8945 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8946 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8947
8948 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
8949 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8950 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8951 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8952 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8953 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8954 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8955 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8956 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8957 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8958 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8959 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8960 in Lisp.)
8961
8962 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8963 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8964
8965 @noindent
8966 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8967 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8968 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8969 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8970 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8971
8972 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8973 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8974
8975 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8976 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8977
8978 @noindent
8979 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8980 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
8981
8982 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
8983 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
8984
8985 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
8986 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
8987 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
8988
8989 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
8990 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
8991
8992 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8993 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
8994
8995 @noindent
8996 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
8997 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
8998
8999 @noindent
9000 Computing
9001 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
9002 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
9003
9004 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
9005
9006 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
9007
9008 @noindent
9009 Computing the logarithm:
9010
9011 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
9012
9013 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9014
9015 @noindent
9016 Computing the vector of integers:
9017
9018 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9019 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9020 from the stack.)
9021
9022 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9023 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9024 next command.)
9025
9026 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9027
9028 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9029 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9030
9031 @noindent
9032 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9033
9034 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9035 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9036
9037 @smallexample
9038 @group
9039 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9040 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9041 . .
9042
9043 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9044 @end group
9045 @end smallexample
9046
9047 @noindent
9048 This answer is quite accurate.
9049
9050 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9051 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9052
9053 @noindent
9054 Here is the matrix:
9055
9056 @example
9057 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9058 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9059 @end example
9060
9061 @noindent
9062 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9063 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9064
9065 @example
9066 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9067 @end example
9068
9069 @noindent
9070 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9071 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9072 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9073 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9074 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9075 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9076 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9077 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9078
9079 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9080 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9081
9082 @noindent
9083 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9084 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9085 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9086
9087 @smallexample
9088 @group
9089 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9090 . 1: 4
9091 .
9092
9093 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9094 @end group
9095 @end smallexample
9096
9097 @noindent
9098 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9099 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9100 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9101 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9102 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9103 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9104 loop counter exceeds 4.
9105
9106 @smallexample
9107 @group
9108 2: 31 3: 31
9109 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9110 . 1: 4.02724519544
9111 .
9112
9113 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9114 @end group
9115 @end smallexample
9116
9117 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9118 harmonic number is 4.02.
9119
9120 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9121 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9122
9123 @noindent
9124 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9125 the formula
9126 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9127 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9128
9129 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9130 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9131 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9132 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9133 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9134 just for purposes of illustration.)
9135
9136 @smallexample
9137 @group
9138 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9139 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9140 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9141 .
9142
9143 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9144
9145 @end group
9146 @end smallexample
9147 @noindent
9148 @smallexample
9149 @group
9150 2: 4.5
9151 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9152 .
9153
9154 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9155 @end group
9156 @end smallexample
9157
9158 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9159 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9160 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9161 repetitions are done.)
9162
9163 @smallexample
9164 @group
9165 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9166 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9167 1: 4.5 .
9168 .
9169
9170 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9171 @end group
9172 @end smallexample
9173
9174 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9175 old one to see if we've converged.
9176
9177 @smallexample
9178 @group
9179 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9180 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9181 1: 4.5 .
9182 .
9183
9184 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9185 @end group
9186 @end smallexample
9187
9188 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9189 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9190
9191 @smallexample
9192 @group
9193 2: 5.26345856348
9194 1: 0.499999999997
9195 .
9196
9197 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9198 @end group
9199 @end smallexample
9200
9201 Let's test the new definition again:
9202
9203 @smallexample
9204 @group
9205 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9206 1: 1 .
9207 .
9208
9209 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9210 @end group
9211 @end smallexample
9212
9213 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9214
9215 @example
9216 @group
9217 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9218 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9219 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9220 Z >
9221 Z '
9222 C-x )
9223 @end group
9224 @end example
9225
9226 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9227 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9228 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9229 to see how to use it.
9230
9231 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9232 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9233 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9234 @xref{Root Finding}.
9235
9236 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9237 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9238
9239 @noindent
9240 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9241 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9242 reduce the problem using
9243 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9244 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9245 on to compute
9246 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9247 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9248 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9249 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9250
9251 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9252 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9253 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9254 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9255 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9256 just for purposes of illustration.)
9257
9258 @smallexample
9259 @group
9260 1: 1. 1: 1.
9261 . .
9262
9263 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9264 @end group
9265 @end smallexample
9266
9267 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9268 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9269
9270 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9271 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9272 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9273 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9274
9275 @smallexample
9276 @group
9277 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9278 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9279 1: 5 .
9280 .
9281
9282 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9283 @end group
9284 @end smallexample
9285
9286 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9287 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9288 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9289 minus the adjustment factor.
9290
9291 @smallexample
9292 @group
9293 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9294 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9295 . .
9296
9297 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9298 @end group
9299 @end smallexample
9300
9301 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9302 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9303 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9304
9305 @smallexample
9306 @group
9307 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9308 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9309 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9310 . . 1: 36.
9311 .
9312
9313 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9314
9315 @end group
9316 @end smallexample
9317 @noindent
9318 @smallexample
9319 @group
9320 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9321 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9322 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9323 . .
9324
9325 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9326 @end group
9327 @end smallexample
9328
9329 This is the value of
9330 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9331 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9332 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9333 a higher precision:
9334
9335 @smallexample
9336 @group
9337 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9338 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9339
9340 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9341 @end group
9342 @end smallexample
9343
9344 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9345
9346 @example
9347 @group
9348 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9349 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9350 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9351 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9352 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9353 2 Z )
9354 Z '
9355 C-x )
9356 @end group
9357 @end example
9358
9359 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9360 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9361
9362 @noindent
9363 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9364 a term like
9365 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9366 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9367 Taking the derivative of a constant
9368 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9369 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9370 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9371
9372 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9373 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9374 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9375 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9376 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9377 just for purposes of illustration.)
9378
9379 @smallexample
9380 @group
9381 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9382 1: 6 2: 0
9383 . 1: 6
9384 .
9385
9386 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9387 @end group
9388 @end smallexample
9389
9390 @noindent
9391 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9392
9393 @smallexample
9394 @group
9395 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9396 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9397 . 1: 1 .
9398 .
9399
9400 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9401 @end group
9402 @end smallexample
9403
9404 @noindent
9405 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9406 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9407 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9408
9409 @smallexample
9410 @group
9411 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9412 . . .
9413
9414 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9415 @end group
9416 @end smallexample
9417
9418 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9419 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9420
9421 @smallexample
9422 @group
9423 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9424 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9425 . .
9426
9427 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9428
9429 @end group
9430 @end smallexample
9431 @noindent
9432 @smallexample
9433 @group
9434 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9435 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9436 .
9437
9438 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9439 @end group
9440 @end smallexample
9441
9442 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9443
9444 @example
9445 @group
9446 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9447 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9448 a d x @key{RET}
9449 1 Z ) r 1
9450 Z '
9451 C-x )
9452
9453 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9454 @end group
9455 @end example
9456
9457 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9458 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9459
9460 @noindent
9461 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9462 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9463 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9464 sure the stack comes out right.
9465
9466 @smallexample
9467 @group
9468 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9469 1: 2 . 1: 2
9470 . .
9471
9472 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9473 @end group
9474 @end smallexample
9475
9476 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9477 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9478 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9479 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9480
9481 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9482 below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9483
9484 @smallexample
9485 @group
9486 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9487 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9488 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9489 1: 2 .
9490 .
9491
9492 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9493
9494 @end group
9495 @end smallexample
9496 @noindent
9497 @smallexample
9498 @group
9499 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9500 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9501 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9502 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9503 . . .
9504
9505 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9506 @end group
9507 @end smallexample
9508
9509 @noindent
9510 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9511 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9512
9513 @smallexample
9514 @group
9515 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9516 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9517 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9518 . 1: 2 .
9519 .
9520
9521 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9522
9523 @end group
9524 @end smallexample
9525 @noindent
9526 @smallexample
9527 @group
9528 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9529 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9530 . .
9531
9532 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9533 @end group
9534 @end smallexample
9535
9536 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9537 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9538 the right answers.
9539
9540 Here's the full program once again:
9541
9542 @example
9543 @group
9544 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9545 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9546 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9547 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9548 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9549 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9550 Z ]
9551 Z ]
9552 C-x )
9553 @end group
9554 @end example
9555
9556 You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9557 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9558 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9559 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9560 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9561
9562 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9563 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9564
9565 @noindent
9566 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9567 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9568
9569 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9570 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9571
9572 @smallexample
9573 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9574 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9575 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9576 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9577 C-c C-c
9578 @end smallexample
9579
9580 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9581
9582 @smallexample
9583 @group
9584 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9585 1: 2 . .
9586 .
9587
9588 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9589 @end group
9590 @end smallexample
9591
9592 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9593 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9594 the last rule.
9595
9596 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9597 @tex
9598 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9599 @end tex
9600
9601 @c [reference]
9602
9603 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9604 @chapter Introduction
9605
9606 @noindent
9607 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9608 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9609 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9610
9611 @c [when-split]
9612 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9613
9614 @menu
9615 * Basic Commands::
9616 * Help Commands::
9617 * Stack Basics::
9618 * Numeric Entry::
9619 * Algebraic Entry::
9620 * Quick Calculator::
9621 * Prefix Arguments::
9622 * Undo::
9623 * Error Messages::
9624 * Multiple Calculators::
9625 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9626 @end menu
9627
9628 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9629 @section Basic Commands
9630
9631 @noindent
9632 @pindex calc
9633 @pindex calc-mode
9634 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9635 @cindex Running the Calculator
9636 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9637 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @samp{*Calculator*}
9638 and @samp{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9639 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9640 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9641 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9642 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9643 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9644 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9645 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9646 to turn the trail window off, but the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9647 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9648
9649 @kindex C-x * c
9650 @kindex C-x * *
9651 @ignore
9652 @mindex @null
9653 @end ignore
9654 In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9655 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9656 is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9657 in its Keypad mode.
9658
9659 @kindex x
9660 @kindex M-x
9661 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9662 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9663 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9664 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9665 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9666 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9667 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9668 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9669
9670 @cindex Extensions module
9671 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9672 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9673 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9674 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9675 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9676 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9677 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9678 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9679 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9680 extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9681 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9682
9683 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9684 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9685 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9686 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9687 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9688 to auto-load the Calculator.
9689
9690 @kindex C-x * b
9691 @pindex full-calc
9692 If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9693 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9694 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9695 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9696 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9697 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9698 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9699
9700 @kindex C-x * o
9701 @pindex calc-other-window
9702 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9703 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9704 window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9705 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9706 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9707 @kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9708
9709 @ignore
9710 @mindex C-x * q
9711 @end ignore
9712 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9713 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9714 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9715 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9716
9717 @ignore
9718 @mindex C-x * k
9719 @end ignore
9720 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9721 @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9722 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9723 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9724
9725 @kindex q
9726 @pindex calc-quit
9727 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9728 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9729 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9730 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9731 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9732 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9733 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9734 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9735 Calculator on and off.
9736
9737 @kindex C-x * x
9738 The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9739 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9740 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9741
9742 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9743 @pindex calc-refresh
9744 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9745 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9746 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9747 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9748 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9749
9750 @ignore
9751 @mindex o
9752 @end ignore
9753 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9754 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9755
9756 @kindex <
9757 @kindex >
9758 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9759 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9760 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9761 @cindex Scrolling
9762 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9763 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9764 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9765 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9766 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9767 window whenever it can.)
9768
9769 @kindex @{
9770 @kindex @}
9771 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9772 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9773 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9774 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9775 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9776 height of the Calc window.
9777
9778 @kindex C-x * 0
9779 @pindex calc-reset
9780 The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9781 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9782 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9783 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9784 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9785 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9786 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9787 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9788 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9789 negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9790 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9791
9792 @pindex calc-version
9793 The @kbd{M-x calc-version} command displays the current version number
9794 of Calc and the name of the person who installed it on your system.
9795 (This information is also present in the @samp{*Calc Trail*} buffer,
9796 and in the output of the @kbd{h h} command.)
9797
9798 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9799 @section Help Commands
9800
9801 @noindent
9802 @cindex Help commands
9803 @kindex ?
9804 @pindex calc-help
9805 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9806 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs'
9807 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9808 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9809 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9810 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9811
9812 @kindex h h
9813 @pindex calc-full-help
9814 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9815 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9816 summary of Calc keystrokes.
9817
9818 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9819 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9820 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9821
9822 @kindex h i
9823 @kindex C-x * i
9824 @kindex i
9825 @pindex calc-info
9826 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9827 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9828 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9829 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9830 manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9831 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9832 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9833 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9834 different command in a future version of Calc.
9835
9836 @kindex h t
9837 @kindex C-x * t
9838 @pindex calc-tutorial
9839 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9840 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9841 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9842 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9843 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9844 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9845 The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9846 all times).
9847
9848 @kindex h s
9849 @kindex C-x * s
9850 @pindex calc-info-summary
9851 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9852 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9853 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9854
9855 @kindex h k
9856 @pindex calc-describe-key
9857 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9858 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9859 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9860 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9861 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9862 node indicated by the index.
9863
9864 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9865 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9866 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9867 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9868
9869 @kindex h c
9870 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9871 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9872 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9873 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9874 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9875 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9876 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9877 gives the description:
9878
9879 @smallexample
9880 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9881 @end smallexample
9882
9883 @noindent
9884 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9885 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9886 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9887 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9888 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9889
9890 @kindex h f
9891 @pindex calc-describe-function
9892 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9893 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9894 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9895 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9896 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9897 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9898 @samp{=>}.
9899
9900 @kindex h v
9901 @pindex calc-describe-variable
9902 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9903 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9904 @code{PlotRejects}.
9905
9906 @kindex h b
9907 @pindex describe-bindings
9908 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9909 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9910 listed.
9911
9912 @kindex h n
9913 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9914 the ``news'' or change history of Calc. This is kept in the file
9915 @file{README}, which Calc looks for in the same directory as the Calc
9916 source files.
9917
9918 @kindex h C-c
9919 @kindex h C-d
9920 @kindex h C-w
9921 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9922 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9923 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9924 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9925
9926 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9927 @section Stack Basics
9928
9929 @noindent
9930 @cindex Stack basics
9931 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9932 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9933 Tutorial}.
9934
9935 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9936 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9937 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9938 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9939 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9940 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9941 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
9942 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9943
9944 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9945 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9946 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9947 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9948 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9949 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9950
9951 @kindex d l
9952 @pindex calc-line-numbering
9953 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9954 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9955 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9956 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9957 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9958
9959 @kindex o
9960 @pindex calc-realign
9961 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9962 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9963 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9964 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9965
9966 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9967 two consecutive numbers.
9968 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9969 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9970 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9971 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9972
9973 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9974 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9975 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9976 commands.
9977
9978 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9979 @section Numeric Entry
9980
9981 @noindent
9982 @kindex 0-9
9983 @kindex .
9984 @kindex e
9985 @cindex Numeric entry
9986 @cindex Entering numbers
9987 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
9988 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
9989 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
9990 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
9991 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
9992
9993 @cindex Minus signs
9994 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
9995 @kindex _
9996 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
9997 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
9998 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
9999 different keys for these operations, respectively:
10000 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10001 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10002 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10003 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10004 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10005 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10006 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10007
10008 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10009 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10010 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10011 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10012
10013 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10014
10015 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10016 @section Algebraic Entry
10017
10018 @noindent
10019 @kindex '
10020 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10021 @cindex Algebraic notation
10022 @cindex Formulas, entering
10023 Calculations can also be entered in algebraic form. This is accomplished
10024 by typing the apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in
10025 standard format:
10026
10027 @example
10028 ' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10029 @end example
10030
10031 @noindent
10032 This will compute
10033 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10034 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10035 and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10036 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10037 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10038 clear previous results off the stack.
10039
10040 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10041 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do this
10042 would be to use the full Emacs cursor motion and editing keys, which are
10043 available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10044
10045 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10046 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10047 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10048 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10049
10050 @kindex m a
10051 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10052 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10053 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10054 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10055 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10056 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10057 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10058 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10059 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10060 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10061 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10062
10063 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10064 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10065 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10066 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10067 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10068
10069 @kindex m t
10070 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10071 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10072 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10073 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10074 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10075 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10076 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10077 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10078 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10079 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10080 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10081 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10082 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10083
10084 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10085 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10086 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10087
10088 @kindex $
10089 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10090 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10091 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10092 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10093 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10094 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10095 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10096 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10097 first character in the new formula.
10098
10099 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10100 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10101 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10102 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10103 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10104 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10105 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10106
10107 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10108 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10109 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10110 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10111 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10112 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10113
10114 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10115 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10116 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10117 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10118 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10119 @key{TAB} key.
10120
10121 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10122 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10123 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10124 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10125
10126 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10127 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables the default simplifications
10128 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10129 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10130 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10131 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10132
10133 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10134 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10135
10136 @noindent
10137 @kindex C-x * q
10138 @pindex quick-calc
10139 @cindex Quick Calculator
10140 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10141 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10142 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10143 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10144 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10145
10146 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10147 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10148 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10149 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10150 forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10151 @samp{$} as the formula.
10152
10153 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10154 session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @code{*Calculator*}
10155 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10156 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10157 Calculator refers to the @code{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10158 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10159 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10160 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10161
10162 If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10163 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10164
10165 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10166 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10167 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10168 to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10169 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10170 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10171
10172 If you finish your formula by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead
10173 of @key{RET}, the result is inserted immediately into the current
10174 buffer rather than going into the kill ring.
10175
10176 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10177 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10178 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10179 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10180 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10181 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10182
10183 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10184 the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10185 the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10186 an ASCII character.
10187
10188 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10189 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10190 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10191 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10192 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10193 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10194 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10195
10196 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10197 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10198 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10199 small calculations.
10200
10201 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10202 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10203
10204 @noindent
10205 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10206 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10207 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10208 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10209 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10210
10211 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10212 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10213 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10214 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10215 on the entire stack.
10216
10217 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10218 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10219 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10220 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10221 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10222 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10223 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10224 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10225 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10226 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10227 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10228 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10229 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10230 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10231 argument for some other purpose.
10232
10233 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10234 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10235 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10236 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10237
10238 @kindex ~
10239 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10240 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10241 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10242 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10243 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10244 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10245
10246 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10247 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10248
10249 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10250 @section Undoing Mistakes
10251
10252 @noindent
10253 @kindex U
10254 @kindex C-_
10255 @pindex calc-undo
10256 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10257 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10258 @cindex Errors, undoing
10259 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10260 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10261 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10262 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10263 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10264 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10265 specified number of operations. The undo history is cleared only by the
10266 @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is
10267 synonymous with @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this
10268 also clears the undo history.)
10269
10270 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10271 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10272 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10273
10274 @kindex D
10275 @pindex calc-redo
10276 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10277 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10278 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10279 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10280 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10281 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10282 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10283 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10284
10285 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10286 @pindex calc-last-args
10287 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10288 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10289 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10290 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10291 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10292 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10293 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10294 onto the stack.
10295
10296 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10297 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10298
10299 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10300 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10301
10302 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10303
10304 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10305 @section Error Messages
10306
10307 @noindent
10308 @kindex w
10309 @pindex calc-why
10310 @cindex Errors, messages
10311 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10312 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10313 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10314 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10315 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10316 reasons for this to happen.
10317
10318 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10319 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10320 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10321 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10322 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10323 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10324 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10325
10326 @kindex d w
10327 @pindex calc-auto-why
10328 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10329 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10330 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10331 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10332 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10333 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10334
10335 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10336 @section Multiple Calculators
10337
10338 @noindent
10339 @pindex another-calc
10340 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10341 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10342 is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @samp{*Calculator*}
10343 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10344 form @samp{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10345 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10346 this would ordinarily never be done.
10347
10348 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10349 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10350 Calculator buffer.
10351
10352 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10353 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10354 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10355 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10356 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10357 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10358
10359 There is only one trail buffer, @samp{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10360 Calculator buffers.
10361
10362 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10363 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10364
10365 @noindent
10366 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10367 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10368
10369 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10370 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10371
10372 @menu
10373 * Autoloading Problems::
10374 * Recursion Depth::
10375 * Caches::
10376 * Debugging Calc::
10377 @end menu
10378
10379 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10380 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10381
10382 @noindent
10383 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10384 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10385 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10386 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10387 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10388
10389 @kindex C-x * L
10390 @pindex calc-load-everything
10391 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10392 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10393 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10394 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10395
10396 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10397 @subsection Recursion Depth
10398
10399 @noindent
10400 @kindex M
10401 @kindex I M
10402 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10403 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10404 @cindex Recursion depth
10405 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10406 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10407 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10408 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10409 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10410 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10411 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10412 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10413 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10414 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10415
10416 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10417 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10418 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10419 The default value is 1000.
10420
10421 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10422 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10423
10424 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10425 @subsection Caches
10426
10427 @noindent
10428 @cindex Caches
10429 @cindex Flushing caches
10430 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10431 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10432 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10433 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10434 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10435 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10436 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10437 @cpiover{4} and
10438 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10439 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10440 The visible effect of caching is that
10441 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10442 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10443 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10444 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10445
10446 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10447 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10448 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10449 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10450 The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10451 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10452
10453 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10454 @subsection Debugging Calc
10455
10456 @noindent
10457 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10458 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10459 your own Calc commands.
10460
10461 @kindex Z T
10462 @pindex calc-timing
10463 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10464 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10465 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10466 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10467 accurate only to within one second.
10468
10469 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10470 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10471 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10472 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10473 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10474 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10475 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10476 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10477 to execute the whole macro.
10478
10479 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10480 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10481 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10482 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10483 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10484 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10485 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10486
10487 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10488 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10489 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10490 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10491 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10492 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10493 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10494
10495 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10496 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10497 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10498 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10499 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10500 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10501 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10502 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10503 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10504 will be lost.
10505
10506 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10507 @chapter Data Types
10508
10509 @noindent
10510 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10511 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10512 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10513 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10514
10515 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10516 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10517 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10518 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10519 arbitrarily:@: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10520 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10521 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10522
10523 @menu
10524 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10525 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10526 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10527 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10528 * Infinities::
10529 * Vectors and Matrices::
10530 * Strings::
10531 * HMS Forms::
10532 * Date Forms::
10533 * Modulo Forms::
10534 * Error Forms::
10535 * Interval Forms::
10536 * Incomplete Objects::
10537 * Variables::
10538 * Formulas::
10539 @end menu
10540
10541 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10542 @section Integers
10543
10544 @noindent
10545 @cindex Integers
10546 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10547 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10548 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10549 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10550 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10551 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10552
10553 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10554 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10555 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10556 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10557
10558 @kindex #
10559 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10560 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10561 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10562 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10563 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10564 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10565 number, the current display radix is used.
10566
10567 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10568 @section Fractions
10569
10570 @noindent
10571 @cindex Fractions
10572 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10573 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10574 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10575 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10576 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10577 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10578 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10579
10580 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10581 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10582 display formats.
10583
10584 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10585 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10586 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10587
10588 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10589 @section Floats
10590
10591 @noindent
10592 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10593 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10594 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10595 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10596 range of acceptable values is from
10597 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10598 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10599 (inclusive) to
10600 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10601 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10602 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10603
10604 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10605 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10606 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10607 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10608 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10609 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10610 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10611 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10612 would have overflowed!)
10613
10614 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10615 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10616 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10617 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10618
10619 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10620 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10621 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10622 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10623 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10624 or 0.235.
10625
10626 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10627 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10628 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10629 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10630
10631 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10632 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10633 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10634 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10635 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10636 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10637 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10638 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10639 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10640 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10641 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10642 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10643 way.
10644
10645 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10646 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10647 float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10648 decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10649 was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10650 current precison. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10651 is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10652 Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10653 than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10654 defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10655 use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10656 notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10657 power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10658 the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10659 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10660 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10661
10662 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10663 @section Complex Numbers
10664
10665 @noindent
10666 @cindex Complex numbers
10667 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10668 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10669 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10670 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10671 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10672 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10673
10674 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10675 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10676 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10677 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10678 @texline @math{\theta}
10679 @infoline @var{theta}
10680 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10681 @texline @math{\theta}
10682 @infoline @var{theta}
10683 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10684 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10685 in radians.
10686
10687 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10688 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10689
10690 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10691 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10692 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10693 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10694 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10695
10696 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10697 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10698 number.
10699
10700 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10701 @section Infinities
10702
10703 @noindent
10704 @cindex Infinity
10705 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10706 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10707 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10708 @vindex inf
10709 @vindex uinf
10710 @vindex nan
10711 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10712 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10713 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10714 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10715 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10716 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10717 entered using algebraic entry.
10718
10719 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10720 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10721 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10722 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10723 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10724 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10725 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10726 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10727 @texline @math{e^x}
10728 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10729 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10730 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10731 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10732 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10733
10734 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10735 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10736 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10737 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10738 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10739 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10740 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10741 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10742 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10743 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10744 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10745
10746 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10747 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10748 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10749 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10750 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10751 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10752 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10753 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10754 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10755 some cases.
10756
10757 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10758 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10759 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10760 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10761 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10762 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10763 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10764 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10765 notation.
10766
10767 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10768 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10769 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10770 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10771 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10772 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10773 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10774 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10775 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10776 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10777 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10778 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10779 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10780 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10781 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10782 (as described above).
10783
10784 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10785 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10786
10787 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10788 @section Vectors and Matrices
10789
10790 @noindent
10791 @cindex Vectors
10792 @cindex Plain vectors
10793 @cindex Matrices
10794 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10795 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10796 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10797 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10798 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10799
10800 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10801 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
10802 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10803 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10804 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10805 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10806 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10807 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10808 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10809 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10810 this case.
10811
10812 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10813 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10814 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10815 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10816 of its elements.
10817
10818 @ignore
10819 @starindex
10820 @end ignore
10821 @tindex vec
10822 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10823 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10824 @texline @math{n\times m}
10825 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10826 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10827 from 1 to @samp{n}.
10828
10829 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10830 @section Strings
10831
10832 @noindent
10833 @kindex "
10834 @cindex Strings
10835 @cindex Character strings
10836 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10837 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10838 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10839 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10840 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10841 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10842
10843 @example
10844 @group
10845 \a 7 \^@@ 0
10846 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10847 \e 27 \^[ 27
10848 \f 12 \^\\ 28
10849 \n 10 \^] 29
10850 \r 13 \^^ 30
10851 \t 9 \^_ 31
10852 \^? 127
10853 @end group
10854 @end example
10855
10856 @noindent
10857 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10858 character from its ASCII code.
10859
10860 @kindex d "
10861 @pindex calc-display-strings
10862 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10863 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10864 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10865 instead.
10866
10867 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10868 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10869 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10870 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10871 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10872 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10873
10874 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10875 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10876 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10877
10878 @ignore
10879 @starindex
10880 @end ignore
10881 @tindex string
10882 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10883 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10884 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10885 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10886 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10887 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10888 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10889 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10890 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10891
10892 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10893 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10894 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10895 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10896
10897 @ignore
10898 @starindex
10899 @end ignore
10900 @tindex bstring
10901 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10902 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10903 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10904 character in the string.
10905
10906 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10907 @section HMS Forms
10908
10909 @noindent
10910 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10911 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10912 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10913 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10914 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10915 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10916 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10917 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10918
10919 @kindex @@
10920 @ignore
10921 @mindex @null
10922 @end ignore
10923 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
10924 @ignore
10925 @mindex @null
10926 @end ignore
10927 @kindex " (HMS forms)
10928 @ignore
10929 @mindex @null
10930 @end ignore
10931 @kindex h (HMS forms)
10932 @ignore
10933 @mindex @null
10934 @end ignore
10935 @kindex o (HMS forms)
10936 @ignore
10937 @mindex @null
10938 @end ignore
10939 @kindex m (HMS forms)
10940 @ignore
10941 @mindex @null
10942 @end ignore
10943 @kindex s (HMS forms)
10944 The default format for HMS values is
10945 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10946 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10947 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10948 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10949 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10950 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10951 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10952 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10953 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10954 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10955 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10956 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10957
10958 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10959 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10960 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10961 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10962
10963 @pindex calc-time
10964 @cindex Time of day
10965 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10966 the stack as an HMS form.
10967
10968 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10969 @section Date Forms
10970
10971 @noindent
10972 @cindex Date forms
10973 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10974 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10975 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10976 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10977 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10978 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10979 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10980
10981 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
10982 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
10983 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
10984 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
10985 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
10986
10987 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
10988 of days since midnight on the morning of January 1 of the year 1 AD.
10989 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
10990 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
10991 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991>}
10992 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
10993 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
10994 time can be stored without roundoff error.
10995
10996 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
10997 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
10998 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
10999 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11000 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11001 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11002 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11003 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11004 never an issue for them.
11005
11006 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11007 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11008 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11009
11010 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11011 year numbers represent years BC. Calc uses a combination of the
11012 Gregorian and Julian calendars, following the history of Great
11013 Britain and the British colonies. This is the same calendar that
11014 is used by the @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations.
11015
11016 @cindex Julian calendar
11017 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11018 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11019 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the gradual
11020 drift caused by the lack of leap years in the calendar used
11021 until that time. The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in
11022 all years divisible by four. After some initial confusion, the
11023 calendar was adopted around the year we call 8 AD. Some centuries
11024 later it became apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was
11025 itself not quite right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the
11026 Gregorian calendar, which added the new rule that years divisible
11027 by 100, but not by 400, were not to be considered leap years
11028 despite being divisible by four. Many countries delayed adoption
11029 of the Gregorian calendar because of religious differences;
11030 in Britain it was put off until the year 1752, by which time
11031 the Julian calendar had fallen eleven days behind the true
11032 seasons. So the switch to the Gregorian calendar in early
11033 September 1752 introduced a discontinuity: The day after
11034 Sep 2, 1752 is Sep 14, 1752. Calc follows this convention.
11035 To take another example, Russia waited until 1918 before
11036 adopting the new calendar, and thus needed to remove thirteen
11037 days (between Feb 1, 1918 and Feb 14, 1918). This means that
11038 Calc's reckoning will be inconsistent with Russian history between
11039 1752 and 1918, and similarly for various other countries.
11040
11041 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second'' as
11042 well, but Calc does not take these minor effects into account.
11043 (If it did, it would have to report a non-integer number of days
11044 between, say, @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11045 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11046
11047 Calc uses the Julian calendar for all dates before the year 1752,
11048 including dates BC when the Julian calendar technically had not
11049 yet been invented. Thus the claim that day number @mathit{-10000} is
11050 called ``August 16, 28 BC'' should be taken with a grain of salt.
11051
11052 Please note that there is no ``year 0''; the day before
11053 @samp{<Sat Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Fri Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11054 days 0 and @mathit{-1} respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme.
11055
11056 @cindex Julian day counting
11057 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11058 ``Julian.'' The Julian day number is the numbers of days since
11059 12:00 noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC, which in Calc's scheme (in GMT)
11060 is @mathit{-1721423.5} (recall that Calc starts at midnight instead
11061 of noon). Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11062 date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721423.5 after
11063 compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11064 command performs this conversion for you.
11065
11066 The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11067 in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11068 since it is involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11069 Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11070 Julian cycle is based it on three other cycles: the indiction cycle,
11071 the Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15
11072 year cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later
11073 used to date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year
11074 cycle; 19 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year
11075 and a lunar month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will
11076 occur on the same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year
11077 cycle; the Julian calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The
11078 smallest time period which contains multiples of all three cycles is
11079 the least common multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which
11080 (since they're pairwise relatively prime) is
11081 @texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11082 @infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11083 This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11084 year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scalinger
11085 chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11086 there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11087 as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11088 numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11089 Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11090 the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11091 up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11092 astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11093 since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11094 noon GMT.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
11095
11096 @cindex Unix time format
11097 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11098 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11099 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11100 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11101 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11102 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11103 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11104 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11105 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11106 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11107 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11108 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11109 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11110 conversions.
11111
11112 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11113 @section Modulo Forms
11114
11115 @noindent
11116 @cindex Modulo forms
11117 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11118 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11119 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11120 `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11121 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11122 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11123 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11124 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11125 integers but this is not required.
11126
11127 @ignore
11128 @mindex M
11129 @end ignore
11130 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11131 @ignore
11132 @mindex mod
11133 @end ignore
11134 @tindex mod (operator)
11135 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11136 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11137 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11138 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11139 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11140 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11141
11142 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11143 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11144 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11145 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11146 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11147 the result always lies in the desired range.
11148
11149 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11150 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11151 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11152 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11153 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11154 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11155 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11156 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11157
11158 @cindex Modulo division
11159 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11160 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11161 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11162 `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11163 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11164 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11165 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11166 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11167 @w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11168 in the sense of reducing
11169 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11170 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11171 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11172 number-theoretical point of view.)
11173
11174 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11175 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11176 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11177 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11178 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11179 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11180 24 radians!
11181
11182 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11183 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11184 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11185
11186 You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11187 @xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11188
11189 @ignore
11190 @starindex
11191 @end ignore
11192 @tindex makemod
11193 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11194 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11195
11196 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11197 @section Error Forms
11198
11199 @noindent
11200 @cindex Error forms
11201 @cindex Standard deviations
11202 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11203 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11204 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11205 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11206 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11207 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11208 deviation or ``error''
11209 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11210 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11211 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11212 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11213 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11214 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11215 regular number by the Calculator.
11216
11217 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11218 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11219 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11220 @texline @math{\sin x}
11221 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11222 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11223 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11224 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11225 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11226 @tex
11227 $$ \eqalign{
11228 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11229 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11230 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11231 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11232 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11233 \right| \right)^2
11234 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11235 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11236 } $$
11237 @end tex
11238 Note that this
11239 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11240 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11241 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11242 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11243 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11244 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11245 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11246
11247 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11248 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11249 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11250 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11251 @texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11252 @infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11253 is
11254 @texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11255 @infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11256 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11257 @texline @math{\cos x}
11258 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11259 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11260 @texline @math{\sigma};
11261 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11262 this makes sense, since
11263 @texline @math{\sin x}
11264 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11265 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11266 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11267 @texline @math{\cos x}
11268 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11269 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11270 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11271 has relatively little effect on the value of
11272 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11273 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11274 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11275 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11276 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11277 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11278 @texline @math{\sin x}
11279 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11280 would indeed have been negligible.
11281
11282 @ignore
11283 @mindex p
11284 @end ignore
11285 @kindex p (error forms)
11286 @tindex +/-
11287 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11288 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11289 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11290 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11291 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11292
11293 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11294 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11295 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11296 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11297 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11298 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11299 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11300 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11301
11302 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11303 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11304
11305 @ignore
11306 @starindex
11307 @end ignore
11308 @tindex sdev
11309 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11310
11311 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11312 @section Interval Forms
11313
11314 @noindent
11315 @cindex Interval forms
11316 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11317 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11318 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11319 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11320 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11321 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11322 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11323 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11324 set of possible values of the input.
11325
11326 @ifnottex
11327 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11328 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11329 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11330 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11331 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11332 terms,
11333 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11334 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11335 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11336 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11337 @end ifnottex
11338 @tex
11339 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11340 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11341 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11342 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11343 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11344 terms,
11345 $$ \eqalign{
11346 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11347 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11348 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11349 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11350 } $$
11351 @end tex
11352
11353 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11354 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11355 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11356 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11357 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11358 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11359 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11360 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11361 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11362 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11363 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11364 the real infinities.
11365
11366 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11367 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11368 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11369 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11370 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11371 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11372 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11373
11374 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11375 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11376 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11377 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11378 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11379 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11380 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11381 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11382 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11383
11384 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11385 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11386 form
11387 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11388 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11389 means a variable is random, and its value could
11390 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11391 @texline @math{\sigma}
11392 @infoline @var{sigma}
11393 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11394 `@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11395 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11396 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11397 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11398 answer.
11399
11400 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11401 HMS forms or date forms.
11402
11403 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11404 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11405
11406 @ignore
11407 @starindex
11408 @end ignore
11409 @tindex intv
11410 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11411 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11412 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11413 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11414
11415 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11416 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11417 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11418 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11419 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11420 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11421 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11422 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11423 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11424 error.
11425
11426 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11427 @section Incomplete Objects
11428
11429 @noindent
11430 @ignore
11431 @mindex [ ]
11432 @end ignore
11433 @kindex [
11434 @ignore
11435 @mindex ( )
11436 @end ignore
11437 @kindex (
11438 @kindex ,
11439 @ignore
11440 @mindex @null
11441 @end ignore
11442 @kindex ]
11443 @ignore
11444 @mindex @null
11445 @end ignore
11446 @kindex )
11447 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11448 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11449 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11450 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11451 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11452 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11453 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11454 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11455 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11456
11457 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11458 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11459 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11460
11461 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11462 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11463 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11464 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11465
11466 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11467 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11468 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11469 from the list.
11470
11471 @kindex ;
11472 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11473 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11474 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11475 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11476
11477 @kindex ..
11478 @pindex calc-dots
11479 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11480 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11481 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11482 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11483 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11484 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11485
11486 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11487 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11488
11489 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11490 @section Variables
11491
11492 @noindent
11493 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11494 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11495 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11496 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11497 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11498 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11499 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11500 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11501 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11502 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11503 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11504 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11505 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11506 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11507 refer to the same variable.)
11508
11509 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11510 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11511 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11512 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11513 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11514 @code{foo}.
11515
11516 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11517 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11518 (@key{'}) key.
11519
11520 @kindex =
11521 @pindex calc-evaluate
11522 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11523 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11524 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11525 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11526 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11527 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11528 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11529 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11530 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11531 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11532 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11533 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11534
11535 @cindex @code{e} variable
11536 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11537 @cindex @code{i} variable
11538 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11539 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11540 @vindex e
11541 @vindex pi
11542 @vindex i
11543 @vindex phi
11544 @vindex gamma
11545 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11546 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11547 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11548 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11549 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11550 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11551
11552 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11553 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11554 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11555 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11556 a value into any of these special variables.
11557
11558 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11559
11560 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11561 @section Formulas
11562
11563 @noindent
11564 @cindex Formulas
11565 @cindex Expressions
11566 @cindex Operators in formulas
11567 @cindex Precedence of operators
11568 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11569 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11570 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11571 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11572 Parentheses may
11573 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11574 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11575 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11576 with their equivalent function names, are:
11577
11578 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11579
11580 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11581
11582 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x})
11583 and prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11584
11585 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11586 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11587
11588 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11589 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11590
11591 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11592
11593 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11594
11595 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11596 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11597
11598 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11599
11600 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11601
11602 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11603 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11604
11605 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11606
11607 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11608
11609 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11610
11611 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11612
11613 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11614
11615 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11616
11617 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11618
11619 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11620
11621 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11622
11623 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11624 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11625 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11626 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11627
11628 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11629 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11630 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11631 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11632 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11633 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11634 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11635 as in @samp{f(x)},
11636 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11637 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11638 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11639 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11640 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11641
11642 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11643 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11644 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11645 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11646 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11647 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11648 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11649 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11650 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11651 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11652 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11653
11654 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11655 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11656 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11657 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11658 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11659 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11660 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11661 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11662 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11663 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11664
11665 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11666 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11667 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11668 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11669
11670 @cindex Function call notation
11671 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11672 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11673 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11674 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11675 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11676 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11677 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11678 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11679 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11680 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11681 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11682
11683 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11684 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11685 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11686 represent the same operation.
11687
11688 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11689 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11690 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11691 and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11692 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11693 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11694 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11695
11696 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11697 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11698 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11699 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11700
11701 @example
11702 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11703 c + d,
11704 %% last line is coming up:
11705 e + f ]
11706 @end example
11707
11708 @noindent
11709 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11710
11711 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11712 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11713 formats.
11714
11715 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11716
11717 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11718 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11719
11720 @noindent
11721 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11722 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11723 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11724
11725 @menu
11726 * Stack Manipulation::
11727 * Editing Stack Entries::
11728 * Trail Commands::
11729 * Keep Arguments::
11730 @end menu
11731
11732 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11733 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11734
11735 @noindent
11736 @kindex @key{RET}
11737 @kindex @key{SPC}
11738 @pindex calc-enter
11739 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11740 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11741 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11742 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11743 several elements at the top of the stack.
11744 Given a negative argument,
11745 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11746 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11747 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11748 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11749 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11750 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11751 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11752
11753 @kindex @key{LFD}
11754 @pindex calc-over
11755 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11756 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11757 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11758 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11759 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11760 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11761 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11762
11763 @kindex @key{DEL}
11764 @kindex C-d
11765 @pindex calc-pop
11766 @cindex Removing stack entries
11767 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11768 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11769 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11770 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11771 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11772 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11773 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11774 stack is emptied.
11775 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11776 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11777 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11778 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11779 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11780
11781 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11782 @pindex calc-pop-above
11783 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11784 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11785 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11786 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11787 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11788 the third stack element.
11789
11790 @kindex @key{TAB}
11791 @pindex calc-roll-down
11792 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11793 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11794 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11795 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11796 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11797 top-for-bottom.
11798 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11799 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11800 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11801 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11802 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11803
11804 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11805 @pindex calc-roll-up
11806 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11807 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11808 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11809 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11810 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11811 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11812 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11813 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11814
11815 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11816 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11817 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11818 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11819 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11820 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11821 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11822
11823 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11824 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11825 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11826 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @mathit{n}, also
11827 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11828
11829 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11830 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11831
11832 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11833 @section Editing Stack Entries
11834
11835 @noindent
11836 @kindex `
11837 @pindex calc-edit
11838 @pindex calc-edit-finish
11839 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
11840 The backquote, @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary
11841 buffer (@samp{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using
11842 regular Emacs commands. With a numeric prefix argument, it edits the
11843 specified number of stack entries at once. (An argument of zero edits
11844 the entire stack; a negative argument edits one specific stack entry.)
11845
11846 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11847 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11848 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11849 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11850 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11851
11852 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11853 the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11854 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11855 then kills the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11856 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11857 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11858 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11859
11860 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11861 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11862 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11863 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11864
11865 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11866 Calc will not kill the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11867 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11868 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11869 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11870 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11871 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11872 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11873 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11874
11875 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11876 each line of the @samp{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11877 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11878 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11879 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11880
11881 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11882 text entered so far is moved to the @code{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11883 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11884
11885 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11886 @section Trail Commands
11887
11888 @noindent
11889 @cindex Trail buffer
11890 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11891 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11892
11893 @kindex t d
11894 @pindex calc-trail-display
11895 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11896 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11897 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11898 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11899 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11900 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11901 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11902 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11903 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11904
11905 @kindex t i
11906 @pindex calc-trail-in
11907 @kindex t o
11908 @pindex calc-trail-out
11909 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11910 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11911 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11912 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11913 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11914 in the Calculator window.
11915
11916 @cindex Trail pointer
11917 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11918 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11919 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11920 trail pointer in various ways.
11921
11922 @kindex t y
11923 @pindex calc-trail-yank
11924 @cindex Retrieving previous results
11925 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11926 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11927 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11928 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11929 trail pointer.
11930
11931 @kindex t <
11932 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11933 @kindex t >
11934 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11935 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11936 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11937 window left or right by one half of its width.
11938
11939 @kindex t n
11940 @pindex calc-trail-next
11941 @kindex t p
11942 @pindex calc-trail-previous
11943 @kindex t f
11944 @pindex calc-trail-forward
11945 @kindex t b
11946 @pindex calc-trail-backward
11947 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11948 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11949 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11950 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11951 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11952 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11953
11954 @kindex t [
11955 @pindex calc-trail-first
11956 @kindex t ]
11957 @pindex calc-trail-last
11958 @kindex t h
11959 @pindex calc-trail-here
11960 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
11961 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
11962 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
11963 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
11964 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
11965
11966 @kindex t s
11967 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
11968 @kindex t r
11969 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
11970 @ifnottex
11971 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
11972 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
11973 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
11974 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
11975 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
11976 it was when the search began.
11977 @end ifnottex
11978 @tex
11979 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
11980 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
11981 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
11982 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
11983 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
11984 it was when the search began.
11985 @end tex
11986
11987 @kindex t m
11988 @pindex calc-trail-marker
11989 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
11990 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
11991 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
11992 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
11993 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
11994
11995 @kindex t k
11996 @pindex calc-trail-kill
11997 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
11998 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
11999 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12000 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12001 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12002
12003 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12004 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12005
12006 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12007 @section Keep Arguments
12008
12009 @noindent
12010 @kindex K
12011 @pindex calc-keep-args
12012 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12013 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12014 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12015 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12016 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12017
12018 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12019 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12020 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12021 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12022 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12023 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12024 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12025 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12026 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12027 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12028 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12029 extra work.
12030
12031 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12032 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12033 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12034
12035 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12036 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12037 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12038 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12039 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12040 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12041
12042 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12043 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12044 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12045 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12046 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12047 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12048
12049 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12050 @chapter Mode Settings
12051
12052 @noindent
12053 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12054 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12055 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12056
12057 @menu
12058 * General Mode Commands::
12059 * Precision::
12060 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12061 * Calculation Modes::
12062 * Simplification Modes::
12063 * Declarations::
12064 * Display Modes::
12065 * Language Modes::
12066 * Modes Variable::
12067 * Calc Mode Line::
12068 @end menu
12069
12070 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12071 @section General Mode Commands
12072
12073 @noindent
12074 @kindex m m
12075 @pindex calc-save-modes
12076 @cindex Continuous memory
12077 @cindex Saving mode settings
12078 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12079 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12080 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12081 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12082 @file{~/.calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command.
12083 This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time it starts up.
12084 The modes saved in the file include everything controlled by the @kbd{m}
12085 and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current precision and binary word size,
12086 whether or not the trail is displayed, the current height of the Calc
12087 window, and more. The current interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *})
12088 is also saved. If there were already saved mode settings in the
12089 file, they are replaced. Otherwise, the new mode information is
12090 appended to the end of the file.
12091
12092 @kindex m R
12093 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12094 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12095 record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12096 time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12097 ``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12098 Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12099 settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12100 necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12101 the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12102
12103 @kindex m F
12104 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12105 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12106 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12107 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12108 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12109 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12110 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12111 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12112 file name is @file{~/.calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12113 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12114 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12115
12116 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12117 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12118 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12119 to reread. You can give
12120 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12121 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12122 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12123 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12124 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12125 modes present in the file you were using before.
12126
12127 @kindex m x
12128 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12129 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12130 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12131 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12132 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12133 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12134 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12135 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12136
12137 @kindex m S
12138 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12139 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12140 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12141 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12142 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12143 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12144 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12145 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12146 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12147 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12148 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12149 shifted-prefix mode.
12150
12151 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12152 @section Precision
12153
12154 @noindent
12155 @kindex p
12156 @pindex calc-precision
12157 @cindex Precision of calculations
12158 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12159 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12160 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12161 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12162 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12163
12164 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12165 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12166
12167 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12168 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12169 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12170 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12171 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12172 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12173 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12174 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12175 existing value to a new precision.
12176
12177 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12178 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12179 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12180 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12181 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12182 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12183 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12184 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12185 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12186 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12187 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12188 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12189 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12190
12191 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12192 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12193 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12194 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12195 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12196 of the numbers involved.
12197
12198 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12199 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12200 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12201 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12202 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12203 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12204
12205 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12206 issues.
12207
12208 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12209 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12210
12211 @noindent
12212 @kindex I
12213 @pindex calc-inverse
12214 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12215 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12216 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12217 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12218 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12219
12220 @kindex H
12221 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12222 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12223 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12224 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12225 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12226 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12227 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12228
12229 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12230 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12231 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12232 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12233
12234 The Inverse and Hyperbolic flags apply only to the next Calculator
12235 command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They are also
12236 cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits you
12237 type after @kbd{I} or @kbd{H} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as prefix
12238 arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The same
12239 is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means to
12240 subtract and keep arguments).
12241
12242 The third Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12243 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12244
12245 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12246 @section Calculation Modes
12247
12248 @noindent
12249 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12250 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12251 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12252 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12253
12254 @menu
12255 * Angular Modes::
12256 * Polar Mode::
12257 * Fraction Mode::
12258 * Infinite Mode::
12259 * Symbolic Mode::
12260 * Matrix Mode::
12261 * Automatic Recomputation::
12262 * Working Message::
12263 @end menu
12264
12265 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12266 @subsection Angular Modes
12267
12268 @noindent
12269 @cindex Angular mode
12270 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12271 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12272 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12273 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12274 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12275 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12276
12277 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12278 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12279 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12280 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12281 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12282 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12283 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12284
12285 @kindex m r
12286 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12287 @kindex m d
12288 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12289 @kindex m h
12290 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12291 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12292 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12293 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12294 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12295
12296 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12297 @subsection Polar Mode
12298
12299 @noindent
12300 @cindex Polar mode
12301 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12302 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12303 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12304 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12305 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12306
12307 @kindex m p
12308 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12309 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12310 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12311 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12312
12313 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12314 @subsection Fraction Mode
12315
12316 @noindent
12317 @cindex Fraction mode
12318 @cindex Division of integers
12319 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12320 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12321 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12322 to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12323 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12324 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12325 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12326
12327 @kindex m f
12328 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12329 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12330 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12331 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12332 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12333 Float mode.
12334
12335 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12336 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12337 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12338
12339 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12340 @subsection Infinite Mode
12341
12342 @noindent
12343 @cindex Infinite mode
12344 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12345 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12346 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12347 results.
12348
12349 @kindex m i
12350 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12351 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12352 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12353 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12354 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12355 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12356 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12357
12358 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12359 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12360 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12361 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12362 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12363 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12364 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12365 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12366
12367 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12368 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12369 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12370 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12371 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12372 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12373 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12374 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12375 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12376 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12377 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12378
12379 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12380 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12381
12382 @noindent
12383 @cindex Symbolic mode
12384 @cindex Inexact results
12385 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12386 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12387 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12388 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12389 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12390
12391 @kindex m s
12392 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12393 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12394 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12395 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12396 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12397
12398 @kindex N
12399 @pindex calc-eval-num
12400 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12401 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12402 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12403 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12404 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12405 of the command.
12406
12407 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12408 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12409 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12410 variables.)
12411
12412 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12413 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12414
12415 @noindent
12416 @cindex Matrix mode
12417 @cindex Scalar mode
12418 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12419 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12420 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12421 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12422
12423 @kindex m v
12424 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12425 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12426 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12427 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12428 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12429 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12430 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12431 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12432 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12433 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12434 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12435 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12436 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12437 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12438 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12439 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12440 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12441 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12442 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12443
12444 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12445 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12446 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12447 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12448 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12449 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12450 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12451
12452 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12453
12454 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12455 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12456 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12457 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12458 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12459 @kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12460 unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12461
12462 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12463 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12464 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12465 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12466 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12467 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12468
12469 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12470 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12471 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12472 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12473 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12474 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12475 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12476
12477 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12478 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12479 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12480 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12481 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12482 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12483
12484 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12485 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12486
12487 @noindent
12488 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12489 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12490 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12491 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12492
12493 @kindex m C
12494 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12495 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12496 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12497 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12498 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12499 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12500 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12501 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12502 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12503
12504 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12505 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12506 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12507
12508 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12509 @subsection Working Messages
12510
12511 @noindent
12512 @cindex Performance
12513 @cindex Working messages
12514 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12515 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12516 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12517 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12518 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12519 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12520 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12521
12522 @kindex m w
12523 @pindex calc-working
12524 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12525 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12526 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12527 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12528 the current mode.
12529
12530 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12531 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12532 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12533 to turn the messages off.
12534
12535 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12536 @section Simplification Modes
12537
12538 @noindent
12539 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12540 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12541 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12542 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12543 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12544 are done by default but can be turned off when necessary.
12545
12546 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12547 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12548 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12549 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12550
12551 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12552 followed by a shifted letter.
12553
12554 @kindex m O
12555 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12556 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12557 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12558 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12559 in this mode.
12560
12561 @kindex m N
12562 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12563 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12564 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12565 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12566 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12567 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12568 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12569 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12570 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12571 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12572 elements are constant.
12573
12574 @kindex m D
12575 @pindex calc-default-simplify-mode
12576 The @kbd{m D} (@code{calc-default-simplify-mode}) command restores the
12577 default simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12578 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12579 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12580 @expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12581
12582 @kindex m B
12583 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12584 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the default
12585 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12586 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12587 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12588 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12589 results (after the default simplifications) are left alone.
12590
12591 @kindex m A
12592 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12593 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does algebraic
12594 simplification; it applies all the default simplifications, and also
12595 the more powerful (and slower) simplifications made by @kbd{a s}
12596 (@code{calc-simplify}). @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12597
12598 @kindex m E
12599 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12600 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended''
12601 algebraic simplification, as by the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended})
12602 command. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12603
12604 @kindex m U
12605 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12606 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12607 simplification; it applies the command @kbd{u s}
12608 (@code{calc-simplify-units}), which in turn
12609 is a superset of @kbd{a s}. In this mode, variable names which
12610 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12611 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12612
12613 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12614 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12615 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12616 perform higher types of simplifications on demand. @xref{Algebraic
12617 Definitions}, for another sample use of No-Simplification mode.
12618
12619 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12620 @section Declarations
12621
12622 @noindent
12623 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12624 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12625 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12626 take the fully general situation into account.
12627
12628 @menu
12629 * Declaration Basics::
12630 * Kinds of Declarations::
12631 * Functions for Declarations::
12632 @end menu
12633
12634 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12635 @subsection Declaration Basics
12636
12637 @noindent
12638 @kindex s d
12639 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12640 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12641 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12642 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12643 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12644 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12645 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12646 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12647
12648 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12649 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12650 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12651 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12652 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12653 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12654 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12655 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12656
12657 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12658 @vindex Decls
12659 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12660 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12661 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12662 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12663 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12664 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12665 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12666 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12667 permanently if you wish.
12668
12669 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12670 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12671 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12672 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12673 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12674
12675 For example, the declaration matrix
12676
12677 @smallexample
12678 @group
12679 [ [ foo, real ]
12680 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12681 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12682 @end group
12683 @end smallexample
12684
12685 @noindent
12686 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12687 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12688 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12689
12690 @vindex All
12691 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12692 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12693 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12694 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12695 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12696 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12697 response to the variable-name prompt.
12698
12699 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12700 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12701
12702 @noindent
12703 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12704 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12705 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12706 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12707 for the variable.
12708
12709 @smallexample
12710 @group
12711 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12712 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12713 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12714 @end group
12715 @end smallexample
12716
12717 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12718 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12719 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12720 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12721 nearly equivalent (see below).
12722
12723 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12724 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12725 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12726 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12727
12728 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12729 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12730 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12731 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12732 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12733 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12734
12735 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12736 stored in a variable:
12737
12738 @table @code
12739 @item int
12740 Integers.
12741 @item numint
12742 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12743 @item frac
12744 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12745 @item rat
12746 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12747 @item float
12748 Floating-point numbers.
12749 @item real
12750 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12751 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12752 reals here.)
12753 @item pos
12754 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12755 @item nonneg
12756 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12757 @item number
12758 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12759 @end table
12760
12761 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12762 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12763 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12764 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12765 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12766 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12767 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12768 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12769 of the formula.
12770
12771 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12772 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12773 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12774 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12775 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12776 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12777
12778 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12779 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12780 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12781 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12782 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12783
12784 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12785 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12786 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12787 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12788 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12789 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12790
12791 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12792 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12793 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12794 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12795 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12796 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12797 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12798 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12799 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12800 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12801
12802 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12803 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12804
12805 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12806 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12807 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12808 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12809 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12810 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12811 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12812
12813 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12814 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12815 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12816 type symbol.
12817
12818 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12819 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12820 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12821 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12822 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12823
12824 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12825 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12826 shown above).
12827
12828 Another command that makes use of declarations is @kbd{a s}, when
12829 simplifying equations and inequalities. It will cancel @code{x}
12830 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12831 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12832 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12833 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12834 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12835 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12836 including cancelling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12837 not known to be nonzero.
12838
12839 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12840
12841 @table @code
12842 @item scalar
12843 The value is not a vector.
12844 @item vector
12845 The value is a vector.
12846 @item matrix
12847 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12848 @item sqmatrix
12849 The value is a square matrix.
12850 @end table
12851
12852 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12853 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12854 is a matrix of integers.
12855
12856 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12857 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12858 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12859 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12860 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12861 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12862 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12863 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12864 declarations.)
12865
12866 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12867 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12868 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12869
12870 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12871 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12872
12873 @table @code
12874 @item const
12875 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12876 @end table
12877
12878 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12879 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12880 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12881 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12882 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12883 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12884 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12885 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12886 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12887 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12888
12889 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12890 @subsection Functions for Declarations
12891
12892 @noindent
12893 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12894 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12895 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12896 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12897 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12898 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12899 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12900 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12901 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12902
12903 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12904 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12905 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12906 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12907 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12908
12909 @ignore
12910 @starindex
12911 @end ignore
12912 @tindex dint
12913 @ignore
12914 @starindex
12915 @end ignore
12916 @tindex dnumint
12917 @ignore
12918 @starindex
12919 @end ignore
12920 @tindex dnatnum
12921 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12922 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12923 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12924 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12925 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12926 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12927 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12928 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12929
12930 @ignore
12931 @starindex
12932 @end ignore
12933 @tindex drat
12934 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12935 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12936 and error forms do not.
12937
12938 @ignore
12939 @starindex
12940 @end ignore
12941 @tindex dreal
12942 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12943 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12944
12945 @ignore
12946 @starindex
12947 @end ignore
12948 @tindex dimag
12949 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
12950 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
12951
12952 @ignore
12953 @starindex
12954 @end ignore
12955 @tindex dpos
12956 @ignore
12957 @starindex
12958 @end ignore
12959 @tindex dneg
12960 @ignore
12961 @starindex
12962 @end ignore
12963 @tindex dnonneg
12964 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
12965 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
12966 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
12967 equal to zero. Note that the @kbd{a s} command can simplify an
12968 expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}, and that
12969 @kbd{a s} is effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules,
12970 so the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
12971 are rarely necessary.
12972
12973 @ignore
12974 @starindex
12975 @end ignore
12976 @tindex dnonzero
12977 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
12978 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
12979 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
12980 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
12981 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
12982 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
12983 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
12984
12985 @ignore
12986 @starindex
12987 @end ignore
12988 @tindex deven
12989 @ignore
12990 @starindex
12991 @end ignore
12992 @tindex dodd
12993 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
12994 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
12995 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
12996 The @kbd{a s} command uses this to simplify a test of the form
12997 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
12998
12999 @ignore
13000 @starindex
13001 @end ignore
13002 @tindex drange
13003 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13004 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13005 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13006 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13007 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13008 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13009 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13010 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13011 remains unevaluated.
13012
13013 @ignore
13014 @starindex
13015 @end ignore
13016 @tindex dscalar
13017 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13018 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13019 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13020 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13021 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13022 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13023 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13024 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13025 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13026 information to tell.
13027
13028 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13029 @section Display Modes
13030
13031 @noindent
13032 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13033 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13034 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13035 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13036 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13037 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13038
13039 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13040 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13041 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13042 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13043 reflect the latest mode settings.
13044
13045 @kindex d @key{RET}
13046 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13047 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13048 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13049 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13050 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13051 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13052 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13053 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13054
13055 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13056 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13057 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13058 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13059
13060 @menu
13061 * Radix Modes::
13062 * Grouping Digits::
13063 * Float Formats::
13064 * Complex Formats::
13065 * Fraction Formats::
13066 * HMS Formats::
13067 * Date Formats::
13068 * Truncating the Stack::
13069 * Justification::
13070 * Labels::
13071 @end menu
13072
13073 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13074 @subsection Radix Modes
13075
13076 @noindent
13077 @cindex Radix display
13078 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13079 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13080 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13081 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13082 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13083 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13084 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13085
13086 @kindex d 2
13087 @kindex d 8
13088 @kindex d 6
13089 @kindex d 0
13090 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13091 @cindex Octal integers
13092 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13093 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13094 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13095 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13096 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13097 as decimal.
13098
13099 @kindex d r
13100 @pindex calc-radix
13101 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13102 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13103 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13104
13105 @kindex d z
13106 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13107 @cindex Leading zeros
13108 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13109 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13110 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13111 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13112 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13113 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13114 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13115 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13116 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13117 entirety.)
13118
13119 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13120 @subsection Grouping Digits
13121
13122 @noindent
13123 @kindex d g
13124 @pindex calc-group-digits
13125 @cindex Grouping digits
13126 @cindex Digit grouping
13127 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13128 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13129 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13130 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13131 separated by commas.
13132
13133 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13134 With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13135 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13136 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13137 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13138 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13139 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13140
13141 @kindex d ,
13142 @pindex calc-group-char
13143 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13144 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13145 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13146 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13147 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13148 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13149 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13150
13151 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13152 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13153 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13154 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13155 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13156
13157 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13158 @subsection Float Formats
13159
13160 @noindent
13161 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13162 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13163 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13164 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13165 formats for floats.
13166
13167 @kindex d n
13168 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13169 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13170 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13171 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13172 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13173 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13174 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13175 current precision is 12.)
13176
13177 @kindex d f
13178 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13179 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13180 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13181 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13182 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13183 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13184 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13185 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13186
13187 @kindex d s
13188 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13189 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13190 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13191 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13192 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13193 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13194 The default is to display all significant digits.
13195
13196 @kindex d e
13197 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13198 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13199 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13200 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13201 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13202 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13203 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13204
13205 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13206 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13207 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13208 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13209 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13210 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13211 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13212 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13213 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13214
13215 @kindex d .
13216 @pindex calc-point-char
13217 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13218 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13219 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13220 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13221 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13222
13223 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13224 @subsection Complex Formats
13225
13226 @noindent
13227 @kindex d c
13228 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13229 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13230 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13231 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13232 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13233
13234 @kindex d i
13235 @pindex calc-i-notation
13236 @kindex d j
13237 @pindex calc-j-notation
13238 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13239 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13240 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13241 in some disciplines.
13242
13243 @cindex @code{i} variable
13244 @vindex i
13245 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13246 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13247 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13248 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13249 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13250 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13251 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13252 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13253
13254 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13255 @subsection Fraction Formats
13256
13257 @noindent
13258 @kindex d o
13259 @pindex calc-over-notation
13260 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13261 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13262 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13263 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13264 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13265 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13266 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13267 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13268
13269 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13270 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13271 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13272 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13273 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13274
13275 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13276 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13277 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13278 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13279 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13280 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13281 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13282 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13283 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13284 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13285 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13286
13287 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13288 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13289 never affects floats.
13290
13291 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13292 @subsection HMS Formats
13293
13294 @noindent
13295 @kindex d h
13296 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13297 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13298 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13299 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13300 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13301 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13302 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13303 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13304
13305 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13306 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13307 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13308 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13309 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13310 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13311 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13312 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13313 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13314 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13315 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13316 entry.
13317
13318 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13319 @subsection Date Formats
13320
13321 @noindent
13322 @kindex d d
13323 @pindex calc-date-notation
13324 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13325 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13326 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13327 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13328 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13329 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13330 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13331 pure dates.
13332
13333 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13334 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13335 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13336 reestablished.
13337
13338 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13339 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13340 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13341
13342 @menu
13343 * Date Formatting Codes::
13344 * Free-Form Dates::
13345 * Standard Date Formats::
13346 @end menu
13347
13348 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, Date Formats, Date Formats
13349 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13350
13351 @noindent
13352 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13353 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13354 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13355 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13356 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13357 below.
13358
13359 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13360 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13361 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13362 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13363 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13364 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13365 since Jan 1, 1 AD. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13366 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13367
13368 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13369
13370 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13371 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13372 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13373 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13374 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13375
13376 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13377
13378 @table @asis
13379 @item Y
13380 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13381 @item YY
13382 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13383 @item BY
13384 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13385 @item YYY
13386 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13387 @item YYYY
13388 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13389 @item aa
13390 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13391 @item AA
13392 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13393 @item aaa
13394 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13395 @item AAA
13396 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13397 @item aaaa
13398 Year: ``a.d.'' or blank.
13399 @item AAAA
13400 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13401 @item bb
13402 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13403 @item BB
13404 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13405 @item bbb
13406 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13407 @item BBB
13408 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13409 @item bbbb
13410 Year: ``b.c.'' or blank.
13411 @item BBBB
13412 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13413 @item M
13414 Month: ``8'' for August.
13415 @item MM
13416 Month: ``08'' for August.
13417 @item BM
13418 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13419 @item MMM
13420 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13421 @item Mmm
13422 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13423 @item mmm
13424 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13425 @item MMMM
13426 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13427 @item Mmmm
13428 Month: ``August'' for August.
13429 @item D
13430 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13431 @item DD
13432 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13433 @item BD
13434 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13435 @item W
13436 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13437 @item WWW
13438 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13439 @item Www
13440 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13441 @item www
13442 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13443 @item WWWW
13444 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13445 @item Wwww
13446 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13447 @item d
13448 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13449 @item ddd
13450 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13451 @item bdd
13452 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13453 @item h
13454 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13455 @item hh
13456 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13457 @item bh
13458 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13459 @item H
13460 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13461 @item HH
13462 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13463 @item BH
13464 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13465 @item p
13466 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13467 @item P
13468 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13469 @item pp
13470 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13471 @item PP
13472 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13473 @item pppp
13474 AM/PM: ``a.m.'' or ``p.m.''.
13475 @item PPPP
13476 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13477 @item m
13478 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13479 @item mm
13480 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13481 @item bm
13482 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13483 @item s
13484 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13485 @item ss
13486 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13487 @item bs
13488 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13489 @item SS
13490 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13491 @item BS
13492 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13493 @item N
13494 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13495 @item n
13496 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13497 @item J
13498 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13499 @item j
13500 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13501 @item U
13502 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13503 @item X
13504 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13505 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13506 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13507 required for algebraic entry.
13508 @end table
13509
13510 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13511 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13512
13513 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13514 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13515 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13516 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13517 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13518
13519 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13520 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13521 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13522 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13523 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13524
13525 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13526 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13527 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13528
13529 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13530 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13531
13532 @noindent
13533 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13534 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13535 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13536 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13537 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13538
13539 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13540 while interpreting dates.
13541
13542 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13543 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13544 the date.
13545
13546 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13547 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13548 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13549 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13550 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13551 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13552 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13553 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13554 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13555 recognized with no number attached.
13556
13557 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13558 format.
13559
13560 To read the date portion, all words and numbers are isolated
13561 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must
13562 be either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which
13563 are ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13564 abbreviations.
13565
13566 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13567 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13568 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13569 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13570 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13571 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13572 current year is taken from the system clock.
13573
13574 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13575 words, then the input is rejected.
13576
13577 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13578 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13579 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13580 date components when the date was formatted.
13581
13582 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13583 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13584 minus sign on the year value.
13585
13586 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13587 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13588
13589 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13590 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13591
13592 @noindent
13593 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13594 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13595 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13596 to select the other formats.
13597
13598 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13599 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13600 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13601 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13602 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13603 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13604
13605 @table @asis
13606 @item 0
13607 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13608 @item 1
13609 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13610 @item 2
13611 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13612 @item 3
13613 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13614 @item 4
13615 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13616 @item 5
13617 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13618 @item 6
13619 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13620 @item 7
13621 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13622 @item 8
13623 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13624 @item 9
13625 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13626 @end table
13627
13628 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13629 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13630
13631 @noindent
13632 @kindex d t
13633 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13634 @cindex Truncating the stack
13635 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13636 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13637 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13638 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13639 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13640 operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13641 Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13642 are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13643 keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13644 of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13645 the stack.
13646
13647 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13648 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13649 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13650 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13651 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13652 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13653 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13654
13655 @kindex d [
13656 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13657 @kindex d ]
13658 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13659 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13660 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13661 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13662
13663 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13664 @subsection Justification
13665
13666 @noindent
13667 @kindex d <
13668 @pindex calc-left-justify
13669 @kindex d =
13670 @pindex calc-center-justify
13671 @kindex d >
13672 @pindex calc-right-justify
13673 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13674 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13675 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13676 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13677 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13678 window.
13679
13680 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13681 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13682 text.
13683
13684 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13685 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13686 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13687
13688 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13689 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13690 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13691 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13692 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13693 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13694 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13695 mode.
13696
13697 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13698 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13699 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13700 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13701 line is indented to the origin.
13702
13703 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13704 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13705 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13706 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13707 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13708 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13709
13710 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13711 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13712 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13713 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13714 line width or Calc window width is used.
13715
13716 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13717 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13718 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13719 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13720 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13721 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13722 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13723
13724 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13725 @subsection Labels
13726
13727 @noindent
13728 @kindex d @{
13729 @pindex calc-left-label
13730 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13731 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13732 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13733 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13734 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13735 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13736 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13737
13738 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13739
13740 @kindex d @}
13741 @pindex calc-right-label
13742 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13743 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13744 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13745 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13746 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13747 justified to the line width.
13748
13749 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13750 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13751 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13752 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13753 left or right as you prefer.
13754
13755 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13756 @section Language Modes
13757
13758 @noindent
13759 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13760 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13761 other common language such as Pascal or La@TeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13762 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13763 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13764 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13765
13766 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13767 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13768 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13769 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13770
13771 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13772 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13773 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13774 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13775 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13776 to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13777 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13778 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13779
13780 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13781 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13782 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13783 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13784 multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13785
13786 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a La@TeX{}
13787 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13788 formula from the program in C mode, switch to La@TeX{} mode, and yank the
13789 formula into the document in La@TeX{} math-mode format.
13790
13791 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13792 shifted letter key.
13793
13794 @menu
13795 * Normal Language Modes::
13796 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13797 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13798 * Eqn Language Mode::
13799 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13800 * Maple Language Mode::
13801 * Compositions::
13802 * Syntax Tables::
13803 @end menu
13804
13805 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13806 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13807
13808 @noindent
13809 @kindex d N
13810 @pindex calc-normal-language
13811 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
13812 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
13813 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
13814 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
13815 keyboard.
13816
13817 @kindex d O
13818 @pindex calc-flat-language
13819 @cindex Matrix display
13820 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
13821 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
13822 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
13823 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
13824
13825 @kindex d b
13826 @pindex calc-line-breaking
13827 @cindex Line breaking
13828 @cindex Breaking up long lines
13829 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
13830 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
13831 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
13832 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
13833 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
13834 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
13835 long lines.
13836
13837 @kindex d B
13838 @pindex calc-big-language
13839 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
13840 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
13841 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
13842
13843 @example
13844 ____________
13845 | a + 1 2
13846 | ----- + c
13847 \| b
13848 @end example
13849
13850 @noindent
13851 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
13852
13853 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
13854 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
13855 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
13856 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
13857 notation.
13858
13859 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
13860
13861 @example
13862 3
13863 - -
13864 4
13865 @end example
13866
13867 @noindent
13868 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
13869 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
13870 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
13871 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
13872 typical use.
13873
13874 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
13875 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
13876 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
13877 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
13878 in Big mode.
13879
13880 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
13881 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
13882 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
13883 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
13884 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
13885
13886 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
13887 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
13888 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
13889 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
13890
13891 @kindex d U
13892 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
13893 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
13894 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
13895 shown above would be displayed:
13896
13897 @example
13898 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
13899 @end example
13900
13901 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
13902 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
13903 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
13904 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
13905 parentheses).
13906
13907 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
13908 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
13909
13910 @noindent
13911 @kindex d C
13912 @pindex calc-c-language
13913 @cindex C language
13914 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
13915 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
13916 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
13917 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
13918 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
13919 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
13920 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
13921
13922 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
13923 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
13924 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
13925 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
13926 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
13927 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
13928 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
13929
13930 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
13931 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
13932 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
13933 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
13934 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
13935 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
13936 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
13937 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
13938
13939 @kindex d P
13940 @pindex calc-pascal-language
13941 @cindex Pascal language
13942 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
13943 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
13944 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
13945 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
13946 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
13947 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.) not followed by digits works the same as
13948 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
13949 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
13950 of handling these in Pascal.
13951
13952 @kindex d F
13953 @pindex calc-fortran-language
13954 @cindex FORTRAN language
13955 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
13956 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
13957 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
13958 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
13959 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
13960 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
13961 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
13962 Also, if the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
13963 @code{vector} or @code{matrix} then @samp{a(i)} will be parsed as a
13964 subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't matter, though;
13965 if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and Calc interprets
13966 it as a function call, you'll never know the difference unless you
13967 switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an actual
13968 vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
13969 function!).
13970
13971 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
13972 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
13973 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
13974
13975 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
13976 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
13977 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
13978 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
13979 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
13980 convert to lower-case for display and input.
13981
13982 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
13983 @subsection @TeX{} and La@TeX{} Language Modes
13984
13985 @noindent
13986 @kindex d T
13987 @pindex calc-tex-language
13988 @cindex TeX language
13989 @kindex d L
13990 @pindex calc-latex-language
13991 @cindex LaTeX language
13992 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
13993 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
13994 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
13995 conventions of ``math mode'' in La@TeX{}, a typesetting language that
13996 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's La@TeX{} language mode can
13997 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although La@TeX{}
13998 mode may display it differently.
13999
14000 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14001 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14002 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14003 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( a \over b \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14004 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in La@TeX{} mode.
14005 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14006 La@TeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14007 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14008 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14009
14010 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14011 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14012 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in La@TeX{} mode (as in
14013 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14014 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14015 @code{\binom} in La@TeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14016 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14017 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14018 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14019 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14020 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14021 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14022 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14023
14024 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14025 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14026 and La@TeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14027 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14028 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14029 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14030 printed result is
14031 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14032 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14033 but
14034 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14035 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14036
14037 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and La@TeX{}
14038 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14039 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14040 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14041 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14042 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14043 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14044 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in La@TeX{} mode. The
14045 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14046 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14047 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14048 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14049 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14050 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14051 any @TeX{} mode.)
14052
14053 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14054 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14055 @code{\bmatrix}. In La@TeX{} mode this also applies to
14056 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14057 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14058 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14059 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14060 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14061 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14062 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14063 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14064 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14065 La@TeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14066 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14067 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14068 form, such as
14069
14070 @example
14071 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14072 a & b \\
14073 c & d
14074 \end@{pmatrix@}
14075 @end example
14076
14077 @noindent
14078 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14079 expressions being displayed like
14080
14081 @example
14082 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14083 a & b \\
14084 c & d
14085 \end@{pmatrix@}
14086 @end example
14087
14088 @noindent
14089 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect La@TeX{}.
14090 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14091
14092 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14093 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14094 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14095 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14096 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14097 in Calc, @TeX{}, La@TeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14098
14099 @iftex
14100 @begingroup
14101 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14102 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14103 @end iftex
14104 @ignore
14105 @starindex
14106 @end ignore
14107 @tindex acute
14108 @ignore
14109 @starindex
14110 @end ignore
14111 @tindex Acute
14112 @ignore
14113 @starindex
14114 @end ignore
14115 @tindex bar
14116 @ignore
14117 @starindex
14118 @end ignore
14119 @tindex Bar
14120 @ignore
14121 @starindex
14122 @end ignore
14123 @tindex breve
14124 @ignore
14125 @starindex
14126 @end ignore
14127 @tindex Breve
14128 @ignore
14129 @starindex
14130 @end ignore
14131 @tindex check
14132 @ignore
14133 @starindex
14134 @end ignore
14135 @tindex Check
14136 @ignore
14137 @starindex
14138 @end ignore
14139 @tindex dddot
14140 @ignore
14141 @starindex
14142 @end ignore
14143 @tindex ddddot
14144 @ignore
14145 @starindex
14146 @end ignore
14147 @tindex dot
14148 @ignore
14149 @starindex
14150 @end ignore
14151 @tindex Dot
14152 @ignore
14153 @starindex
14154 @end ignore
14155 @tindex dotdot
14156 @ignore
14157 @starindex
14158 @end ignore
14159 @tindex DotDot
14160 @ignore
14161 @starindex
14162 @end ignore
14163 @tindex dyad
14164 @ignore
14165 @starindex
14166 @end ignore
14167 @tindex grave
14168 @ignore
14169 @starindex
14170 @end ignore
14171 @tindex Grave
14172 @ignore
14173 @starindex
14174 @end ignore
14175 @tindex hat
14176 @ignore
14177 @starindex
14178 @end ignore
14179 @tindex Hat
14180 @ignore
14181 @starindex
14182 @end ignore
14183 @tindex Prime
14184 @ignore
14185 @starindex
14186 @end ignore
14187 @tindex tilde
14188 @ignore
14189 @starindex
14190 @end ignore
14191 @tindex Tilde
14192 @ignore
14193 @starindex
14194 @end ignore
14195 @tindex under
14196 @ignore
14197 @starindex
14198 @end ignore
14199 @tindex Vec
14200 @ignore
14201 @starindex
14202 @end ignore
14203 @tindex VEC
14204 @iftex
14205 @endgroup
14206 @end iftex
14207 @example
14208 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14209 ---- --- ----- ---
14210 acute \acute \acute
14211 Acute \Acute
14212 bar \bar \bar bar
14213 Bar \Bar
14214 breve \breve \breve
14215 Breve \Breve
14216 check \check \check
14217 Check \Check
14218 dddot \dddot
14219 ddddot \ddddot
14220 dot \dot \dot dot
14221 Dot \Dot
14222 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14223 DotDot \Ddot
14224 dyad dyad
14225 grave \grave \grave
14226 Grave \Grave
14227 hat \hat \hat hat
14228 Hat \Hat
14229 Prime prime
14230 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14231 Tilde \Tilde
14232 under \underline \underline under
14233 Vec \vec \vec vec
14234 VEC \Vec
14235 @end example
14236
14237 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14238 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14239 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14240 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14241 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14242 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14243 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14244 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14245
14246 @example
14247 \def\evalto@{@}
14248 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14249 @end example
14250
14251 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14252 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14253 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14254 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14255 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14256 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14257
14258 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14259 reading is:
14260
14261 @example
14262 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14263 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14264 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14265 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14266 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14267 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14268 \evalto
14269 @end example
14270
14271 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14272 La@TeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14273 font information.
14274
14275 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14276 the same as @samp{*}.
14277
14278 @ifnottex
14279 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14280 end of this section.
14281 @end ifnottex
14282 @iftex
14283 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14284
14285 @example
14286 @group
14287 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14288 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14289 @end group
14290 @end example
14291 @tex
14292 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14293 @end tex
14294 @sp 1
14295
14296 @example
14297 @group
14298 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14299 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14300 @end group
14301 @end example
14302 @tex
14303 \turnoffactive
14304 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14305 @end tex
14306 @sp 1
14307
14308 @example
14309 @group
14310 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14311 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14312 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14313 @end group
14314 @end example
14315 @tex
14316 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14317 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14318 @end tex
14319 @sp 1
14320
14321 @example
14322 @group
14323 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14324 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14325 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14326 @end group
14327 @end example
14328 @tex
14329 \turnoffactive
14330 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14331 @end tex
14332 @sp 2
14333
14334 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14335 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14336 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14337
14338 @example
14339 @group
14340 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14341 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14342 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14343 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14344 @end group
14345 @end example
14346 @tex
14347 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14348 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14349 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14350 @end tex
14351 @sp 2
14352
14353 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14354
14355 @example
14356 @group
14357 2 + 3 => 5
14358 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14359 @end group
14360 @end example
14361 @tex
14362 \turnoffactive
14363 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14364 $$ 5 $$
14365 @end tex
14366 @sp 2
14367
14368 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14369
14370 @example
14371 @group
14372 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14373 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14374 @end group
14375 @end example
14376 @tex
14377 \turnoffactive
14378 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14379 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14380 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14381 @end tex
14382 @sp 2
14383
14384 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14385
14386 @example
14387 @group
14388 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14389 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14390 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14391 @end group
14392 @end example
14393 @tex
14394 \turnoffactive
14395 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14396 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14397 @end tex
14398 @sp 2
14399 @end iftex
14400
14401 @node Eqn Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14402 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14403
14404 @noindent
14405 @kindex d E
14406 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14407 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14408 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14409 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14410 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14411
14412 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14413 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14414 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14415 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14416 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14417 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14418
14419 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14420 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14421 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14422 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14423 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14424 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14425 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14426
14427 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14428 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14429 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14430 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14431 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14432 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14433 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14434 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14435 names, too.)
14436
14437 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14438 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14439 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14440 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14441 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14442
14443 As in La@TeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14444 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14445 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14446 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14447
14448 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14449 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14450 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14451 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14452 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14453 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14454 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14455
14456 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14457 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14458 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14459 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14460 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14461 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14462 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14463 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14464
14465 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14466 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14467 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14468 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14469 recognized for these operators during reading.
14470
14471 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14472 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14473 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14474 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14475 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14476
14477 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14478 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14479
14480 @noindent
14481 @kindex d M
14482 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14483 @cindex Mathematica language
14484 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14485 conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14486 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14487 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14488 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14489 Mathematica mode.
14490
14491 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14492 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14493 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14494 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14495 Mathematica mode.
14496 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14497 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14498 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14499
14500 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14501 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14502
14503 @noindent
14504 @kindex d W
14505 @pindex calc-maple-language
14506 @cindex Maple language
14507 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14508 conventions of Maple.
14509
14510 Maple's language is much like C. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14511 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14512 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14513 denote powers.
14514
14515 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14516 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14517 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14518 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14519 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14520 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14521
14522 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14523 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]}, and
14524 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot
14525 see the difference between an open and a closed interval while in
14526 Maple display mode.
14527
14528 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14529 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14530 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14531 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14532
14533 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14534 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14535 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14536
14537 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14538 @subsection Compositions
14539
14540 @noindent
14541 @cindex Compositions
14542 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14543 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14544 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14545 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14546 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14547
14548 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14549 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14550 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14551 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14552 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14553 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14554 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14555 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14556
14557 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14558 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14559 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14560 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14561 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14562 the language modes.
14563
14564 @menu
14565 * Composition Basics::
14566 * Horizontal Compositions::
14567 * Vertical Compositions::
14568 * Other Compositions::
14569 * Information about Compositions::
14570 * User-Defined Compositions::
14571 @end menu
14572
14573 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14574 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14575
14576 @noindent
14577 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14578 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14579 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14580 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14581 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14582 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14583 For example, in the Big mode formula
14584
14585 @example
14586 @group
14587 2
14588 a + b
14589 17 + ------
14590 c
14591 @end group
14592 @end example
14593
14594 @noindent
14595 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14596 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14597 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14598
14599 @tex
14600 \bigskip
14601 @end tex
14602
14603 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14604 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14605 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14606 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14607 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14608
14609 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14610 following precedences:
14611
14612 @example
14613 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14614 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14615 - 1000 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14616 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14617 mod 400
14618 +/- 300
14619 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14620 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14621 ^ 200
14622 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14623 / % \ 190
14624 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14625 | 170
14626 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14627 && 110
14628 || 100
14629 ? : 90
14630 !!! 85
14631 &&& 80
14632 ||| 75
14633 := 50
14634 :: 45
14635 => 40
14636 @end example
14637
14638 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14639 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14640 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14641 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14642 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14643 normally never get additional parentheses).
14644
14645 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14646 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14647 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14648 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14649 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14650 with one-higher precedence.
14651
14652 @ignore
14653 @starindex
14654 @end ignore
14655 @tindex cprec
14656 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14657 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14658 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14659 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14660 precedence than multiplication).
14661
14662 @tex
14663 \bigskip
14664 @end tex
14665
14666 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14667 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14668 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14669 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14670 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14671 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14672 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14673 view them.
14674
14675 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14676 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14677 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14678 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14679 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14680 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14681 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14682 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14683 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14684
14685 @example
14686 @group
14687 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14688 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14689 @end group
14690 @end example
14691
14692 @noindent
14693 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14694 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14695 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14696 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14697 itself been too large to fit.
14698
14699 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14700 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14701 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14702 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14703 end of the string.
14704
14705 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14706 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14707 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14708 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14709 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14710 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14711 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14712 object.
14713
14714 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14715 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14716
14717 @noindent
14718 @ignore
14719 @starindex
14720 @end ignore
14721 @tindex choriz
14722 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14723 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14724 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14725
14726 @example
14727 @group
14728 a b
14729 17---d
14730 c
14731 @end group
14732 @end example
14733
14734 @noindent
14735 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
14736 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
14737 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
14738 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
14739 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
14740 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
14741
14742 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
14743 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
14744 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
14745 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
14746 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
14747 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
14748
14749 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
14750 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
14751 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
14752 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
14753 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
14754
14755 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
14756 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
14757
14758 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
14759 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
14760
14761 @noindent
14762 @ignore
14763 @starindex
14764 @end ignore
14765 @tindex cvert
14766 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
14767 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
14768 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
14769 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
14770 formats in Big mode as
14771
14772 @example
14773 @group
14774 f( a , 2 )
14775 bb a + 1
14776 ccc 2
14777 b
14778 @end group
14779 @end example
14780
14781 @ignore
14782 @starindex
14783 @end ignore
14784 @tindex cbase
14785 There are several special composition functions that work only as
14786 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
14787 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
14788 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
14789 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
14790 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
14791
14792 @example
14793 @group
14794 2
14795 a + 1
14796 a 2
14797 f(bb , b )
14798 ccc
14799 @end group
14800 @end example
14801
14802 @ignore
14803 @starindex
14804 @end ignore
14805 @tindex ctbase
14806 @ignore
14807 @starindex
14808 @end ignore
14809 @tindex cbbase
14810 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
14811 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
14812 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
14813 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
14814 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
14815
14816 @example
14817 @group
14818 a
14819 a -
14820 - + a + b
14821 b -
14822 b
14823 @end group
14824 @end example
14825
14826 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
14827 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
14828 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
14829 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
14830 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
14831 item.
14832
14833 @ignore
14834 @starindex
14835 @end ignore
14836 @tindex crule
14837 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
14838 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
14839 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
14840 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
14841 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
14842 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
14843 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
14844
14845 @example
14846 @group
14847 a + 1
14848 =====
14849 2
14850 b
14851 @end group
14852 @end example
14853
14854 @ignore
14855 @starindex
14856 @end ignore
14857 @tindex clvert
14858 @ignore
14859 @starindex
14860 @end ignore
14861 @tindex crvert
14862 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
14863 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
14864 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
14865 gives:
14866
14867 @example
14868 @group
14869 a + a
14870 bb bb
14871 ccc ccc
14872 @end group
14873 @end example
14874
14875 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
14876 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
14877 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
14878
14879 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
14880 @subsubsection Other Compositions
14881
14882 @noindent
14883 @ignore
14884 @starindex
14885 @end ignore
14886 @tindex csup
14887 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
14888 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
14889 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
14890 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
14891 bottom line is one above the baseline.
14892
14893 @ignore
14894 @starindex
14895 @end ignore
14896 @tindex csub
14897 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
14898 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
14899 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
14900 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
14901 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
14902
14903 @ignore
14904 @starindex
14905 @end ignore
14906 @tindex cflat
14907 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
14908 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
14909 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
14910 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
14911 to improve its readability.
14912
14913 @ignore
14914 @starindex
14915 @end ignore
14916 @tindex cspace
14917 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
14918 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
14919 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
14920 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
14921 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
14922 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
14923 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
14924
14925 @example
14926 @group
14927 2 2 2 2
14928 a a a a
14929 @end group
14930 @end example
14931
14932 @noindent
14933 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
14934
14935 @ignore
14936 @starindex
14937 @end ignore
14938 @tindex cvspace
14939 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
14940 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
14941 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
14942 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
14943 height if used in a vertical composition.
14944
14945 @ignore
14946 @starindex
14947 @end ignore
14948 @tindex ctspace
14949 @ignore
14950 @starindex
14951 @end ignore
14952 @tindex cbspace
14953 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
14954 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
14955 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
14956 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
14957 displays as:
14958
14959 @example
14960 @group
14961 a
14962 -
14963 a b
14964 - a a
14965 b + - + -
14966 a b b
14967 - a
14968 b -
14969 b
14970 @end group
14971 @end example
14972
14973 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
14974 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
14975
14976 @noindent
14977 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
14978 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
14979 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
14980
14981 @ignore
14982 @starindex
14983 @end ignore
14984 @tindex cwidth
14985 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
14986 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
14987 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
14988 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
14989 the composition functions described in this section.
14990
14991 @ignore
14992 @starindex
14993 @end ignore
14994 @tindex cheight
14995 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
14996 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
14997
14998 @ignore
14999 @starindex
15000 @end ignore
15001 @tindex cascent
15002 @ignore
15003 @starindex
15004 @end ignore
15005 @tindex cdescent
15006 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15007 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15008 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15009 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15010 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15011 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15012 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15013 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15014
15015 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15016 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15017
15018 @noindent
15019 @kindex Z C
15020 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15021 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15022 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15023 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15024 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15025 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15026 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15027 replaced.
15028
15029 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15030 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15031 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15032 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15033 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15034 affect the display at all.
15035
15036 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15037 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15038 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15039 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15040 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15041 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15042 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15043 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15044 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15045 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15046
15047 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15048 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15049 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15050
15051 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15052 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15053
15054 @example
15055 @group
15056 n
15057 ( )
15058 m
15059 @end group
15060 @end example
15061
15062 @noindent
15063 You might prefer the notation,
15064
15065 @example
15066 @group
15067 C
15068 n m
15069 @end group
15070 @end example
15071
15072 @noindent
15073 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15074 then put the formula
15075
15076 @smallexample
15077 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15078 @end smallexample
15079
15080 @noindent
15081 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15082 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15083 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15084 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15085 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15086 as an algebraic entry.
15087
15088 @example
15089 @group
15090 C + C
15091 a b 7 3
15092 @end group
15093 @end example
15094
15095 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15096 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15097 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15098 instead of parentheses.
15099
15100 @smallexample
15101 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15102 @end smallexample
15103
15104 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15105 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15106
15107 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15108 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15109 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15110 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15111 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15112 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15113 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15114 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15115 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15116 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15117 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15118 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15119
15120 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15121 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15122 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15123 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15124 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15125 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15126 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15127 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15128 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15129 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15130 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15131 symbolic form.
15132
15133 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15134 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15135 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15136 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15137 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15138 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15139 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15140 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15141 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15142
15143 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15144 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15145
15146 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15147 @subsection Syntax Tables
15148
15149 @noindent
15150 @cindex Syntax tables
15151 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15152 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15153 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15154 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15155
15156 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15157 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15158
15159 @kindex Z S
15160 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15161 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15162 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15163 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15164 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15165 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15166 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15167 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15168
15169 @menu
15170 * Syntax Table Basics::
15171 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15172 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15173 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15174 @end menu
15175
15176 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15177 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15178
15179 @noindent
15180 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15181 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15182 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15183 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15184 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15185 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15186 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15187 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15188 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15189 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15190
15191 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15192 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15193 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15194 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15195 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15196 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15197 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15198 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15199 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15200 completely different.)
15201
15202 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15203 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15204 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15205
15206 @example
15207 foo ( ) := 2+3
15208 @end example
15209
15210 @noindent
15211 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15212 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15213 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15214 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15215 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15216 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15217 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15218 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15219 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15220 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15221 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15222 calls would no longer recognize it!
15223
15224 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15225 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15226 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15227
15228 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15229 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15230 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15231 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15232 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15233 and postfix operator, respectively:
15234
15235 @example
15236 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15237 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15238 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15239 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15240 @end example
15241
15242 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15243 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15244
15245 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15246 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15247 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15248 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15249 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15250 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15251 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15252 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15253 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15254 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15255 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15256 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15257
15258 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15259 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15260 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15261 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15262 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15263 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15264 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15265 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15266
15267 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15268 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15269 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15270 rule,
15271
15272 @example
15273 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15274 @end example
15275
15276 @noindent
15277 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15278 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15279 define these operators quite easily:
15280
15281 @example
15282 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15283 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15284 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15285 @end example
15286
15287 @noindent
15288 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15289 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15290 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15291 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15292
15293 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15294 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15295
15296 @example
15297 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15298 @end example
15299
15300 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15301 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15302 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15303 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15304 backslashes in tokens.)
15305
15306 @example
15307 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15308 @end example
15309
15310 @noindent
15311 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15312
15313 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15314 it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15315 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15316 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15317 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15318 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15319 respectively).
15320
15321 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15322 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15323
15324 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15325 @subsubsection Precedence
15326
15327 @noindent
15328 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15329 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15330
15331 @example
15332 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15333 @end example
15334
15335 @noindent
15336 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15337 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15338 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15339 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15340 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15341 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15342
15343 @example
15344 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15345 @end example
15346
15347 @noindent
15348 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15349 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15350 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15351 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15352 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15353 can create a right-associative operator.
15354
15355 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15356 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15357 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15358
15359 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15360 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15361
15362 @noindent
15363 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15364 write
15365
15366 @example
15367 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15368 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15369 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15370 @end example
15371
15372 @noindent
15373 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15374 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15375 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15376
15377 @example
15378 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15379 @end example
15380
15381 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15382 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15383 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15384 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15385 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15386 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15387 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15388 several expressions separated by commas.
15389
15390 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15391 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15392 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15393 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15394 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15395 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15396
15397 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15398 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15399 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15400 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15401 always be an empty vector.
15402
15403 @example
15404 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15405 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15406 @end example
15407
15408 @noindent
15409 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15410 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15411 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15412 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15413 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15414
15415 @example
15416 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15417 @end example
15418
15419 @noindent
15420 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15421 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15422
15423 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15424 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15425 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15426
15427 @example
15428 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15429 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15430 @end example
15431
15432 @noindent
15433 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15434 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15435 empty vector is produced.
15436
15437 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15438 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15439 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15440 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15441 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15442 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15443 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15444 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15445 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15446 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15447 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15448 as optional.
15449
15450 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15451 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15452
15453 @example
15454 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15455 @end example
15456
15457 @noindent
15458 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15459 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15460 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15461 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15462 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15463 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15464 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15465
15466 @example
15467 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15468 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15469 @end example
15470
15471 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15472 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15473 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15474 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15475 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15476 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15477 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15478
15479 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15480 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15481
15482 @noindent
15483 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15484 example, the rules
15485
15486 @example
15487 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15488 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15489 @end example
15490
15491 @noindent
15492 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15493 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15494 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15495 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15496 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15497 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15498
15499 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15500 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15501 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15502 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15503 as if by the @w{@kbd{a s}} algebra command (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15504 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15505 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15506 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15507 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15508 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15509 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15510
15511 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15512 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15513 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15514 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15515 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15516 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15517
15518 @example
15519 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15520 @end example
15521
15522 @noindent
15523 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15524 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15525 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15526 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15527
15528 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15529 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15530 rules.
15531
15532 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15533 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15534 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15535 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15536 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15537 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15538
15539 @example
15540 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15541 @end example
15542
15543 @noindent
15544 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15545 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15546 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15547 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15548 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15549 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15550 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15551 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15552
15553 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15554 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15555
15556 @noindent
15557 @kindex m g
15558 @pindex calc-get-modes
15559 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15560 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15561 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15562 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15563 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15564 on the current mode settings.
15565
15566 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15567 @vindex Modes
15568 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15569 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15570 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15571 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15572 command will continue to work, however.)
15573
15574 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15575 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15576 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15577 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15578
15579 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15580
15581 @enumerate
15582 @item
15583 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15584
15585 @item
15586 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15587
15588 @item
15589 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15590 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15591
15592 @item
15593 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15594
15595 @item
15596 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15597 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15598 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15599 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15600 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15601 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15602 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15603 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15604 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15605 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15606
15607 @item
15608 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15609 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15610
15611 @item
15612 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15613
15614 @item
15615 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15616
15617 @item
15618 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15619 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15620
15621 @item
15622 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15623 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15624 or @var{N} for
15625 @texline @math{N\times N}
15626 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15627 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15628
15629 @item
15630 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15631 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15632 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15633
15634 @item
15635 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15636 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15637 @end enumerate
15638
15639 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15640 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15641 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15642 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15643 keyboard macro.)
15644
15645 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15646 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15647
15648 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15649 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15650 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15651 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15652 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15653 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15654
15655 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15656 @section The Calc Mode Line
15657
15658 @noindent
15659 @cindex Mode line indicators
15660 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15661 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15662 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15663
15664 The basic mode line format is:
15665
15666 @example
15667 --%%-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15668 @end example
15669
15670 The @samp{%%} is the Emacs symbol for ``read-only''; it shows that
15671 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15672 as if it were text.
15673
15674 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15675 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15676 that are in effect.
15677
15678 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15679 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15680 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15681
15682 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15683 on the mode line:
15684
15685 @table @code
15686 @item Alg
15687 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15688
15689 @item Alg[(
15690 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15691
15692 @item Alg*
15693 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15694
15695 @item Symb
15696 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15697
15698 @item Matrix
15699 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15700
15701 @item Matrix@var{n}
15702 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15703
15704 @item SqMatrix
15705 Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15706
15707 @item Scalar
15708 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15709
15710 @item Polar
15711 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15712
15713 @item Frac
15714 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15715
15716 @item Inf
15717 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15718
15719 @item +Inf
15720 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15721
15722 @item NoSimp
15723 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15724
15725 @item NumSimp
15726 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15727
15728 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15729 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
15730
15731 @item AlgSimp
15732 Algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m A}).
15733
15734 @item ExtSimp
15735 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
15736
15737 @item UnitSimp
15738 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
15739
15740 @item Bin
15741 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15742
15743 @item Oct
15744 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
15745
15746 @item Hex
15747 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
15748
15749 @item Radix@var{n}
15750 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
15751
15752 @item Zero
15753 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
15754
15755 @item Big
15756 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15757
15758 @item Flat
15759 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
15760
15761 @item Unform
15762 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
15763
15764 @item C
15765 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
15766
15767 @item Pascal
15768 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
15769
15770 @item Fortran
15771 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
15772
15773 @item TeX
15774 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15775
15776 @item LaTeX
15777 La@TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
15778
15779 @item Eqn
15780 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
15781
15782 @item Math
15783 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
15784
15785 @item Maple
15786 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
15787
15788 @item Norm@var{n}
15789 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
15790
15791 @item Fix@var{n}
15792 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
15793
15794 @item Sci
15795 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
15796
15797 @item Sci@var{n}
15798 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
15799
15800 @item Eng
15801 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
15802
15803 @item Eng@var{n}
15804 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
15805
15806 @item Left@var{n}
15807 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
15808
15809 @item Right
15810 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
15811
15812 @item Right@var{n}
15813 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
15814
15815 @item Center
15816 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
15817
15818 @item Center@var{n}
15819 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
15820
15821 @item Wid@var{n}
15822 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
15823
15824 @item Wide
15825 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
15826
15827 @item Break
15828 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15829
15830 @item Save
15831 Record modes in @file{~/.calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
15832
15833 @item Local
15834 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15835
15836 @item LocEdit
15837 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15838
15839 @item LocPerm
15840 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15841
15842 @item Global
15843 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
15844
15845 @item Manual
15846 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
15847 Recomputation}).
15848
15849 @item Graph
15850 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
15851
15852 @item Sel
15853 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
15854
15855 @item Dirty
15856 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
15857
15858 @item Inv
15859 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
15860
15861 @item Hyp
15862 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
15863
15864 @item Keep
15865 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
15866
15867 @item Narrow
15868 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
15869 @end table
15870
15871 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
15872 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
15873
15874 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
15875 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
15876
15877 @noindent
15878 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
15879 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
15880 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
15881 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
15882 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
15883 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
15884 is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
15885
15886 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
15887 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
15888 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
15889
15890 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
15891 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
15892 interpret a prefix argument.
15893
15894 @menu
15895 * Basic Arithmetic::
15896 * Integer Truncation::
15897 * Complex Number Functions::
15898 * Conversions::
15899 * Date Arithmetic::
15900 * Financial Functions::
15901 * Binary Functions::
15902 @end menu
15903
15904 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
15905 @section Basic Arithmetic
15906
15907 @noindent
15908 @kindex +
15909 @pindex calc-plus
15910 @ignore
15911 @mindex @null
15912 @end ignore
15913 @tindex +
15914 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
15915 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
15916 onto the stack.
15917
15918 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
15919 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
15920 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
15921 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
15922 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
15923 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
15924 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
15925 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
15926 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
15927 to every element of a vector.
15928
15929 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
15930 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
15931 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
15932 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
15933 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
15934
15935 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
15936 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
15937 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
15938 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
15939 and then the two HMS forms are added.
15940
15941 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
15942 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
15943 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
15944 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
15945 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
15946 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
15947 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
15948 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
15949
15950 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
15951 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
15952 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
15953 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
15954 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
15955 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
15956 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
15957 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
15958
15959 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
15960 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
15961 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
15962 the two values.
15963
15964 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
15965 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
15966 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
15967 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
15968
15969 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
15970 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
15971 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
15972 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
15973
15974 @kindex -
15975 @pindex calc-minus
15976 @ignore
15977 @mindex @null
15978 @end ignore
15979 @tindex -
15980 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
15981 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
15982 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
15983 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
15984
15985 @kindex *
15986 @pindex calc-times
15987 @ignore
15988 @mindex @null
15989 @end ignore
15990 @tindex *
15991 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
15992 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
15993 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
15994 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
15995 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
15996 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
15997 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
15998 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
15999 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16000
16001 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16002 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16003 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16004 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16005 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16006 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16007 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16008 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16009
16010 @kindex /
16011 @pindex calc-divide
16012 @ignore
16013 @mindex @null
16014 @end ignore
16015 @tindex /
16016 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16017
16018 When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16019 is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16020 interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16021 @samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16022 parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16023 in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16024 multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16025 Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16026 @xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16027 the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16028 @code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16029 division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16030 precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16031 @smallexample
16032 @group
16033 a b
16034 ---.
16035 c d
16036 @end group
16037 @end smallexample
16038
16039 When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16040 computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16041 also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16042 effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16043 If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16044 plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16045 equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16046 Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16047 @emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16048 you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16049 solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16050 v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16051 @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16052 transpose the result.
16053
16054 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16055 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16056 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16057 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16058 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16059 interval.
16060
16061 @kindex ^
16062 @pindex calc-power
16063 @ignore
16064 @mindex @null
16065 @end ignore
16066 @tindex ^
16067 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16068 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16069 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16070 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16071 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16072 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16073
16074 @kindex I ^
16075 @tindex nroot
16076 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16077 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16078 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16079
16080 @kindex \
16081 @pindex calc-idiv
16082 @tindex idiv
16083 @ignore
16084 @mindex @null
16085 @end ignore
16086 @tindex \
16087 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16088 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16089 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16090 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16091 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16092 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16093
16094 @kindex %
16095 @pindex calc-mod
16096 @ignore
16097 @mindex @null
16098 @end ignore
16099 @tindex %
16100 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16101 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16102 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16103 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16104 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16105 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16106 must be positive real number.
16107
16108 @kindex :
16109 @pindex calc-fdiv
16110 @tindex fdiv
16111 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16112 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16113 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16114 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16115 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16116 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16117 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16118 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16119
16120 @kindex n
16121 @pindex calc-change-sign
16122 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16123 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16124 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16125
16126 @kindex A
16127 @pindex calc-abs
16128 @tindex abs
16129 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16130 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16131 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16132 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16133 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16134 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16135 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16136 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16137 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16138
16139 @kindex f A
16140 @pindex calc-abssqr
16141 @tindex abssqr
16142 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16143 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16144
16145 @kindex f s
16146 @pindex calc-sign
16147 @tindex sign
16148 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16149 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16150 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16151 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16152 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16153
16154 @kindex &
16155 @pindex calc-inv
16156 @tindex inv
16157 @cindex Reciprocal
16158 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16159 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16160 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16161
16162 @kindex Q
16163 @pindex calc-sqrt
16164 @tindex sqrt
16165 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16166 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16167 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16168
16169 @kindex f h
16170 @pindex calc-hypot
16171 @tindex hypot
16172 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16173 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16174 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16175 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16176 magnitudes are used.
16177
16178 @kindex f Q
16179 @pindex calc-isqrt
16180 @tindex isqrt
16181 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16182 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16183 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16184 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16185 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16186 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16187 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16188
16189 @kindex f n
16190 @kindex f x
16191 @pindex calc-min
16192 @tindex min
16193 @pindex calc-max
16194 @tindex max
16195 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16196 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16197 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16198 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16199 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16200 all the arguments.)
16201
16202 @kindex f M
16203 @kindex f X
16204 @pindex calc-mant-part
16205 @tindex mant
16206 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16207 @tindex xpon
16208 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16209 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16210 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16211 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16212 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16213 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16214 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16215 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16216 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16217 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16218 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16219 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16220 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16221
16222 @kindex f S
16223 @pindex calc-scale-float
16224 @tindex scf
16225 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16226 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16227 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16228 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16229 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16230
16231 @kindex f [
16232 @kindex f ]
16233 @pindex calc-decrement
16234 @pindex calc-increment
16235 @tindex decr
16236 @tindex incr
16237 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16238 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16239 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16240 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16241 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16242 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16243 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16244 @samp{0.0} produces
16245 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16246 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16247 where @expr{p} is the current
16248 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16249 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16250
16251 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16252 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16253 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16254 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16255 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16256 way floating-point numbers work.
16257
16258 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16259 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16260
16261 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16262 @section Integer Truncation
16263
16264 @noindent
16265 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16266 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16267 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16268 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16269 to integer form.
16270
16271 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16272 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16273
16274 @cindex Integer part of a number
16275 @kindex F
16276 @pindex calc-floor
16277 @tindex floor
16278 @tindex ffloor
16279 @ignore
16280 @mindex @null
16281 @end ignore
16282 @kindex H F
16283 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16284 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16285 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16286 @mathit{-4}.
16287
16288 @kindex I F
16289 @pindex calc-ceiling
16290 @tindex ceil
16291 @tindex fceil
16292 @ignore
16293 @mindex @null
16294 @end ignore
16295 @kindex H I F
16296 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16297 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16298 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16299
16300 @kindex R
16301 @pindex calc-round
16302 @tindex round
16303 @tindex fround
16304 @ignore
16305 @mindex @null
16306 @end ignore
16307 @kindex H R
16308 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16309 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16310 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16311 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16312 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16313
16314 @kindex I R
16315 @pindex calc-trunc
16316 @tindex trunc
16317 @tindex ftrunc
16318 @ignore
16319 @mindex @null
16320 @end ignore
16321 @kindex H I R
16322 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16323 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16324 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16325 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16326
16327 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16328 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16329 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16330 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16331 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16332 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16333
16334 @ignore
16335 @starindex
16336 @end ignore
16337 @tindex rounde
16338 @ignore
16339 @starindex
16340 @end ignore
16341 @tindex roundu
16342 @ignore
16343 @starindex
16344 @end ignore
16345 @tindex frounde
16346 @ignore
16347 @starindex
16348 @end ignore
16349 @tindex froundu
16350 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16351 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16352 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16353 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16354 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16355 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16356 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16357 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16358 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16359 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16360 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16361 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16362 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16363 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16364 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16365
16366 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16367 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16368 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16369 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16370 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16371 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16372 no second argument at all.
16373
16374 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16375 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16376 added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16377 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16378
16379 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16380 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16381 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16382 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16383
16384 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16385 @section Complex Number Functions
16386
16387 @noindent
16388 @kindex J
16389 @pindex calc-conj
16390 @tindex conj
16391 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16392 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16393 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16394 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16395 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16396
16397 @kindex G
16398 @pindex calc-argument
16399 @tindex arg
16400 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16401 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16402 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16403 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16404 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16405 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16406 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16407 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16408
16409 @pindex calc-imaginary
16410 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16411 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16412 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16413 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16414
16415 @kindex f r
16416 @pindex calc-re
16417 @tindex re
16418 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16419 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16420 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16421 the value part.)
16422
16423 @kindex f i
16424 @pindex calc-im
16425 @tindex im
16426 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16427 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16428 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16429
16430 @ignore
16431 @mindex v p
16432 @end ignore
16433 @kindex v p (complex)
16434 @pindex calc-pack
16435 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16436 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16437 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16438 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16439 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16440
16441 @ignore
16442 @mindex v u
16443 @end ignore
16444 @kindex v u (complex)
16445 @pindex calc-unpack
16446 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16447 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16448 into its separate components.
16449
16450 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16451 @section Conversions
16452
16453 @noindent
16454 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16455 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16456
16457 @kindex c f
16458 @pindex calc-float
16459 @tindex pfloat
16460 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16461 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16462 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16463 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16464 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16465 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16466 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16467 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16468 format may lose information.
16469
16470 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16471 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16472 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16473 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16474 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16475 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16476
16477 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16478 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16479 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16480 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16481
16482 @kindex H c f
16483 @tindex float
16484 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16485 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16486 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16487 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16488
16489 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16490 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16491 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16492 that appear right now.
16493
16494 @kindex c F
16495 @pindex calc-fraction
16496 @tindex pfrac
16497 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16498 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16499 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16500 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16501 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16502 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16503 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16504 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16505 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16506 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16507 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16508
16509 @kindex H c F
16510 @tindex frac
16511 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16512 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16513 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16514
16515 @kindex c d
16516 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16517 @tindex deg
16518 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16519 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16520 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16521 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16522
16523 @kindex c r
16524 @pindex calc-to-radians
16525 @tindex rad
16526 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16527 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16528
16529 @kindex c h
16530 @pindex calc-to-hms
16531 @tindex hms
16532 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16533 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16534 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16535 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16536 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16537
16538 @pindex calc-from-hms
16539 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16540 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16541
16542 @kindex c p
16543 @kindex I c p
16544 @pindex calc-polar
16545 @tindex polar
16546 @tindex rect
16547 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16548 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16549 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16550 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16551 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16552 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16553 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16554 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16555
16556 @kindex c c
16557 @pindex calc-clean
16558 @tindex pclean
16559 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16560 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16561 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16562 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16563 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16564 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16565 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16566 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16567 number (i.e., pervasively).
16568
16569 If the simplification mode is set below the default level, it is raised
16570 to the default level for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c}
16571 applies the default simplifications even if their automatic application
16572 is disabled. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16573
16574 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16575 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16576 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16577 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16578 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16579
16580 @kindex c 0-9
16581 @pindex calc-clean-num
16582 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16583 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16584 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16585 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16586
16587 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16588 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16589 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16590 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16591 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16592 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16593 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16594
16595 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16596 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16597 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16598 does not clip small numbers.)
16599
16600 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16601 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16602 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16603 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16604 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16605 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16606
16607 @kindex H c 0-9
16608 @kindex H c c
16609 @tindex clean
16610 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16611 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16612
16613 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16614 @section Date Arithmetic
16615
16616 @noindent
16617 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16618 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16619 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16620 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16621 letters.
16622
16623 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16624 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16625 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16626 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16627 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16628 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16629
16630 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16631 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16632 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16633
16634 @menu
16635 * Date Conversions::
16636 * Date Functions::
16637 * Time Zones::
16638 * Business Days::
16639 @end menu
16640
16641 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16642 @subsection Date Conversions
16643
16644 @noindent
16645 @kindex t D
16646 @pindex calc-date
16647 @tindex date
16648 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16649 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD. The
16650 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16651 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16652 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16653
16654 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16655 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16656 of the following ways:
16657
16658 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16659 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16660 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16661 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16662 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16663 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16664 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16665 month will be used.
16666
16667 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16668 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16669 real-time clock.
16670
16671 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16672 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16673
16674 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16675 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16676 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16677 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16678 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16679 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16680
16681 @kindex t J
16682 @pindex calc-julian
16683 @tindex julian
16684 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16685 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16686 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16687 since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC. A pure date is converted to an
16688 integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16689 is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16690 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16691 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16692 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16693 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16694 are never time-zone adjusted.
16695
16696 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16697 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16698 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16699 current or specified time zone.
16700
16701 @kindex t U
16702 @pindex calc-unix-time
16703 @tindex unixtime
16704 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16705 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16706 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16707 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16708 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16709 precisions, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16710 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16711 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16712 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16713 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16714 suppress the adjustment if so.
16715
16716 @kindex t C
16717 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16718 @tindex tzconv
16719 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16720 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16721 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16722 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16723 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16724 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16725 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16726 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16727 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
16728
16729 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
16730 @subsection Date Functions
16731
16732 @noindent
16733 @kindex t N
16734 @pindex calc-now
16735 @tindex now
16736 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
16737 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
16738 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
16739 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
16740
16741 @kindex t P
16742 @pindex calc-date-part
16743 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
16744 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
16745 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
16746 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
16747
16748 @tindex year
16749 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
16750 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
16751 following functions will also accept a real number for an
16752 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
16753 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
16754 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
16755
16756 @tindex month
16757 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
16758 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
16759
16760 @tindex day
16761 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
16762 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
16763
16764 @tindex hour
16765 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
16766 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
16767 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
16768 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
16769 HMS forms as input.
16770
16771 @tindex minute
16772 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
16773 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
16774
16775 @tindex second
16776 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
16777 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
16778 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
16779 precisions, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
16780
16781 @tindex weekday
16782 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
16783 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
16784 to 6 (Saturday).
16785
16786 @tindex yearday
16787 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
16788 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
16789 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
16790
16791 @tindex time
16792 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
16793 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
16794 for a pure date form.
16795
16796 @kindex t M
16797 @pindex calc-new-month
16798 @tindex newmonth
16799 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
16800 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
16801 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
16802 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
16803 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
16804 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
16805 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
16806 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
16807
16808 @kindex t Y
16809 @pindex calc-new-year
16810 @tindex newyear
16811 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
16812 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
16813 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
16814 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
16815 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
16816 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
16817 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
16818 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
16819 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
16820
16821 @kindex t W
16822 @pindex calc-new-week
16823 @tindex newweek
16824 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
16825 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
16826 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
16827 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
16828 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
16829 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
16830
16831 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
16832 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
16833 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
16834 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
16835 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
16836 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
16837 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
16838 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
16839 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
16840 the time to midnight; hint:@: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
16841 of the @code{weekday} function?).
16842
16843 @ignore
16844 @starindex
16845 @end ignore
16846 @tindex pwday
16847 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
16848 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
16849 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
16850 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
16851 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
16852 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
16853 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
16854 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
16855 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
16856 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
16857 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
16858
16859 @kindex t I
16860 @pindex calc-inc-month
16861 @tindex incmonth
16862 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
16863 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
16864 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
16865 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
16866 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
16867 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
16868 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
16869 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
16870 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
16871 in this case).
16872
16873 @ignore
16874 @starindex
16875 @end ignore
16876 @tindex incyear
16877 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
16878 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
16879 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
16880 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
16881 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
16882 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
16883 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
16884 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
16885
16886 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
16887 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
16888 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
16889
16890 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
16891 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
16892
16893 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
16894 @subsection Business Days
16895
16896 @noindent
16897 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
16898 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
16899 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
16900 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
16901 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
16902 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
16903
16904 @kindex t +
16905 @kindex t -
16906 @tindex badd
16907 @tindex bsub
16908 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
16909 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
16910 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
16911 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
16912 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
16913 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
16914 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
16915 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
16916 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
16917 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
16918 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
16919 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
16920 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
16921 case the result is the number of business days between the two
16922 dates.
16923
16924 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
16925 @vindex Holidays
16926 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
16927 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
16928 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
16929 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
16930 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
16931 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
16932 be any of the following kinds of objects:
16933
16934 @itemize @bullet
16935 @item
16936 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
16937 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
16938
16939 @item
16940 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
16941 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
16942
16943 @item
16944 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
16945 considered to be a holiday.
16946
16947 @item
16948 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
16949 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
16950 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
16951 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
16952 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
16953 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
16954 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
16955 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
16956 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
16957
16958 @item
16959 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
16960 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
16961
16962 @item
16963 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
16964 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
16965 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
16966 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
16967 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
16968 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
16969 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
16970 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
16971 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
16972 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
16973
16974 @item
16975 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
16976 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
16977 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
16978 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
16979 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
16980 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
16981 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
16982 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
16983 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
16984 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
16985 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
16986 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
16987 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
16988 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
16989 @end itemize
16990
16991 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
16992 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
16993 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
16994
16995 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
16996 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
16997 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
16998 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
16999 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17000 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17001
17002 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17003 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17004 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17005 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17006 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17007 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17008 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17009 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17010
17011 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17012 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17013 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17014 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17015 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17016 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17017 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17018 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17019 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17020 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17021 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17022 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17023 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17024 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17025 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17026
17027 @ignore
17028 @starindex
17029 @end ignore
17030 @tindex holiday
17031 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17032 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17033 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17034 business day.
17035
17036 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17037 @subsection Time Zones
17038
17039 @noindent
17040 @cindex Time zones
17041 @cindex Daylight saving time
17042 Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17043 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17044 compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17045 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17046 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17047 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17048 can't determine the right correction to use.
17049
17050 Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17051 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17052 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17053 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17054 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17055 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17056 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17057 default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17058 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17059 evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17060 because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17061 April 7, 1991.
17062
17063 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17064 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17065 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17066 days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17067
17068 @pindex calc-time-zone
17069 @ignore
17070 @starindex
17071 @end ignore
17072 @tindex tzone
17073 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17074 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17075 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17076 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17077 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17078 Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17079 the normal difference.
17080
17081 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17082 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17083 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17084 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17085 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17086 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17087 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17088 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17089 (for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17090
17091 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17092 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17093 another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17094 in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17095
17096 @smallexample
17097 @group
17098 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17099 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17100
17101 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17102 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17103
17104 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17105 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17106 @end group
17107 @end smallexample
17108
17109 @vindex math-tzone-names
17110 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17111 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17112 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17113 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17114 Pacific Time look like this:
17115
17116 @smallexample
17117 @group
17118 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17119 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17120 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17121 @end group
17122 @end smallexample
17123
17124 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17125 @vindex TimeZone
17126 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17127 default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17128 calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17129 emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17130 calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17131 @code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17132 time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17133 @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17134 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17135 @code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17136 If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17137 e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17138 to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17139 is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17140 used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17141 The special time zone name @code{local}
17142 is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17143 from the calendar.
17144
17145 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17146 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17147 information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17148 otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17149
17150 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17151 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17152 When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17153 the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17154 daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17155 (for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17156 before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17157 November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17158 years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17159 much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17160 that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17161 for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17162 daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17163 @code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17164 the conversion functions.
17165
17166 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17167 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17168 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17169 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17170 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17171
17172 The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17173 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17174 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17175 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17176 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17177 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17178 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17179
17180 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17181 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17182 daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17183 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17184 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17185 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17186 and the weekday number (0-6).
17187
17188 The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17189 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17190 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17191 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17192 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17193 daylight saving hook:
17194
17195 @smallexample
17196 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17197 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17198 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17199 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17200 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17201 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17202 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17203 (t -1))))
17204 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17205 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17206 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17207 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17208 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17209 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17210 (t 0))))
17211 (t 0))
17212 )
17213 @end smallexample
17214
17215 @noindent
17216 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17217 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17218 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17219 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17220 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17221
17222 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17223 beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17224 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17225 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17226 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17227 form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17228 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17229 later).
17230
17231 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17232 daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17233
17234 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17235 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17236 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17237 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17238 daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17239 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17240 daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17241 the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17242 that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17243 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17244 is typically represented in.
17245
17246 @ignore
17247 @starindex
17248 @end ignore
17249 @tindex dsadj
17250 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17251 daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17252 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17253 daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17254 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17255 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17256 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17257
17258 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, for the address of Calc's author, if you
17259 should wish to contribute your improved versions of
17260 @code{math-tzone-names} and @code{math-daylight-savings-hook}
17261 to the Calc distribution.
17262
17263 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17264 @section Financial Functions
17265
17266 @noindent
17267 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17268 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17269 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17270
17271 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17272 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17273 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17274 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17275
17276 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17277 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17278 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17279 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17280
17281 @menu
17282 * Percentages::
17283 * Future Value::
17284 * Present Value::
17285 * Related Financial Functions::
17286 * Depreciation Functions::
17287 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17288 @end menu
17289
17290 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17291 @subsection Percentages
17292
17293 @kindex M-%
17294 @pindex calc-percent
17295 @tindex %
17296 @tindex percent
17297 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17298 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17299 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17300 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17301
17302 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17303 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17304 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17305 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17306 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17307 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17308 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17309 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17310
17311 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17312 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17313 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17314 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17315 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17316 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17317
17318 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17319 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17320 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17321 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17322
17323 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17324 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17325 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17326
17327 @kindex c %
17328 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17329 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17330 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17331 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17332 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17333 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17334 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17335 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17336
17337 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17338 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17339 @samp{25%}.
17340
17341 @kindex b %
17342 @pindex calc-percent-change
17343 @tindex relch
17344 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17345 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17346 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17347 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17348 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17349 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17350 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17351 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17352 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17353 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17354
17355 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17356 @subsection Future Value
17357
17358 @noindent
17359 @kindex b F
17360 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17361 @tindex fv
17362 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17363 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17364 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17365 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17366 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17367 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17368 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17369 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17370 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17371 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17372
17373 @kindex I b F
17374 @tindex fvb
17375 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17376 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17377 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17378 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17379 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17380 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17381 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17382 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17383 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17384
17385 @kindex H b F
17386 @tindex fvl
17387 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17388 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17389 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17390 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17391
17392 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17393 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17394 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17395 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17396 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17397
17398 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17399 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17400 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17401 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17402 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17403 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17404 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17405 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17406 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17407 by @code{fvb} directly.
17408
17409 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17410 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17411 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17412 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17413 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17414 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17415 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17416
17417 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17418 @subsection Present Value
17419
17420 @noindent
17421 @kindex b P
17422 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17423 @tindex pv
17424 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17425 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17426 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17427 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17428 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17429 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17430 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17431 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17432 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17433 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17434 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17435 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17436 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17437
17438 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17439 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17440 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17441 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17442 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17443 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17444 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17445 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17446 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17447
17448 @kindex I b P
17449 @tindex pvb
17450 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17451 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17452 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17453 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17454 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17455 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17456
17457 @kindex H b P
17458 @tindex pvl
17459 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17460 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17461 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17462 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17463 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17464 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17465 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17466
17467 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17468 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17469 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17470
17471 @kindex b N
17472 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17473 @tindex npv
17474 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17475 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17476 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17477 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17478 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17479 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17480 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17481
17482 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17483 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17484 not all the same!
17485
17486 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17487 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17488 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17489 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17490 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17491 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17492 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17493 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17494
17495 @kindex I b N
17496 @tindex npvb
17497 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17498 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17499 rather than at the end.
17500
17501 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17502 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17503
17504 @noindent
17505 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17506 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17507
17508 @kindex b M
17509 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17510 @tindex pmt
17511 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17512 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17513 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17514 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17515 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17516
17517 @kindex I b M
17518 @tindex pmtb
17519 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17520 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17521 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17522 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17523
17524 @kindex H b M
17525 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17526 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17527
17528 @kindex b #
17529 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17530 @tindex nper
17531 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17532 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17533 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17534 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17535 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17536 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17537 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17538
17539 @kindex I b #
17540 @tindex nperb
17541 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17542 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17543 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17544 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17545
17546 @kindex H b #
17547 @tindex nperl
17548 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17549 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17550 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17551 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17552 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17553
17554 @kindex b T
17555 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17556 @tindex rate
17557 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17558 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17559 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17560 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17561 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17562
17563 @kindex I b T
17564 @kindex H b T
17565 @tindex rateb
17566 @tindex ratel
17567 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17568 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17569 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17570 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17571 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17572 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17573 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17574
17575 @kindex b I
17576 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17577 @tindex irr
17578 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17579 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17580 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17581 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17582 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17583
17584 @kindex I b I
17585 @tindex irrb
17586 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17587 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17588
17589 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17590 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17591
17592 @noindent
17593 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17594 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17595 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17596 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17597 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17598 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17599
17600 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17601 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17602
17603 @kindex b S
17604 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17605 @tindex sln
17606 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17607 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17608 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17609 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17610 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17611 per year.
17612
17613 @kindex b Y
17614 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17615 @tindex syd
17616 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17617 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17618 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17619 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17620 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17621 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17622 return zero.
17623
17624 @kindex b D
17625 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17626 @tindex ddb
17627 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17628 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17629 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17630
17631 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17632 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17633 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17634
17635 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17636 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17637 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17638 the three depreciation methods:
17639
17640 @example
17641 @group
17642 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17643 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17644 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17645 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17646 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17647 @end group
17648 @end example
17649
17650 @noindent
17651 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17652 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17653 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17654 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17655
17656 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17657 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17658 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17659
17660 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17661 @subsection Definitions
17662
17663 @noindent
17664 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17665 Calc's financial functions.
17666
17667 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17668 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17669 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17670 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17671 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17672 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17673
17674 @ifnottex
17675 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17676 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17677 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17678
17679 @example
17680 n
17681 (1 + rate) - 1
17682 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17683 rate
17684
17685 n
17686 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17687 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17688 rate
17689
17690 n
17691 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17692
17693 -n
17694 1 - (1 + rate)
17695 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17696 rate
17697
17698 -n
17699 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17700 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17701 rate
17702
17703 -n
17704 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17705
17706 -1 -2 -3
17707 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17708
17709 -1 -2
17710 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17711
17712 -n
17713 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17714 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17715 -n
17716 1 - (1 + rate)
17717
17718 -n
17719 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17720 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17721 -n
17722 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17723
17724 amt * rate
17725 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17726 pmt
17727
17728 amt * rate
17729 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17730 pmt * (1 + rate)
17731
17732 amt
17733 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
17734 pmt
17735
17736 1/n
17737 pmt
17738 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
17739 1/n
17740 amt
17741
17742 cost - salv
17743 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
17744 life
17745
17746 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
17747 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
17748 life * (life + 1) / 2
17749
17750 book * 2
17751 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
17752 life
17753 @end example
17754 @end ifnottex
17755 @tex
17756 \turnoffactive
17757 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
17758 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17759 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
17760 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
17761 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
17762 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
17763 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
17764 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
17765 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
17766 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
17767 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
17768 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
17769 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
17770 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
17771 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
17772 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
17773 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
17774 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
17775 @end tex
17776
17777 @noindent
17778 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
17779
17780 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
17781 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
17782 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
17783 all sorts of inputs.
17784
17785 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
17786 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
17787 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
17788
17789 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
17790 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
17791 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
17792 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
17793 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
17794 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
17795
17796 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
17797 for @samp{rate}.
17798
17799 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
17800 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
17801 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
17802
17803 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
17804 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
17805 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
17806
17807 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
17808 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
17809 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
17810 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
17811 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
17812 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
17813 period.
17814
17815 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
17816 @section Binary Number Functions
17817
17818 @noindent
17819 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
17820 the @kbd{b} prefix.
17821
17822 @cindex Binary numbers
17823 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
17824 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
17825 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
17826 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
17827 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
17828
17829 @cindex Word size for binary operations
17830 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
17831 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
17832 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
17833 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
17834 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
17835
17836 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce 2's complement
17837 integers from
17838 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
17839 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
17840 to
17841 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
17842 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
17843 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
17844 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
17845
17846 @kindex b c
17847 @pindex calc-clip
17848 @tindex clip
17849 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
17850 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
17851 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
17852 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
17853 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
17854 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
17855 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
17856 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
17857 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
17858
17859 @kindex b w
17860 @pindex calc-word-size
17861 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
17862 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
17863 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
17864 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
17865 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
17866 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
17867 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
17868
17869 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
17870 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
17871 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
17872 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
17873 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
17874 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
17875 integer-valued floats.
17876
17877 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
17878 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
17879 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
17880 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
17881
17882 @kindex b a
17883 @pindex calc-and
17884 @tindex and
17885 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
17886 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
17887 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
17888 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
17889 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
17890
17891 @kindex b o
17892 @pindex calc-or
17893 @tindex or
17894 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
17895 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
17896 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
17897
17898 @kindex b x
17899 @pindex calc-xor
17900 @tindex xor
17901 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
17902 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
17903 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
17904
17905 @kindex b d
17906 @pindex calc-diff
17907 @tindex diff
17908 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
17909 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
17910 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
17911
17912 @kindex b n
17913 @pindex calc-not
17914 @tindex not
17915 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
17916 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
17917
17918 @kindex b l
17919 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
17920 @tindex lsh
17921 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
17922 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
17923 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
17924 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
17925 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
17926 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
17927
17928 @kindex H b l
17929 @kindex H b r
17930 @ignore
17931 @mindex @idots
17932 @end ignore
17933 @kindex H b L
17934 @ignore
17935 @mindex @null
17936 @end ignore
17937 @kindex H b R
17938 @ignore
17939 @mindex @null
17940 @end ignore
17941 @kindex H b t
17942 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
17943 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
17944 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
17945 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
17946 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
17947
17948 @kindex b r
17949 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
17950 @tindex rsh
17951 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
17952 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
17953 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
17954
17955 @kindex b L
17956 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
17957 @tindex ash
17958 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
17959 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
17960 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
17961 is performed as described below.
17962
17963 @kindex b R
17964 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
17965 @tindex rash
17966 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
17967 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
17968 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
17969 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
17970 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
17971 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
17972 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
17973 performs a standard left shift.
17974
17975 @kindex b t
17976 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
17977 @tindex rot
17978 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
17979 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
17980 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
17981 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
17982 or right.
17983
17984 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
17985 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
17986 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
17987 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
17988 bits in a binary integer.
17989
17990 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
17991 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
17992 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
17993 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
17994 into a binary integer.
17995
17996 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
17997 @chapter Scientific Functions
17998
17999 @noindent
18000 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18001 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18002 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18003 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18004
18005 @kindex P
18006 @pindex calc-pi
18007 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18008 @vindex pi
18009 @kindex H P
18010 @cindex @code{e} variable
18011 @vindex e
18012 @kindex I P
18013 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18014 @vindex gamma
18015 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18016 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18017 @kindex H I P
18018 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18019 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18020 @cindex Golden ratio
18021 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18022 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18023 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18024 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18025 @texline @math{\gamma}
18026 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18027 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18028 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18029 @texline @math{\phi}
18030 @infoline @expr{phi}
18031 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18032 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18033 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18034 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18035 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18036
18037 @ignore
18038 @mindex Q
18039 @end ignore
18040 @ignore
18041 @mindex I Q
18042 @end ignore
18043 @kindex I Q
18044 @tindex sqr
18045 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18046 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18047 computes the square of the argument.
18048
18049 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18050 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18051 interpret a prefix argument.
18052
18053 @menu
18054 * Logarithmic Functions::
18055 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18056 * Advanced Math Functions::
18057 * Branch Cuts::
18058 * Random Numbers::
18059 * Combinatorial Functions::
18060 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18061 @end menu
18062
18063 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18064 @section Logarithmic Functions
18065
18066 @noindent
18067 @kindex L
18068 @pindex calc-ln
18069 @tindex ln
18070 @ignore
18071 @mindex @null
18072 @end ignore
18073 @kindex I E
18074 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18075 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18076 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18077 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18078
18079 @kindex E
18080 @pindex calc-exp
18081 @tindex exp
18082 @ignore
18083 @mindex @null
18084 @end ignore
18085 @kindex I L
18086 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18087 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18088 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18089 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18090
18091 @kindex H L
18092 @kindex H E
18093 @pindex calc-log10
18094 @tindex log10
18095 @tindex exp10
18096 @ignore
18097 @mindex @null
18098 @end ignore
18099 @kindex H I L
18100 @ignore
18101 @mindex @null
18102 @end ignore
18103 @kindex H I E
18104 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18105 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18106 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18107 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18108 by
18109 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18110 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18111
18112 @kindex B
18113 @kindex I B
18114 @pindex calc-log
18115 @tindex log
18116 @tindex alog
18117 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18118 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18119 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18120 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18121 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18122 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18123 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18124 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18125
18126 @kindex f I
18127 @pindex calc-ilog
18128 @tindex ilog
18129 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18130 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18131 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18132 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18133 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18134 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18135 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18136
18137 @kindex f E
18138 @pindex calc-expm1
18139 @tindex expm1
18140 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18141 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18142 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18143 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18144 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18145 @texline @math{e^x}
18146 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18147 is close to one.
18148
18149 @kindex f L
18150 @pindex calc-lnp1
18151 @tindex lnp1
18152 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18153 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18154 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18155 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18156
18157 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18158 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18159
18160 @noindent
18161 @kindex S
18162 @pindex calc-sin
18163 @tindex sin
18164 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18165 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18166 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18167 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18168 on complex numbers.
18169
18170 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18171 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18172 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18173 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18174 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18175
18176 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18177 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18178 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command recognizes many such
18179 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18180 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18181 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18182 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18183 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18184 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18185 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18186
18187 The @kbd{a s} command knows all angles which are integer multiples of
18188 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18189 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18190 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18191
18192 @kindex I S
18193 @pindex calc-arcsin
18194 @tindex arcsin
18195 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18196 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18197 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18198 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18199
18200 @kindex H S
18201 @pindex calc-sinh
18202 @tindex sinh
18203 @kindex H I S
18204 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18205 @tindex arcsinh
18206 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18207 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18208 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18209 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18210
18211 @kindex C
18212 @pindex calc-cos
18213 @tindex cos
18214 @ignore
18215 @mindex @idots
18216 @end ignore
18217 @kindex I C
18218 @pindex calc-arccos
18219 @ignore
18220 @mindex @null
18221 @end ignore
18222 @tindex arccos
18223 @ignore
18224 @mindex @null
18225 @end ignore
18226 @kindex H C
18227 @pindex calc-cosh
18228 @ignore
18229 @mindex @null
18230 @end ignore
18231 @tindex cosh
18232 @ignore
18233 @mindex @null
18234 @end ignore
18235 @kindex H I C
18236 @pindex calc-arccosh
18237 @ignore
18238 @mindex @null
18239 @end ignore
18240 @tindex arccosh
18241 @ignore
18242 @mindex @null
18243 @end ignore
18244 @kindex T
18245 @pindex calc-tan
18246 @ignore
18247 @mindex @null
18248 @end ignore
18249 @tindex tan
18250 @ignore
18251 @mindex @null
18252 @end ignore
18253 @kindex I T
18254 @pindex calc-arctan
18255 @ignore
18256 @mindex @null
18257 @end ignore
18258 @tindex arctan
18259 @ignore
18260 @mindex @null
18261 @end ignore
18262 @kindex H T
18263 @pindex calc-tanh
18264 @ignore
18265 @mindex @null
18266 @end ignore
18267 @tindex tanh
18268 @ignore
18269 @mindex @null
18270 @end ignore
18271 @kindex H I T
18272 @pindex calc-arctanh
18273 @ignore
18274 @mindex @null
18275 @end ignore
18276 @tindex arctanh
18277 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18278 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18279 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18280 variants of these functions.
18281
18282 @kindex f T
18283 @pindex calc-arctan2
18284 @tindex arctan2
18285 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18286 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18287 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18288 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18289 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18290 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18291 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18292 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18293 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18294 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18295
18296 @pindex calc-sincos
18297 @ignore
18298 @starindex
18299 @end ignore
18300 @tindex sincos
18301 @ignore
18302 @starindex
18303 @end ignore
18304 @ignore
18305 @mindex arc@idots
18306 @end ignore
18307 @tindex arcsincos
18308 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18309 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18310 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18311 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18312 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18313 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18314
18315 @pindex calc-sec
18316 @tindex sec
18317 @pindex calc-csc
18318 @tindex csc
18319 @pindex calc-cot
18320 @tindex cot
18321 @pindex calc-sech
18322 @tindex sech
18323 @pindex calc-csch
18324 @tindex csch
18325 @pindex calc-coth
18326 @tindex coth
18327 The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
18328 @code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}], are also
18329 available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18330 counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
18331 [@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-sech}
18332 [@code{sech}]. (These commmands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
18333
18334 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18335 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18336
18337 @noindent
18338 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18339 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18340 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18341 will work to arbitrarily large precisions. They can not at present
18342 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18343
18344 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18345 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18346 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18347 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18348 slow for some values of the arguments.
18349
18350 @kindex f g
18351 @pindex calc-gamma
18352 @tindex gamma
18353 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18354 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18355 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18356 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18357 integral:
18358 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18359 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18360 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18361
18362 @kindex f G
18363 @tindex gammaP
18364 @ignore
18365 @mindex @idots
18366 @end ignore
18367 @kindex I f G
18368 @ignore
18369 @mindex @null
18370 @end ignore
18371 @kindex H f G
18372 @ignore
18373 @mindex @null
18374 @end ignore
18375 @kindex H I f G
18376 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18377 @ignore
18378 @mindex @null
18379 @end ignore
18380 @tindex gammaQ
18381 @ignore
18382 @mindex @null
18383 @end ignore
18384 @tindex gammag
18385 @ignore
18386 @mindex @null
18387 @end ignore
18388 @tindex gammaG
18389 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18390 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18391 the integral,
18392 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18393 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18394 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18395 definition of the normal gamma function).
18396
18397 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18398 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18399 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18400 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18401 @expr{x} to infinity.
18402
18403 @ifnottex
18404 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18405 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18406 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18407 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18408 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18409 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18410 @end ifnottex
18411 @tex
18412 \turnoffactive
18413 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18414 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18415 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18416 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18417 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18418 @end tex
18419
18420 @kindex f b
18421 @pindex calc-beta
18422 @tindex beta
18423 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18424 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18425 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18426 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18427 or by
18428 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18429 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18430
18431 @kindex f B
18432 @kindex H f B
18433 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18434 @tindex betaI
18435 @tindex betaB
18436 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18437 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18438 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18439 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18440 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18441 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18442
18443 @kindex f e
18444 @kindex I f e
18445 @pindex calc-erf
18446 @tindex erf
18447 @tindex erfc
18448 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18449 error function
18450 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18451 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18452 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18453 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18454 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18455 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18456
18457 @kindex f j
18458 @kindex f y
18459 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18460 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18461 @tindex besJ
18462 @tindex besY
18463 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18464 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18465 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18466 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18467 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18468 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18469 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18470 Use with care!
18471
18472 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18473 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18474
18475 @noindent
18476 @cindex Branch cuts
18477 @cindex Principal values
18478 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18479 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18480 This section describes the values
18481 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18482 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18483 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18484 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18485 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18486
18487 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18488 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Versions of
18489 Calc starting with 2.00 follow the second edition.
18490
18491 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18492 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18493 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18494 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18495 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18496 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18497
18498 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18499 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18500 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18501 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18502
18503 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18504 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18505 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18506 in the right half of the complex plane.
18507
18508 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18509 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18510 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18511 negative real axis.
18512
18513 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18514 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18515 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18516 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18517 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18518
18519 @smallexample
18520 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18521 ----------------------------------------
18522 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18523 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18524 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18525 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18526 @end smallexample
18527
18528 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18529 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18530 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18531 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18532 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18533 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18534
18535 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18536 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18537
18538 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18539 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18540 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18541
18542 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18543 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18544 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18545
18546 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18547 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18548 above @expr{i}.
18549
18550 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18551 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18552 real axis less than 1.
18553
18554 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18555 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18556
18557 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18558 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18559 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18560
18561 @smallexample
18562 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18563 -------------------------------------------------------
18564 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18565 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18566 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18567 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18568 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18569 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18570 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18571 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18572 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18573 @end smallexample
18574
18575 @smallexample
18576 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18577 -----------------------------------------------------
18578 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18579 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18580 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18581 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18582 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18583 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18584 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18585 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18586 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18587 @end smallexample
18588
18589 @smallexample
18590 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18591 -----------------------------------------------------
18592 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18593 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18594 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18595 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18596 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18597 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18598 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18599 @end smallexample
18600
18601 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18602 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18603 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18604
18605 @smallexample
18606 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18607 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18608 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18609 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18610 @end smallexample
18611
18612 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18613 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18614 are not rigorously specified at present.
18615
18616 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18617 @section Random Numbers
18618
18619 @noindent
18620 @kindex k r
18621 @pindex calc-random
18622 @tindex random
18623 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18624 random numbers of various sorts.
18625
18626 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18627 integer @expr{N} in the range
18628 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18629 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18630 Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
18631
18632 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18633 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18634 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18635 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18636 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18637 the result is a random integer in the range
18638 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18639 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18640
18641 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18642 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18643 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18644 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18645 or
18646 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18647 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18648 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18649
18650 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18651 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18652 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18653 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18654
18655 If @expr{M} is an error form
18656 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18657 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18658 where @var{m} and
18659 @texline @math{\sigma}
18660 @infoline @var{s}
18661 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18662 @var{m} and standard deviation
18663 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18664 @infoline @var{s}.
18665
18666 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18667 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18668 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18669 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18670 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18671 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18672 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18673 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18674 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18675 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18676 extremely small.)
18677
18678 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18679 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18680
18681 @vindex RandSeed
18682 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18683 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18684 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18685 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18686 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18687 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18688 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18689 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18690 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18691 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18692 of random numbers as before.
18693
18694 @pindex calc-rrandom
18695 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18696 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18697
18698 @kindex k a
18699 @pindex calc-random-again
18700 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18701 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18702 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18703 that value of @expr{M}.
18704
18705 @kindex k h
18706 @pindex calc-shuffle
18707 @tindex shuffle
18708 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18709 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18710 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18711 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18712 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18713 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18714 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18715
18716 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18717 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18718 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18719 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18720 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18721 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18722 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18723 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18724 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18725 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18726 each make it into the result vector.)
18727
18728 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18729 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18730 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18731 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18732 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18733 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18734 a small discrete set of possibilities.
18735
18736 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
18737 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
18738 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
18739 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
18740 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
18741
18742 @menu
18743 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
18744 @end menu
18745
18746 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
18747 @subsection Random Number Generator
18748
18749 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
18750 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
18751 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
18752 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
18753 characterization.
18754
18755 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs' built-in
18756 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
18757 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
18758 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
18759
18760 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
18761 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
18762 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
18763
18764 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
18765 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
18766 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
18767 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
18768 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
18769 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
18770 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
18771 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
18772
18773 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
18774 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
18775 computing
18776 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
18777 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
18778 This method expands the seed
18779 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
18780 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
18781 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
18782 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
18783 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
18784 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
18785 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
18786 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
18787 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
18788 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
18789 to reseed the generator with that number.
18790
18791 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
18792 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
18793 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
18794 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
18795 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
18796 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
18797 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
18798 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
18799 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
18800 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
18801 damage its randomness.
18802
18803 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
18804 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
18805 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
18806 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
18807 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
18808 value.
18809
18810 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
18811 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
18812 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
18813 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
18814 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
18815 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
18816 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
18817 numbers on the order of
18818 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
18819 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
18820 or
18821 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
18822 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
18823 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
18824 correspond to small integers times
18825 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
18826 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
18827
18828 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
18829 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
18830 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
18831 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
18832 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
18833 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
18834 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
18835 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
18836 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
18837 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
18838
18839 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
18840 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C. This method
18841 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
18842 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
18843
18844 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
18845 @section Combinatorial Functions
18846
18847 @noindent
18848 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
18849 @kbd{k} key prefix.
18850
18851 @kindex k g
18852 @pindex calc-gcd
18853 @tindex gcd
18854 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
18855 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
18856 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
18857 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
18858 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
18859 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
18860 the operation is left in symbolic form.
18861
18862 @kindex k l
18863 @pindex calc-lcm
18864 @tindex lcm
18865 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
18866 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
18867 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
18868 numbers.
18869
18870 @kindex k E
18871 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
18872 @tindex egcd
18873 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
18874 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
18875 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
18876 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
18877 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
18878
18879 @kindex !
18880 @pindex calc-factorial
18881 @tindex fact
18882 @ignore
18883 @mindex @null
18884 @end ignore
18885 @tindex !
18886 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
18887 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
18888 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
18889 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
18890 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
18891 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
18892 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
18893 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
18894 the commands in this section.
18895
18896 @kindex k d
18897 @pindex calc-double-factorial
18898 @tindex dfact
18899 @ignore
18900 @mindex @null
18901 @end ignore
18902 @tindex !!
18903 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
18904 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
18905 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
18906 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
18907 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
18908 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
18909 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
18910
18911 @kindex k c
18912 @pindex calc-choose
18913 @tindex choose
18914 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
18915 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
18916 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
18917 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
18918 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
18919 real numbers by
18920 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
18921 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
18922
18923 @kindex H k c
18924 @pindex calc-perm
18925 @tindex perm
18926 @ifnottex
18927 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
18928 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
18929 @end ifnottex
18930 @tex
18931 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
18932 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
18933 @end tex
18934
18935 @kindex k b
18936 @kindex H k b
18937 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
18938 @tindex bern
18939 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
18940 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
18941 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
18942 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
18943 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
18944 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
18945 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
18946
18947 @kindex k e
18948 @kindex H k e
18949 @pindex calc-euler-number
18950 @tindex euler
18951 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
18952 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
18953 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
18954 functions.
18955
18956 @kindex k s
18957 @kindex H k s
18958 @pindex calc-stirling-number
18959 @tindex stir1
18960 @tindex stir2
18961 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
18962 computes a Stirling number of the first
18963 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
18964 @infoline kind,
18965 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
18966 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
18967 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
18968 @infoline kind.
18969 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
18970 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
18971 non-empty sets, respectively.
18972
18973 @kindex k p
18974 @pindex calc-prime-test
18975 @cindex Primes
18976 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
18977 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
18978 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
18979 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
18980 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
18981 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
18982 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
18983 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
18984 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
18985 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
18986 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
18987 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
18988 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
18989
18990 @ignore
18991 @starindex
18992 @end ignore
18993 @tindex prime
18994 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
18995 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
18996 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
18997 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
18998 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
18999 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19000
19001 @kindex k f
19002 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19003 @tindex prfac
19004 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19005 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19006 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19007 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19008 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19009 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19010 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19011 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19012 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19013
19014 @kindex k n
19015 @pindex calc-next-prime
19016 @ignore
19017 @mindex nextpr@idots
19018 @end ignore
19019 @tindex nextprime
19020 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19021 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19022 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19023 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19024 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19025 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19026 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19027 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19028 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19029 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19030 prime.
19031
19032 @kindex I k n
19033 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19034 @ignore
19035 @mindex prevpr@idots
19036 @end ignore
19037 @tindex prevprime
19038 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19039 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19040
19041 @kindex k t
19042 @pindex calc-totient
19043 @tindex totient
19044 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19045 Euler ``totient''
19046 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19047 @infoline function,
19048 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19049 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19050
19051 @kindex k m
19052 @pindex calc-moebius
19053 @tindex moebius
19054 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19055 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19056 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19057 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19058 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19059 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19060 the result is zero.
19061
19062 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19063 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19064
19065 @noindent
19066 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19067 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19068 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19069 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19070 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19071 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19072 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19073 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19074
19075 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19076 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19077 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19078 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19079 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19080 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19081
19082 @kindex k B
19083 @kindex I k B
19084 @pindex calc-utpb
19085 @tindex utpb
19086 @tindex ltpb
19087 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19088 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19089 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19090 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19091 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19092 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19093 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19094
19095 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19096 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19097 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19098 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19099 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19100 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19101 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19102 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19103 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19104 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19105 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19106
19107 @kindex k C
19108 @pindex calc-utpc
19109 @tindex utpc
19110 @ignore
19111 @mindex @idots
19112 @end ignore
19113 @kindex I k C
19114 @ignore
19115 @mindex @null
19116 @end ignore
19117 @tindex ltpc
19118 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19119 @texline @math{\nu}
19120 @infoline @expr{v}
19121 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19122 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19123
19124 @kindex k F
19125 @pindex calc-utpf
19126 @tindex utpf
19127 @ignore
19128 @mindex @idots
19129 @end ignore
19130 @kindex I k F
19131 @ignore
19132 @mindex @null
19133 @end ignore
19134 @tindex ltpf
19135 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19136 various statistical tests. The parameters
19137 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19138 @infoline @expr{v1}
19139 and
19140 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19141 @infoline @expr{v2}
19142 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19143 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19144
19145 @kindex k N
19146 @pindex calc-utpn
19147 @tindex utpn
19148 @ignore
19149 @mindex @idots
19150 @end ignore
19151 @kindex I k N
19152 @ignore
19153 @mindex @null
19154 @end ignore
19155 @tindex ltpn
19156 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19157 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19158 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19159 @infoline @expr{s}.
19160 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19161 would exceed @expr{x}.
19162
19163 @kindex k P
19164 @pindex calc-utpp
19165 @tindex utpp
19166 @ignore
19167 @mindex @idots
19168 @end ignore
19169 @kindex I k P
19170 @ignore
19171 @mindex @null
19172 @end ignore
19173 @tindex ltpp
19174 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19175 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19176 Poisson random events will occur.
19177
19178 @kindex k T
19179 @pindex calc-ltpt
19180 @tindex utpt
19181 @ignore
19182 @mindex @idots
19183 @end ignore
19184 @kindex I k T
19185 @ignore
19186 @mindex @null
19187 @end ignore
19188 @tindex ltpt
19189 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19190 with
19191 @texline @math{\nu}
19192 @infoline @expr{v}
19193 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19194 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19195 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19196 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19197 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19198 where
19199 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19200 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19201 and
19202 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19203 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19204 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19205 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19206
19207 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19208 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19209 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19210 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19211 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19212
19213 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19214 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19215
19216 @noindent
19217 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19218 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19219 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19220 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19221 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19222
19223 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19224 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19225 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19226 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19227 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19228
19229 @menu
19230 * Packing and Unpacking::
19231 * Building Vectors::
19232 * Extracting Elements::
19233 * Manipulating Vectors::
19234 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19235 * Set Operations::
19236 * Statistical Operations::
19237 * Reducing and Mapping::
19238 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19239 @end menu
19240
19241 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19242 @section Packing and Unpacking
19243
19244 @noindent
19245 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19246 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19247 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19248 vectors.
19249
19250 @kindex v p
19251 @pindex calc-pack
19252 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19253 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19254 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19255 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19256 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19257 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19258 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19259 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19260
19261 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19262 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19263 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19264 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19265
19266 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19267
19268 @table @cite
19269 @item -1
19270 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19271 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19272 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19273 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19274 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19275 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19276 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19277 components are not suitable.)
19278
19279 @item -2
19280 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19281 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19282 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19283 mode.
19284
19285 @item -3
19286 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19287 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19288 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19289 number.
19290
19291 @item -4
19292 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19293 may be real numbers or formulas.
19294
19295 @item -5
19296 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19297 must be real numbers.
19298
19299 @item -6
19300 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19301 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19302
19303 @item -7
19304 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19305
19306 @item -8
19307 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19308
19309 @item -9
19310 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19311
19312 @item -10
19313 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19314
19315 @item -11
19316 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19317 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19318 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19319 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19320
19321 @item -12
19322 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19323 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19324 is desired.
19325
19326 @item -13
19327 A real number is converted into a date form.
19328
19329 @item -14
19330 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19331
19332 @item -15
19333 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19334 @end table
19335
19336 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19337 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19338 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19339 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19340 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19341 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19342 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19343 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19344 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19345 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19346
19347 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19348 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19349 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19350 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19351 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19352
19353 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19354 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19355 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19356 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19357 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19358
19359 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19360 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19361 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19362 @texline @math{2\times3}
19363 @infoline 2x3
19364 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19365 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19366 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19367
19368 @ignore
19369 @starindex
19370 @end ignore
19371 @tindex pack
19372 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19373 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19374 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19375 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19376 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19377 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19378 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19379 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19380 by the mode.
19381
19382 @kindex v u
19383 @pindex calc-unpack
19384 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19385 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19386 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19387 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19388 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19389 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19390
19391 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19392 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19393 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19394 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19395 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19396 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19397 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19398
19399 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19400 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19401 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19402 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19403 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19404 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19405 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19406 is not a composite object.
19407
19408 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19409 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19410 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19411 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19412 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19413 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19414 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19415 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19416
19417 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19418 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19419 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19420 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19421 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19422 original object.
19423
19424 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19425 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19426 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19427 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19428
19429 @ignore
19430 @starindex
19431 @end ignore
19432 @tindex unpack
19433 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19434 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19435 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19436 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19437 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19438 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19439
19440 @ignore
19441 @starindex
19442 @end ignore
19443 @tindex unpackt
19444 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19445 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19446 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19447 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19448 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19449 The identity for re-building the original object is
19450 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19451 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19452 name and a vector of arguments.)
19453
19454 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19455 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19456 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19457 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19458
19459 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19460 @section Building Vectors
19461
19462 @noindent
19463 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19464 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19465
19466 @kindex |
19467 @pindex calc-concat
19468 @ignore
19469 @mindex @null
19470 @end ignore
19471 @tindex |
19472 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19473 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19474 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19475 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19476 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19477 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19478
19479 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19480 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19481 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19482 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19483 one-row matrix.
19484
19485 @kindex H |
19486 @tindex append
19487 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19488 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19489 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19490 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19491 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19492
19493 @kindex I |
19494 @kindex H I |
19495 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19496 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19497 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19498
19499 @kindex v d
19500 @pindex calc-diag
19501 @tindex diag
19502 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19503 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19504 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19505 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19506 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19507 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19508 the prefix argument is required.
19509
19510 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19511 @texline @math{3\times3}
19512 @infoline 3x3
19513 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19514 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19515 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19516
19517 @kindex v i
19518 @pindex calc-ident
19519 @tindex idn
19520 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19521 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19522 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19523 this command prompts for one.
19524
19525 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19526 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19527 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19528 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19529 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19530 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19531 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19532 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19533 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19534 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19535 dimensions.
19536
19537 @kindex v x
19538 @pindex calc-index
19539 @tindex index
19540 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19541 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19542 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19543 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19544 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19545
19546 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19547 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19548 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19549 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19550 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19551 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19552 of numbers or formulas.
19553
19554 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19555 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19556 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19557 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19558 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19559 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19560
19561 @kindex v b
19562 @pindex calc-build-vector
19563 @tindex cvec
19564 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19565 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19566 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19567 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19568 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19569 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19570
19571 @kindex v h
19572 @kindex I v h
19573 @pindex calc-head
19574 @pindex calc-tail
19575 @tindex head
19576 @tindex tail
19577 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19578 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19579 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19580 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19581
19582 @kindex v k
19583 @pindex calc-cons
19584 @tindex cons
19585 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19586 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19587 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19588 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19589 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19590
19591 @kindex H v h
19592 @tindex rhead
19593 @ignore
19594 @mindex @idots
19595 @end ignore
19596 @kindex H I v h
19597 @ignore
19598 @mindex @null
19599 @end ignore
19600 @kindex H v k
19601 @ignore
19602 @mindex @null
19603 @end ignore
19604 @tindex rtail
19605 @ignore
19606 @mindex @null
19607 @end ignore
19608 @tindex rcons
19609 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19610 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19611 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19612 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19613 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19614 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19615 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19616
19617 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19618 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19619
19620 @noindent
19621 @kindex v r
19622 @pindex calc-mrow
19623 @tindex mrow
19624 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19625 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19626 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19627 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19628 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19629 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19630
19631 @cindex Permutations, applying
19632 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19633 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19634 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19635 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19636 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19637 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19638
19639 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19640 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19641 submatrix is returned.
19642
19643 @cindex Subscript notation
19644 @kindex a _
19645 @pindex calc-subscript
19646 @tindex subscr
19647 @tindex _
19648 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19649 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19650 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19651 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19652 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19653 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19654 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19655 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19656 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19657 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19658
19659 @tindex mrrow
19660 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19661 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19662 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19663 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19664 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19665
19666 @tindex getdiag
19667 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19668 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19669 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19670
19671 @kindex v c
19672 @pindex calc-mcol
19673 @tindex mcol
19674 @tindex mrcol
19675 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19676 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19677 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19678 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19679 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19680 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19681
19682 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19683 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19684 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19685 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19686 of matrix @expr{m}.
19687
19688 @kindex v s
19689 @pindex calc-subvector
19690 @tindex subvec
19691 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19692 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19693 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19694 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19695 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19696 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19697 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19698 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19699
19700 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19701 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19702 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19703 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19704 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19705 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19706 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19707
19708 @kindex I v s
19709 @tindex rsubvec
19710 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19711 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19712 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19713 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19714 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19715
19716 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19717 vectors one element at a time.
19718
19719 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
19720 @section Manipulating Vectors
19721
19722 @noindent
19723 @kindex v l
19724 @pindex calc-vlength
19725 @tindex vlen
19726 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
19727 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
19728 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
19729 command.
19730
19731 @kindex H v l
19732 @tindex mdims
19733 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
19734 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
19735 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
19736 its argument is a
19737 @texline @math{2\times3}
19738 @infoline 2x3
19739 matrix.
19740
19741 @kindex v f
19742 @pindex calc-vector-find
19743 @tindex find
19744 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
19745 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
19746 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
19747 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
19748 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
19749 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
19750
19751 @kindex v a
19752 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
19753 @tindex arrange
19754 @cindex Arranging a matrix
19755 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
19756 @cindex Flattening a matrix
19757 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
19758 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
19759 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
19760 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
19761 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
19762 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
19763 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
19764 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
19765 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
19766 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
19767 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
19768 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
19769 @texline @math{1\times4}
19770 @infoline 1x4
19771 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
19772 @texline @math{4\times1}
19773 @infoline 4x1
19774 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
19775 @texline @math{2\times2}
19776 @infoline 2x2
19777 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
19778 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
19779 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
19780
19781 @cindex Sorting data
19782 @kindex V S
19783 @kindex I V S
19784 @pindex calc-sort
19785 @tindex sort
19786 @tindex rsort
19787 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
19788 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
19789 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
19790 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
19791 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
19792 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
19793 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
19794 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
19795 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
19796 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
19797 alphabetical order by this command.
19798
19799 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
19800
19801 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
19802 @cindex Inverse of permutation
19803 @cindex Index tables
19804 @cindex Rank tables
19805 @kindex V G
19806 @kindex I V G
19807 @pindex calc-grade
19808 @tindex grade
19809 @tindex rgrade
19810 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
19811 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
19812 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
19813 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
19814 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
19815 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
19816 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
19817 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
19818 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
19819 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
19820 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
19821 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
19822 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
19823
19824 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
19825 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
19826 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
19827 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
19828 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
19829 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
19830 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
19831 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
19832 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
19833 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
19834 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
19835
19836 @cindex Histograms
19837 @kindex V H
19838 @pindex calc-histogram
19839 @ignore
19840 @mindex histo@idots
19841 @end ignore
19842 @tindex histogram
19843 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
19844 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
19845 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
19846 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
19847 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
19848 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
19849 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
19850 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
19851 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
19852 input vector.)
19853
19854 @kindex H V H
19855 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
19856 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
19857 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
19858 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
19859 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
19860 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
19861
19862 @kindex v t
19863 @pindex calc-transpose
19864 @tindex trn
19865 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
19866 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
19867 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
19868 a one-column matrix.
19869
19870 @kindex v v
19871 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
19872 @tindex rev
19873 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
19874 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
19875 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
19876 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
19877 a matrix.)
19878
19879 @kindex v m
19880 @pindex calc-mask-vector
19881 @tindex vmask
19882 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
19883 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
19884 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
19885 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
19886 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
19887 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
19888 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
19889 @xref{Logical Operations}.
19890
19891 @kindex v e
19892 @pindex calc-expand-vector
19893 @tindex vexp
19894 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
19895 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
19896 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
19897 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
19898 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
19899 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
19900 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
19901 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
19902 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
19903
19904 @kindex H v e
19905 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
19906 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
19907 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
19908 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
19909 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
19910 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
19911 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
19912 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
19913 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
19914
19915 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
19916 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
19917 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
19918 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
19919 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
19920 masking using vectors.
19921
19922 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
19923 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
19924
19925 @noindent
19926 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
19927 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
19928 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
19929 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
19930 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19931
19932 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
19933 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
19934 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
19935 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
19936
19937 @kindex V J
19938 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
19939 @tindex ctrn
19940 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
19941 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
19942
19943 @ignore
19944 @mindex A
19945 @end ignore
19946 @kindex A (vectors)
19947 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
19948 @ignore
19949 @mindex abs
19950 @end ignore
19951 @tindex abs (vectors)
19952 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
19953 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
19954 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
19955 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
19956 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
19957 from that point to the origin.
19958
19959 @kindex v n
19960 @pindex calc-rnorm
19961 @tindex rnorm
19962 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes
19963 the row norm, or infinity-norm, of a vector or matrix. For a plain
19964 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements.
19965 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums,
19966 i.e., of the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the
19967 various rows.
19968
19969 @kindex V N
19970 @pindex calc-cnorm
19971 @tindex cnorm
19972 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
19973 the column norm, or one-norm, of a vector or matrix. For a plain
19974 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
19975 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
19976 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
19977 not provided.
19978
19979 @kindex V C
19980 @pindex calc-cross
19981 @tindex cross
19982 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
19983 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
19984 exactly three elements.
19985
19986 @ignore
19987 @mindex &
19988 @end ignore
19989 @kindex & (matrices)
19990 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
19991 @ignore
19992 @mindex inv
19993 @end ignore
19994 @tindex inv (matrices)
19995 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
19996 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
19997 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
19998 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
19999 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20000 quickly in the future.
20001
20002 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20003 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20004 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20005 by a matrix.
20006
20007 @kindex V D
20008 @pindex calc-mdet
20009 @tindex det
20010 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20011 determinant of a square matrix.
20012
20013 @kindex V L
20014 @pindex calc-mlud
20015 @tindex lud
20016 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20017 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20018 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20019 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20020 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20021 and the third is upper-triangular.
20022
20023 @kindex V T
20024 @pindex calc-mtrace
20025 @tindex tr
20026 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20027 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20028 elements of the matrix.
20029
20030 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20031 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20032
20033 @noindent
20034 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20035 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20036 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20037 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20038 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20039 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20040 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20041 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20042 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20043 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20044 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20045 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20046 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20047
20048 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20049 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20050 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20051 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20052 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20053 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20054
20055 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20056 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20057 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20058 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20059
20060 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20061 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20062 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20063
20064 @kindex V +
20065 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20066 @tindex rdup
20067 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20068 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20069 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20070 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20071 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20072 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20073 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20074 them.
20075
20076 @kindex V V
20077 @pindex calc-set-union
20078 @tindex vunion
20079 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20080 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20081 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20082 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20083 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20084
20085 @kindex V ^
20086 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20087 @tindex vint
20088 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20089 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20090 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20091 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20092 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20093 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20094 notation for set
20095 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20096 @infoline union
20097 and
20098 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20099 @infoline intersection.
20100
20101 @kindex V -
20102 @pindex calc-set-difference
20103 @tindex vdiff
20104 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20105 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20106 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20107 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20108 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20109 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20110 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20111 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20112 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20113 enough to express in a few intervals).
20114
20115 @kindex V X
20116 @pindex calc-set-xor
20117 @tindex vxor
20118 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20119 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20120 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20121 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20122 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20123
20124 @kindex V ~
20125 @pindex calc-set-complement
20126 @tindex vcompl
20127 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20128 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20129 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20130 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20131 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20132
20133 @kindex V F
20134 @pindex calc-set-floor
20135 @tindex vfloor
20136 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20137 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20138 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20139 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20140 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20141 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20142 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20143 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20144
20145 @kindex V E
20146 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20147 @tindex venum
20148 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20149 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20150 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20151 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20152 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20153
20154 @kindex V :
20155 @pindex calc-set-span
20156 @tindex vspan
20157 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20158 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20159 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20160 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20161 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20162
20163 @kindex V #
20164 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20165 @tindex vcard
20166 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20167 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20168 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20169 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20170
20171 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20172 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20173 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20174 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20175 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20176 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20177 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20178 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20179 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20180 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20181 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20182 convenient to you.
20183
20184 @kindex b p
20185 @kindex b u
20186 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20187 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20188 @tindex vpack
20189 @tindex vunpack
20190 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20191 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20192 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20193 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20194 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20195 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20196 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20197 (binary) prefix key.
20198
20199 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20200 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20201 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20202 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20203 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20204 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20205 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20206 representation
20207 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20208 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20209
20210 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20211 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20212
20213 @noindent
20214 @cindex Statistical functions
20215 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20216 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20217 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20218 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20219 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20220 Vetterling.
20221
20222 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20223 a shifted letter or other character.
20224
20225 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20226 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20227
20228 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20229 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20230
20231 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20232 probability distribution functions.
20233
20234 @menu
20235 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20236 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20237 @end menu
20238
20239 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20240 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20241
20242 @noindent
20243 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20244 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20245 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20246 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20247 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20248 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20249 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20250
20251 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20252 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20253 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20254 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20255
20256 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20257 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20258 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20259 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20260 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20261 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20262 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20263
20264 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20265 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20266 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20267 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20268 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20269 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20270 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20271 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20272 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20273 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20274
20275 @kindex u #
20276 @pindex calc-vector-count
20277 @tindex vcount
20278 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20279 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20280 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20281 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20282 simply computes the length of the vector.
20283
20284 @kindex u +
20285 @kindex u *
20286 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20287 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20288 @tindex vsum
20289 @tindex vprod
20290 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20291 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20292 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20293 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20294 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20295 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20296 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20297
20298 @kindex u X
20299 @kindex u N
20300 @pindex calc-vector-max
20301 @pindex calc-vector-min
20302 @tindex vmax
20303 @tindex vmin
20304 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20305 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20306 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20307 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20308 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20309 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20310 plus or minus infinity.
20311
20312 @kindex u M
20313 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20314 @tindex vmean
20315 @cindex Mean of data values
20316 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20317 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20318 If the inputs are error forms
20319 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20320 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20321 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20322 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20323 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20324 @tex
20325 \turnoffactive
20326 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20327 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20328 @end tex
20329 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20330 values divided by the count of the values.
20331
20332 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20333 error
20334 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20335 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20336 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20337 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20338 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20339 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20340 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20341 weight is completely negligible.)
20342
20343 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20344 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20345 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20346 and maximum values of the interval.
20347
20348 @kindex I u M
20349 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20350 @tindex vmeane
20351 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20352 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20353 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20354 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20355 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20356 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20357 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20358 @tex
20359 \turnoffactive
20360 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20361 @end tex
20362 If the inputs are plain
20363 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20364 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20365 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20366 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20367 deviation.)
20368 @tex
20369 \turnoffactive
20370 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20371 @end tex
20372
20373 @kindex H u M
20374 @pindex calc-vector-median
20375 @tindex vmedian
20376 @cindex Median of data values
20377 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20378 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20379 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20380 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20381 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20382 The median function is different from the other functions in
20383 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20384 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20385 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20386 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20387 ignored.
20388
20389 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20390 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20391 the same as the mean.
20392
20393 @kindex H I u M
20394 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20395 @tindex vhmean
20396 @cindex Harmonic mean
20397 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20398 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20399 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20400 of the values.
20401 @tex
20402 \turnoffactive
20403 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20404 @end tex
20405
20406 @kindex u G
20407 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20408 @tindex vgmean
20409 @cindex Geometric mean
20410 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20411 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20412 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20413 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20414 of the data values.
20415 @tex
20416 \turnoffactive
20417 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20418 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20419 @end tex
20420
20421 @kindex H u G
20422 @tindex agmean
20423 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20424 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20425 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20426 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20427 @tex
20428 \turnoffactive
20429 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20430 @end tex
20431
20432 @cindex Root-mean-square
20433 Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20434 for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20435
20436 @kindex u S
20437 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20438 @tindex vsdev
20439 @cindex Standard deviation
20440 @cindex Sample statistics
20441 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20442 computes the standard
20443 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20444 @infoline deviation
20445 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20446 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20447 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20448 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20449 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20450 @tex
20451 \turnoffactive
20452 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20453 @end tex
20454
20455 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20456 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20457 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20458 limits, divided by
20459 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20460 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20461 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20462 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20463
20464 @kindex I u S
20465 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20466 @tindex vpsdev
20467 @cindex Population statistics
20468 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20469 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20470 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20471 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20472 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20473 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20474 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20475 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20476 only an estimate of the true mean.
20477 @tex
20478 \turnoffactive
20479 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20480 @end tex
20481
20482 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20483 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20484 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20485
20486 @kindex H u S
20487 @kindex H I u S
20488 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20489 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20490 @tindex vvar
20491 @tindex vpvar
20492 @cindex Variance of data values
20493 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20494 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20495 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20496 is the
20497 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20498 @infoline square
20499 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20500 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20501 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20502
20503 @ignore
20504 @starindex
20505 @end ignore
20506 @tindex vflat
20507 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20508 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20509 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20510 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20511
20512 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20513 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20514
20515 @noindent
20516 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20517 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20518 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20519 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20520 the stack, which must be an
20521 @texline @math{N\times2}
20522 @infoline Nx2
20523 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20524 of actual vectors and matrices.
20525
20526 @kindex u C
20527 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20528 @tindex vcov
20529 @cindex Covariance
20530 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20531 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20532 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20533 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20534 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20535 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20536 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20537 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20538 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20539 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20540 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20541 input errors.
20542 @tex
20543 \turnoffactive
20544 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20545 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20546 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20547 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20548 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20549 $$
20550 @end tex
20551
20552 @kindex I u C
20553 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20554 @tindex vpcov
20555 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20556 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20557 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20558 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20559
20560 @kindex H u C
20561 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20562 @tindex vcorr
20563 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20564 @cindex Linear correlation
20565 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20566 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20567 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20568 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20569 between sample or population statistics here.)
20570 @tex
20571 \turnoffactive
20572 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20573 @end tex
20574
20575 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20576 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20577
20578 @noindent
20579 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20580 elements of vectors.
20581
20582 @kindex V A
20583 @pindex calc-apply
20584 @tindex apply
20585 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20586 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20587 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20588 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20589 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20590 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20591 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20592
20593 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20594 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20595
20596 @menu
20597 * Specifying Operators::
20598 * Mapping::
20599 * Reducing::
20600 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20601 * Generalized Products::
20602 @end menu
20603
20604 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20605 @subsection Specifying Operators
20606
20607 @noindent
20608 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20609 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20610 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20611 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20612 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20613 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20614 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20615 element as its argument.)
20616
20617 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20618 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20619 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20620 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20621 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20622 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20623 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20624 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20625 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20626 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20627 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20628 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20629 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20630 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20631 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20632
20633 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20634 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20635 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20636 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20637 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20638 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20639 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20640 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20641 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20642 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20643
20644 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20645 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20646 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20647 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20648 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20649 entry interacts with the stack.)
20650
20651 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20652 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20653 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20654 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20655 prompted for an argument list.
20656
20657 @cindex Nameless functions
20658 @cindex Generic functions
20659 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20660 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20661 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20662 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20663 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20664 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20665 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20666 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20667 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20668 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20669 can get it back later if you wish.
20670
20671 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20672 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20673 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20674 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
20675 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
20676
20677 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
20678 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
20679 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
20680 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
20681 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
20682 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
20683 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
20684
20685 @cindex Lambda expressions
20686 @ignore
20687 @starindex
20688 @end ignore
20689 @tindex lambda
20690 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
20691 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
20692 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
20693 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
20694 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
20695 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
20696 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
20697
20698 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
20699 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
20700 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
20701 called.)
20702
20703 @tindex add
20704 @tindex sub
20705 @ignore
20706 @mindex @idots
20707 @end ignore
20708 @tindex mul
20709 @ignore
20710 @mindex @null
20711 @end ignore
20712 @tindex div
20713 @ignore
20714 @mindex @null
20715 @end ignore
20716 @tindex pow
20717 @ignore
20718 @mindex @null
20719 @end ignore
20720 @tindex neg
20721 @ignore
20722 @mindex @null
20723 @end ignore
20724 @tindex mod
20725 @ignore
20726 @mindex @null
20727 @end ignore
20728 @tindex vconcat
20729 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
20730 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
20731 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
20732 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
20733 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
20734 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
20735 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
20736 @code{vconcat}.
20737
20738 @ignore
20739 @starindex
20740 @end ignore
20741 @tindex call
20742 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
20743 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
20744 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
20745 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
20746 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
20747 as @samp{x + 2y}).
20748
20749 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
20750 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
20751 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
20752 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
20753 about it.)
20754
20755 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
20756 @subsection Mapping
20757
20758 @noindent
20759 @kindex V M
20760 @pindex calc-map
20761 @tindex map
20762 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
20763 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
20764 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
20765 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
20766 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
20767 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
20768 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
20769 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
20770 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
20771 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
20772 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
20773 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
20774
20775 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
20776 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
20777 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
20778 produce another
20779 @texline @math{3\times2}
20780 @infoline 3x2
20781 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
20782
20783 @tindex mapr
20784 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
20785 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
20786 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
20787 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
20788 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
20789 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
20790 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
20791 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
20792 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
20793
20794 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
20795 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
20796 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
20797 their individual elements.
20798
20799 @tindex mapc
20800 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
20801 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
20802 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
20803 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
20804 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
20805 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
20806
20807 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
20808 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
20809 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
20810 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
20811
20812 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
20813 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
20814 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
20815 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
20816 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
20817 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
20818
20819 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
20820 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
20821 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
20822 column.
20823
20824 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
20825 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
20826 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
20827 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
20828 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
20829 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
20830 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
20831 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
20832 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
20833 mapped over the elements of each row.)
20834
20835 @tindex mapa
20836 @tindex mapd
20837 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
20838 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
20839 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
20840 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
20841 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
20842 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
20843 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
20844 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
20845
20846 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
20847 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
20848 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
20849 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
20850
20851 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20852 @subsection Reducing
20853
20854 @noindent
20855 @kindex V R
20856 @pindex calc-reduce
20857 @tindex reduce
20858 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
20859 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
20860 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
20861 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
20862 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
20863 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
20864 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
20865 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
20866
20867 @kindex I V R
20868 @tindex rreduce
20869 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
20870 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
20871 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
20872 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
20873 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
20874 in power series expansions.
20875
20876 @kindex V U
20877 @tindex accum
20878 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
20879 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
20880 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
20881 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
20882 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
20883 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
20884
20885 @kindex I V U
20886 @tindex raccum
20887 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
20888 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
20889 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
20890
20891 @tindex reducea
20892 @tindex rreducea
20893 @tindex reduced
20894 @tindex rreduced
20895 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
20896 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
20897 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
20898 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
20899 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
20900 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
20901 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
20902 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
20903 b + e, c + f]}.
20904
20905 @tindex reducer
20906 @tindex rreducer
20907 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
20908 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
20909 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
20910 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
20911 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
20912 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
20913 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
20914
20915 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
20916 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
20917
20918 @tindex reducec
20919 @tindex rreducec
20920 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
20921 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
20922
20923 The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
20924 @kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
20925 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
20926 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
20927
20928 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
20929 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
20930
20931 @noindent
20932 @kindex H V R
20933 @tindex nest
20934 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
20935 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
20936 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
20937 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
20938 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
20939 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
20940 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
20941
20942 @kindex H V U
20943 @tindex anest
20944 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
20945 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
20946 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
20947 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
20948 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
20949
20950 @kindex H I V R
20951 @tindex fixp
20952 @cindex Fixed points
20953 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
20954 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
20955 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
20956 no longer changes.
20957
20958 @kindex H I V U
20959 @tindex afixp
20960 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
20961 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
20962 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
20963 by @code{fixp}.
20964
20965 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
20966 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
20967 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
20968 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
20969 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
20970 to converge to 0.739085.)
20971
20972 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
20973 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
20974 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
20975 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
20976 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
20977 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
20978 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
20979
20980 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
20981 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
20982 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
20983 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
20984 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
20985 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
20986 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
20987 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
20988
20989 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
20990 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
20991 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
20992 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
20993 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
20994 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
20995 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
20996 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
20997 exactly equal.)
20998
20999 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21000 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21001 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21002 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21003
21004 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21005 @subsection Generalized Products
21006
21007 @kindex V O
21008 @pindex calc-outer-product
21009 @tindex outer
21010 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21011 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21012 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21013 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21014 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21015 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21016 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21017
21018 @kindex V I
21019 @pindex calc-inner-product
21020 @tindex inner
21021 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21022 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21023 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21024 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21025 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21026 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21027 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21028 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21029 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21030 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21031 generalized dot product.
21032
21033 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21034 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21035 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21036 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21037 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21038
21039 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21040 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21041
21042 @noindent
21043 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21044 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21045 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21046 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21047 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21048 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21049
21050 @kindex V <
21051 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21052 @kindex V =
21053 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21054 @kindex V >
21055 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21056 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21057 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21058 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21059 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21060
21061 @kindex V [
21062 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21063 @kindex V @{
21064 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21065 @kindex V (
21066 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21067 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21068 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21069 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21070 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21071 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21072 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21073 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21074 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21075 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21076 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21077
21078 @kindex V ]
21079 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21080 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21081 ``big'' style display of matrices. It prompts for a string of code
21082 letters; currently implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables
21083 brackets on each row of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer
21084 brackets in opposite corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which
21085 enables commas or semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last.
21086 The default format is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format
21087 was fixed at @samp{ROC}.) Here are some example matrices:
21088
21089 @example
21090 @group
21091 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21092 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21093 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21094
21095 RO ROC
21096
21097 @end group
21098 @end example
21099 @noindent
21100 @example
21101 @group
21102 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21103 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21104 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21105
21106 O OC
21107
21108 @end group
21109 @end example
21110 @noindent
21111 @example
21112 @group
21113 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21114 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21115 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21116
21117 R @r{blank}
21118 @end group
21119 @end example
21120
21121 @noindent
21122 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21123 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21124 the others are useful for display only.
21125
21126 @kindex V ,
21127 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21128 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21129 off in vector and matrix display.
21130
21131 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21132 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21133 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21134 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21135 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21136 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21137 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21138 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21139 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21140
21141 @kindex V .
21142 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21143 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21144 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21145 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21146 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21147 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21148 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21149 improve Calc's display speed.
21150
21151 @kindex t .
21152 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21153 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21154 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21155 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21156 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21157 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21158 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21159 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21160 that involve the trail.
21161
21162 @kindex V /
21163 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21164 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21165 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21166 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21167 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21168 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21169 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21170
21171 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21172 @chapter Algebra
21173
21174 @noindent
21175 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21176 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21177 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21178 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21179 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21180 is discussed.
21181
21182 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21183 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21184 for anything else'') prefix.
21185
21186 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21187 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21188
21189 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21190 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21191 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21192 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21193 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21194 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21195 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21196
21197 @menu
21198 * Selecting Subformulas::
21199 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21200 * Simplifying Formulas::
21201 * Polynomials::
21202 * Calculus::
21203 * Solving Equations::
21204 * Numerical Solutions::
21205 * Curve Fitting::
21206 * Summations::
21207 * Logical Operations::
21208 * Rewrite Rules::
21209 @end menu
21210
21211 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21212 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21213
21214 @noindent
21215 @cindex Selections
21216 @cindex Sub-formulas
21217 @cindex Parts of formulas
21218 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21219 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21220 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21221 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21222 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21223 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21224
21225 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21226 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21227 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21228
21229 @menu
21230 * Making Selections::
21231 * Changing Selections::
21232 * Displaying Selections::
21233 * Operating on Selections::
21234 * Rearranging with Selections::
21235 @end menu
21236
21237 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21238 @subsection Making Selections
21239
21240 @noindent
21241 @kindex j s
21242 @pindex calc-select-here
21243 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21244 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21245 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21246 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21247 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21248 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21249 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21250
21251 @smallexample
21252 @group
21253 3 ___
21254 (a + b) + V c
21255 1: ---------------
21256 2 x + 1
21257 @end group
21258 @end smallexample
21259
21260 @noindent
21261 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21262 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21263 to
21264
21265 @smallexample
21266 @group
21267 . ...
21268 .. . b. . . .
21269 1* ...............
21270 . . . .
21271 @end group
21272 @end smallexample
21273
21274 @noindent
21275 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21276 to a dot. The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21277 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21278 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21279 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21280 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21281
21282 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21283 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21284
21285 @smallexample
21286 @group
21287 . ...
21288 (a + b) . . .
21289 1* ...............
21290 . . . .
21291 @end group
21292 @end smallexample
21293
21294 @noindent
21295 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21296 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21297 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21298 would have had the same effect.
21299
21300 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21301 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21302 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21303 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21304
21305 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21306 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21307 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21308 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21309 and so on.
21310
21311 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21312 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21313
21314 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21315 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21316 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21317 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21318 cursor on any stack entry.
21319
21320 @kindex j a
21321 @pindex calc-select-additional
21322 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21323 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21324 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21325 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21326 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21327 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21328
21329 @kindex j o
21330 @pindex calc-select-once
21331 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21332 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21333 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21334 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21335 by the cursor.
21336
21337 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21338 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21339 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21340 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21341
21342 @kindex j S
21343 @kindex j O
21344 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21345 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21346 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21347 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21348 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21349 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21350 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21351 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21352 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21353 commands.
21354
21355 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21356 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21357 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21358 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21359 entire four-term sum.
21360
21361 @kindex j b
21362 @pindex calc-break-selections
21363 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21364 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21365 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}
21366 and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain obscure reasons, Calc
21367 treats multiplication as right-associative.) Once you have enabled
21368 @kbd{j b} mode, selecting with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would
21369 only select the @samp{a + b - c} portion, which makes sense when the
21370 deep structure of the sum is considered. There is no way to select
21371 the @samp{b - c + d} portion; although this might initially look
21372 like just as legitimate a sub-formula as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep
21373 structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d U} command can be used
21374 to view the deep structure of any formula (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21375
21376 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21377 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21378 you get.
21379
21380 @kindex j u
21381 @pindex calc-unselect
21382 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21383 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21384 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21385 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21386 position.
21387
21388 @kindex j c
21389 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21390 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21391 stack elements.
21392
21393 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21394 @subsection Changing Selections
21395
21396 @noindent
21397 @kindex j m
21398 @pindex calc-select-more
21399 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21400 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21401 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21402
21403 @smallexample
21404 @group
21405 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21406 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21407 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21408 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21409 @end group
21410 @end smallexample
21411
21412 @noindent
21413 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21414 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21415 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21416
21417 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21418 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21419 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21420 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21421 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21422
21423 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21424 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21425 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21426 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21427
21428 @kindex j l
21429 @pindex calc-select-less
21430 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21431 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21432 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21433 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21434 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21435
21436 @kindex j 1-9
21437 @pindex calc-select-part
21438 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21439 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21440 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21441 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21442 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21443 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21444 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21445 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21446
21447 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21448 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21449 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21450 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21451 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21452
21453 @kindex j n
21454 @kindex j p
21455 @pindex calc-select-next
21456 @pindex calc-select-previous
21457 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21458 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21459 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21460 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21461 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21462 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21463 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21464 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21465 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21466 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21467
21468 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21469 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21470 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21471
21472 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21473 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21474 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21475 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21476 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21477 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21478 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21479 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21480 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21481
21482 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21483 @subsection Displaying Selections
21484
21485 @noindent
21486 @kindex j d
21487 @pindex calc-show-selections
21488 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21489 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21490 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21491 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21492 by @samp{#} signs:
21493
21494 @smallexample
21495 @group
21496 3 ... # ___
21497 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21498 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21499 . . . . 2 x + 1
21500 @end group
21501 @end smallexample
21502
21503 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21504 @subsection Operating on Selections
21505
21506 @noindent
21507 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21508 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21509 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21510 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21511 given stack element.)
21512
21513 @kindex j e
21514 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21515 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21516 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21517 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21518 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21519 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21520 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21521
21522 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21523 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21524 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21525 element.
21526
21527 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21528 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21529 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21530 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21531 portion to the top of the stack.
21532
21533 @smallexample
21534 @group
21535 3 ... ... ___
21536 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21537 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21538 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21539
21540 3 3
21541 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21542 @end group
21543 @end smallexample
21544
21545 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21546 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21547 the complete, edited formula.
21548
21549 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21550 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21551
21552 @kindex j '
21553 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21554 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21555 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21556 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21557 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21558 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21559 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21560 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21561 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21562 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21563
21564 @kindex j `
21565 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21566 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21567 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21568 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21569 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21570
21571 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21572 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21573 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21574 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21575
21576 @smallexample
21577 @group
21578 ###
21579 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21580 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21581 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21582 @end group
21583 @end smallexample
21584
21585 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21586 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21587 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21588 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21589 and resimplifies.
21590
21591 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21592 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21593 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21594
21595 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21596 @pindex calc-del-selection
21597 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21598 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21599 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21600 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21601 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21602
21603 @kindex j @key{RET}
21604 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21605 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21606 command.)
21607
21608 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21609 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21610 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21611 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21612
21613 @smallexample
21614 @group
21615 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21616 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21617 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21618 V 4 - 2 x
21619 @end group
21620 @end smallexample
21621
21622 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21623 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21624 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21625 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21626 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21627 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21628 the command will abort with an error message.
21629
21630 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21631 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21632 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21633 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
21634
21635 @smallexample
21636 @group
21637 .. . .. .
21638 1* .......... 1* ...........
21639 ......... ..........
21640 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
21641 @end group
21642 @end smallexample
21643
21644 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
21645 normally have cancelled out with the subtraction automatically, has
21646 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
21647 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
21648 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
21649 to be simplified.
21650
21651 @smallexample
21652 @group
21653 17 y 17 y
21654 1: ----------- 1: ----------
21655 __________ _________
21656 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
21657 @end group
21658 @end smallexample
21659
21660 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21661 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
21662
21663 @noindent
21664 @kindex j R
21665 @pindex calc-commute-right
21666 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
21667 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
21668 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
21669 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
21670
21671 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
21672 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
21673 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
21674 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
21675
21676 @smallexample
21677 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
21678 @end smallexample
21679
21680 @noindent
21681 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
21682 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
21683 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
21684 mathematical meaning of the formula.
21685
21686 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
21687 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
21688 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
21689 course be drastically changed.
21690
21691 @smallexample
21692 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
21693
21694 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
21695 @end smallexample
21696
21697 @kindex j L
21698 @pindex calc-commute-left
21699 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
21700 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
21701
21702 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
21703 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
21704 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
21705 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
21706 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
21707
21708 @kindex j D
21709 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
21710 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
21711 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
21712 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
21713 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
21714 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
21715 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
21716 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
21717 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
21718
21719 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
21720 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
21721 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
21722 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
21723 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
21724 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
21725
21726 @vindex DistribRules
21727 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
21728 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
21729 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
21730 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
21731 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
21732 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
21733 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
21734
21735 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
21736 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
21737 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
21738 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
21739
21740 @kindex j M
21741 @pindex calc-sel-merge
21742 @vindex MergeRules
21743 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
21744 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
21745 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
21746 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
21747 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
21748 the relevant rules.
21749
21750 @kindex j C
21751 @pindex calc-sel-commute
21752 @vindex CommuteRules
21753 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
21754 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
21755 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
21756 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
21757 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
21758 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
21759 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
21760 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
21761 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
21762
21763 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
21764 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
21765 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
21766 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
21767 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
21768 manipulations described in this section.
21769
21770 @kindex j N
21771 @pindex calc-sel-negate
21772 @vindex NegateRules
21773 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
21774 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
21775 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
21776 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
21777 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
21778 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
21779 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
21780 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
21781
21782 @kindex j &
21783 @pindex calc-sel-invert
21784 @vindex InvertRules
21785 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
21786 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
21787 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
21788 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
21789
21790 @kindex j E
21791 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
21792 @vindex JumpRules
21793 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
21794 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
21795 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
21796 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
21797 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
21798 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
21799
21800 @kindex j I
21801 @kindex H j I
21802 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
21803 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
21804 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
21805 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
21806 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
21807 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
21808 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
21809 as well as equations.
21810
21811 @kindex j *
21812 @kindex j /
21813 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
21814 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
21815 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
21816 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
21817 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It simplifies each
21818 side with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) before re-forming the
21819 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
21820 providing any numeric prefix argument. There is also a @kbd{j /}
21821 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
21822 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
21823
21824 As a special feature, if the numerator of the quotient is 1, then
21825 the denominator is expanded at the top level using the distributive
21826 law (i.e., using the @kbd{C-u -1 a x} command). Suppose the
21827 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, and you wish
21828 to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying both
21829 sides by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
21830 change the result @samp{(sqrt(a) - 1) / (sqrt(a) - 1) (sqrt(a) + 1)}
21831 right back to the original form by cancellation; Calc expands the
21832 denominator to @samp{sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1} to prevent
21833 this. (You would now want to use an @kbd{a x} command to expand
21834 the rest of the way, whereupon the denominator would cancel out to
21835 the desired form, @samp{a - 1}.) When the numerator is not 1, this
21836 initial expansion is not necessary because Calc's default
21837 simplifications will not notice the potential cancellation.
21838
21839 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
21840 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
21841 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
21842 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
21843 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
21844 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
21845 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
21846 message.
21847
21848 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
21849 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
21850 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
21851 back by the formula.
21852
21853 @kindex j +
21854 @kindex j -
21855 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
21856 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
21857 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
21858 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
21859 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
21860 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
21861 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
21862 results.
21863
21864 @kindex j U
21865 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
21866 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
21867 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
21868 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
21869 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
21870 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
21871 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
21872
21873 @kindex j v
21874 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
21875 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
21876 normal default simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
21877 These are the simplifications that are normally done automatically
21878 on all results, but which may have been partially inhibited by
21879 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
21880 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
21881 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
21882
21883 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
21884 the @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) command to the selected
21885 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
21886 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
21887 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
21888 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
21889 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
21890 sub-formula.
21891
21892 @kindex j "
21893 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
21894 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
21895 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
21896
21897 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
21898 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
21899
21900 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
21901 @section Algebraic Manipulation
21902
21903 @noindent
21904 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
21905 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
21906 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
21907 formula).
21908
21909 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
21910 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
21911 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
21912 from the second-to-top stack level.
21913
21914 @kindex a v
21915 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
21916 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
21917 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
21918 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
21919 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
21920 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
21921 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
21922
21923 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
21924 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
21925 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
21926
21927 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
21928 as if in Algebraic Simplification mode. This is equivalent to typing
21929 @kbd{a s}; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}. If you give a numeric prefix
21930 of 3 or more, it uses Extended Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
21931
21932 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
21933 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
21934 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
21935 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
21936 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
21937 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
21938 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
21939 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
21940 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
21941
21942 @tindex evalv
21943 @tindex evalvn
21944 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
21945 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
21946 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
21947 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
21948 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
21949 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
21950 it as a temporary different working precision.)
21951
21952 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
21953 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
21954 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
21955 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
21956 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
21957 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
21958 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
21959 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
21960 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
21961 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
21962 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
21963 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
21964
21965 @kindex a "
21966 @pindex calc-expand-formula
21967 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
21968 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
21969 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
21970 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
21971 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
21972 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
21973 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
21974 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
21975 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
21976 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
21977 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
21978 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
21979 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
21980 top-level function call.
21981
21982 @kindex a M
21983 @pindex calc-map-equation
21984 @tindex mapeq
21985 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
21986 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
21987 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
21988 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
21989 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
21990 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
21991 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
21992 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
21993 respective sides of a new equation.
21994
21995 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
21996 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
21997 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
21998 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
21999 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22000 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22001 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22002 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22003 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the @kbd{a s} command can
22004 then simplify to get @samp{2 < b}.
22005
22006 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22007 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22008 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22009 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22010 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22011
22012 @kindex H a M
22013 @tindex mapeqp
22014 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22015 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22016 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22017 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22018 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22019
22020 @kindex I a M
22021 @tindex mapeqr
22022 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22023 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22024 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22025 working with small positive angles.
22026
22027 @kindex a b
22028 @pindex calc-substitute
22029 @tindex subst
22030 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22031 all occurrences
22032 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22033 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22034 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22035 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22036 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22037 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22038 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22039 doing substitutions.
22040
22041 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22042 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22043 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22044 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22045 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22046 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22047 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22048
22049 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22050 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22051 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22052 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22053 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22054 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22055 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22056 these limitations.
22057
22058 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22059 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22060 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22061 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22062 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22063
22064 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22065 @section Simplifying Formulas
22066
22067 @noindent
22068 @kindex a s
22069 @pindex calc-simplify
22070 @tindex simplify
22071 The @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command applies
22072 various algebraic rules to simplify a formula. This includes rules which
22073 are not part of the default simplifications because they may be too slow
22074 to apply all the time, or may not be desirable all of the time. For
22075 example, non-adjacent terms of sums are combined, as in @samp{a + b + 2 a}
22076 to @samp{b + 3 a}, and some formulas like @samp{sin(arcsin(x))} are
22077 simplified to @samp{x}.
22078
22079 The sections below describe all the various kinds of algebraic
22080 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22081 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22082 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22083 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22084 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22085 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22086 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22087
22088 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22089 simplification occurs automatically. Normally only the ``default
22090 simplifications'' occur.
22091
22092 @menu
22093 * Default Simplifications::
22094 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22095 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22096 * Simplification of Units::
22097 @end menu
22098
22099 @node Default Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22100 @subsection Default Simplifications
22101
22102 @noindent
22103 @cindex Default simplifications
22104 This section describes the ``default simplifications,'' those which are
22105 normally applied to all results. For example, if you enter the variable
22106 @expr{x} on the stack twice and push @kbd{+}, Calc's default
22107 simplifications automatically change @expr{x + x} to @expr{2 x}.
22108
22109 The @kbd{m O} command turns off the default simplifications, so that
22110 @expr{x + x} will remain in this form unless you give an explicit
22111 ``simplify'' command like @kbd{=} or @kbd{a v}. @xref{Algebraic
22112 Manipulation}. The @kbd{m D} command turns the default simplifications
22113 back on.
22114
22115 The most basic default simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22116 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22117 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22118 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22119 range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22120 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22121 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22122 (@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22123
22124 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22125 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22126 simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22127 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22128 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22129 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22130 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22131 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22132
22133 Most commands apply the default simplifications to all arguments they
22134 take from the stack, perform a particular operation, then simplify
22135 the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the common special
22136 case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}],
22137 the arguments are simply popped from the stack and collected into a
22138 suitable function call, which is then simplified (the arguments being
22139 simplified first as part of the process, as described above).
22140
22141 The default simplifications are too numerous to describe completely
22142 here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22143 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22144 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22145 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22146
22147 @tex
22148 \bigskip
22149 @end tex
22150
22151 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22152 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22153 will also be applied before any built-in default simplifications.
22154 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22155
22156 @tex
22157 \bigskip
22158 @end tex
22159
22160 And now, on with the default simplifications:
22161
22162 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22163 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22164 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22165 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22166 a right-associative form for products, @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}.
22167 Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are rearranged to
22168 left-associative form, though this rarely matters since Calc's
22169 algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of
22170 sums and products as much as possible. Sums and products in
22171 their proper associative form will be written without parentheses
22172 in the examples below.
22173
22174 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22175 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22176 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22177 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22178 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22179 Calc assumes you have put the terms into the order you want
22180 and generally leaves that order alone, with the consequence
22181 that formulas like the above will only be simplified if you
22182 explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command. @xref{Algebraic
22183 Simplifications}.
22184
22185 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22186 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22187 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22188 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22189 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22190 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22191 negative-looking.
22192
22193 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22194 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22195 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22196 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22197 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22198 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22199 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22200 simplifications.)
22201
22202 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22203 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22204 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22205 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22206 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22207 using the distributive law.
22208
22209 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22210 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22211 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22212 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22213 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22214 square of the number of terms; Calc relegates potentially slow
22215 operations like this to commands that have to be invoked
22216 explicitly, like @kbd{a s}.
22217
22218 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22219 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22220 to @expr{-a}.
22221
22222 @tex
22223 \bigskip
22224 @end tex
22225
22226 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22227 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22228 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22229 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22230 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22231 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22232
22233 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22234 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22235 numbers.
22236
22237 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22238 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22239
22240 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22241 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22242 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22243 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22244 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22245
22246 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22247 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22248 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22249 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22250 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22251 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22252 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22253 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22254 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22255 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22256
22257 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22258 power is changed to use division:
22259 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22260 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22261 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22262 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22263 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22264
22265 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22266 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22267
22268 @tex
22269 \bigskip
22270 @end tex
22271
22272 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22273 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22274 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22275 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22276 respectively.
22277
22278 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22279 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22280 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22281
22282 The expression
22283 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22284 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22285 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22286 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22287 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22288 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22289 for any power @expr{c}.
22290
22291 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22292 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22293 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22294 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22295 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22296
22297 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22298 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22299 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22300 described for multiplication.
22301
22302 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22303 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22304 is cancelled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22305 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22306 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22307
22308 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22309 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22310 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22311
22312 @tex
22313 \bigskip
22314 @end tex
22315
22316 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22317 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22318 unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22319 If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22320 infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22321 mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22322
22323 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22324 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22325 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22326 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22327 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22328 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22329 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22330 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22331 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22332 (In other words,
22333 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22334 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22335 is safe to simplify, but
22336 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22337 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22338 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22339 variables satisfy these requirements.
22340
22341 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22342 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22343 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22344 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22345
22346 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22347 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22348 simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22349
22350 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22351 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22352 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22353
22354 Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22355 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22356 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22357 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22358
22359 Also, note that
22360 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22361 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22362 is changed to
22363 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22364 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22365 but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22366
22367 @tex
22368 \bigskip
22369 @end tex
22370
22371 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22372 following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22373 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22374 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22375 @expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22376 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22377 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22378 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22379 @code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22380 @expr{n} is an integer.
22381
22382 @tex
22383 \bigskip
22384 @end tex
22385
22386 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22387 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22388 @expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22389 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22390 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22391 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22392
22393 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22394 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22395 @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22396 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22397 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22398
22399 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22400 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22401 @expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22402
22403 The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22404 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22405 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22406 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22407 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22408 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22409 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22410
22411 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22412 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22413 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The @kbd{a s} command
22414 described in the next section does provide some simplifications for
22415 these functions, though.
22416
22417 One important simplification that does occur is that
22418 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22419 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22420 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22421 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22422
22423 Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22424 @tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22425 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22426 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22427 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22428 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22429
22430 Most other Calc functions have few if any default simplifications
22431 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22432 suitable numbers.
22433
22434 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Default Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22435 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22436
22437 @noindent
22438 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22439 The @kbd{a s} command makes simplifications that may be too slow to
22440 do all the time, or that may not be desirable all of the time.
22441 If you find these simplifications are worthwhile, you can type
22442 @kbd{m A} to have Calc apply them automatically.
22443
22444 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22445 the @kbd{a s} command. Note that these occur in addition to the
22446 default simplifications; even if the default simplifications have
22447 been turned off by an @kbd{m O} command, @kbd{a s} will turn them
22448 back on temporarily while it simplifies the formula.
22449
22450 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22451 to be applied by @kbd{a s}. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22452 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22453 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22454 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22455 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22456 the original expression, the process repeats with the default
22457 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22458 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22459
22460 @tex
22461 \bigskip
22462 @end tex
22463
22464 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22465 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22466 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22467 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22468 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22469
22470 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22471 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22472 adjacent terms, but @kbd{a s} compares all pairs of terms including
22473 non-adjacent ones.
22474
22475 @tex
22476 \bigskip
22477 @end tex
22478
22479 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22480 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22481 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the default
22482 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22483 but @kbd{a s} will; it first rewrites the sum to @expr{x y + x y},
22484 and then the default simplifications are able to recognize a sum
22485 of identical terms.
22486
22487 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22488 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22489 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22490 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22491
22492 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22493 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22494 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22495
22496 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22497 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22498 use for adjacent terms of products.
22499
22500 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22501 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22502 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22503 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22504 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22505 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22506 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22507
22508 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22509 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22510 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22511 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22512 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22513
22514 @tex
22515 \bigskip
22516 @end tex
22517
22518 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22519 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22520 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22521 cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22522 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22523 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22524 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is cancelled out;
22525 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22526
22527 Non-constant common factors are not found even by @kbd{a s}. To
22528 cancel the factor @expr{a} in @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first
22529 use @kbd{j M} on the product @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to
22530 @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be simplified successfully.
22531
22532 @tex
22533 \bigskip
22534 @end tex
22535
22536 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22537 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22538 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22539 will no longer occur. This is done by @kbd{a s} instead of by default
22540 in case someone (unwisely) uses the name @code{i} for a variable
22541 unrelated to complex numbers; it would be unfortunate if Calc
22542 quietly and automatically changed this formula for reasons the
22543 user might not have been thinking of.
22544
22545 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22546 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22547 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22548 pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22549 @texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22550 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22551 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22552 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22553 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22554
22555 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22556 numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22557 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22558 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22559
22560 @tex
22561 \bigskip
22562 @end tex
22563
22564 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22565 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22566 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22567 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22568 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22569
22570 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22571 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22572 cancelled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22573 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22574 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22575 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22576 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22577
22578 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22579 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22580 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22581 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22582 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22583 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22584 declared to be an integer.
22585
22586 @tex
22587 \bigskip
22588 @end tex
22589
22590 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22591 products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22592 function, the replacement is made; for example,
22593 @expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22594 Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22595 function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22596 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22597 hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22598
22599 Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22600 simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22601 simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22602 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22603 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22604 to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22605
22606 If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22607 @expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22608 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22609 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22610
22611 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22612 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22613 hyperbolic functions.
22614
22615 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22616 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
22617 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
22618 @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
22619 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
22620 @texline @math{2 \pi}
22621 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
22622 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
22623 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22624
22625 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
22626 are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
22627 @texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
22628 @infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
22629 and
22630 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
22631 @infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
22632 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
22633 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
22634 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
22635 is a suitable multiple of
22636 @texline @math{\pi i}
22637 @infoline @expr{pi i}
22638 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
22639 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
22640 @expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
22641 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
22642 negative imaginary.
22643
22644 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
22645 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
22646 function.
22647
22648 @tex
22649 \bigskip
22650 @end tex
22651
22652 Equations and inequalities are simplified by cancelling factors
22653 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
22654 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is cancelled.
22655 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
22656 cancelled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
22657 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
22658 are cancelled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
22659 sign is known.
22660
22661 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
22662 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
22663 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
22664 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
22665 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
22666 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
22667 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
22668
22669 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22670 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
22671
22672 @noindent
22673 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
22674 @cindex Extended simplification
22675 @kindex a e
22676 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
22677 @ignore
22678 @mindex esimpl@idots
22679 @end ignore
22680 @tindex esimplify
22681 The @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
22682 is like @kbd{a s}
22683 except that it applies some additional simplifications which are not
22684 ``safe'' in all cases. Use this only if you know the values in your
22685 formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these simplifications
22686 are valid. The symbolic integrator uses @kbd{a e};
22687 one effect of this is that the integrator's results must be used with
22688 caution. Where an integral table will often attach conditions like
22689 ``for positive @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic
22690 integration programs) will simply produce an unqualified result.
22691
22692 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
22693 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
22694 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
22695 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
22696 to any specific part of a formula.
22697
22698 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22699 the @kbd{a e} command. These are applied in addition to
22700 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
22701 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
22702
22703 Following is a complete list of ``unsafe'' simplifications performed
22704 by @kbd{a e}.
22705
22706 @tex
22707 \bigskip
22708 @end tex
22709
22710 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
22711 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified
22712 by @kbd{a e}. For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
22713 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
22714 @expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
22715 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
22716 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
22717 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
22718 functions always produce.
22719
22720 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
22721 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
22722 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
22723 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
22724 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
22725 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
22726 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
22727 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
22728 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
22729
22730 Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
22731 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
22732 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
22733 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
22734
22735 Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
22736 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
22737 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
22738
22739 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
22740 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
22741 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
22742 @expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
22743
22744 The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
22745 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
22746 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
22747 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
22748
22749 Common factors are cancelled from products on both sides of an
22750 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
22751 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never cancelled from
22752 inequalities: Even @kbd{a e} is not bold enough to reduce
22753 @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
22754 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
22755 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
22756 both sides of an inequality.
22757
22758 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22759 @subsection Simplification of Units
22760
22761 @noindent
22762 The simplifications described in this section are applied by the
22763 @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command. These are in addition
22764 to the regular @kbd{a s} (but not @kbd{a e}) simplifications described
22765 earlier. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
22766
22767 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
22768 the @kbd{u s} command. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
22769 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
22770
22771 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
22772 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
22773
22774 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
22775 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
22776 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
22777 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
22778 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
22779 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
22780
22781 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
22782 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
22783 leading unit are modified accordingly.
22784
22785 When cancelling and combining units in products and quotients,
22786 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
22787 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
22788 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
22789 are not combined in this way.
22790
22791 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
22792 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
22793 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
22794
22795 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
22796 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
22797 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
22798 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
22799 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
22800
22801 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
22802 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
22803 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
22804
22805 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
22806 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
22807 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
22808 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22809 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22810 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
22811 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
22812 real.)
22813
22814 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
22815 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
22816 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
22817 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
22818 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
22819 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
22820 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
22821 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
22822 replaced by approximately
22823 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
22824 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
22825 which is then changed to
22826 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
22827 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
22828 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
22829
22830 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
22831 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
22832 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
22833 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
22834 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
22835 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
22836
22837 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
22838 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
22839 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
22840 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
22841
22842 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
22843 @section Polynomials
22844
22845 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
22846 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
22847 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
22848 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
22849 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
22850 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
22851 involving the base variable.
22852
22853 @kindex a f
22854 @pindex calc-factor
22855 @tindex factor
22856 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
22857 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
22858 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
22859 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
22860 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
22861
22862 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
22863 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
22864 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
22865 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
22866 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
22867 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
22868 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
22869 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
22870 rewrite mechanism.
22871
22872 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
22873 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
22874 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
22875 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
22876 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
22877 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
22878 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
22879 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
22880 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
22881 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
22882 version of Calc.)
22883
22884 @vindex FactorRules
22885 @ignore
22886 @starindex
22887 @end ignore
22888 @tindex thecoefs
22889 @ignore
22890 @starindex
22891 @end ignore
22892 @ignore
22893 @mindex @idots
22894 @end ignore
22895 @tindex thefactors
22896 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
22897 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
22898 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
22899 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
22900 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
22901 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
22902 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
22903 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
22904 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
22905 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
22906 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
22907 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
22908 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
22909 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
22910 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
22911 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
22912 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
22913 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
22914
22915 @kindex H a f
22916 @tindex factors
22917 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
22918 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
22919 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
22920 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
22921 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
22922 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
22923 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
22924 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
22925 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
22926 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
22927 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
22928
22929 @kindex a c
22930 @pindex calc-collect
22931 @tindex collect
22932 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
22933 formula as a
22934 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
22935 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
22936 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
22937 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
22938 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
22939 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
22940 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
22941 not be expanded.
22942
22943 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
22944 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
22945 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
22946 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
22947 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
22948
22949 @kindex a x
22950 @pindex calc-expand
22951 @tindex expand
22952 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
22953 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
22954 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
22955 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
22956 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
22957 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
22958
22959 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
22960 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
22961 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
22962 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
22963 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
22964 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
22965 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
22966 do not do.)
22967
22968 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
22969 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
22970 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
22971 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
22972 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
22973 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
22974 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
22975 the way in one step.
22976
22977 @kindex a a
22978 @pindex calc-apart
22979 @tindex apart
22980 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
22981 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
22982 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
22983 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
22984 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
22985 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
22986 chooses the base variable automatically.
22987
22988 @kindex a n
22989 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
22990 @tindex nrat
22991 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
22992 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
22993 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
22994 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
22995 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
22996 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
22997
22998 @kindex a \
22999 @pindex calc-poly-div
23000 @tindex pdiv
23001 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23002 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23003 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23004 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23005 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23006 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23007 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23008 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23009 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23010
23011 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23012 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23013 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23014 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23015 above.
23016
23017 @kindex a %
23018 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23019 @tindex prem
23020 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23021 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23022 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23023 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23024 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23025 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23026
23027 @kindex a /
23028 @kindex H a /
23029 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23030 @tindex pdivrem
23031 @tindex pdivide
23032 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23033 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23034 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23035 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23036 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23037 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23038
23039 @kindex a g
23040 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23041 @tindex pgcd
23042 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23043 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23044 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23045 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23046 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23047 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23048 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23049 leaving a remainder.)
23050
23051 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23052 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23053 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23054 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23055 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23056 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23057 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23058
23059 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23060 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23061 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23062
23063 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23064 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23065
23066 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23067 @section Calculus
23068
23069 @noindent
23070 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23071 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23072 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23073 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23074 readable way.
23075
23076 @menu
23077 * Differentiation::
23078 * Integration::
23079 * Customizing the Integrator::
23080 * Numerical Integration::
23081 * Taylor Series::
23082 @end menu
23083
23084 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23085 @subsection Differentiation
23086
23087 @noindent
23088 @kindex a d
23089 @kindex H a d
23090 @pindex calc-derivative
23091 @tindex deriv
23092 @tindex tderiv
23093 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23094 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23095 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23096 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23097 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23098 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23099 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23100 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23101 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23102 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23103 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23104
23105 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23106 @var{n}th derivative.
23107
23108 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23109 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23110 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23111 answer!
23112
23113 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23114 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23115 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23116 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23117 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23118
23119 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23120 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23121 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23122 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23123 derivative of @code{f}.
23124
23125 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23126 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23127 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23128 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23129 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23130 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23131 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23132 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23133
23134 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23135 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23136 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23137 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23138 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23139 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23140 argument once).
23141
23142 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23143 @subsection Integration
23144
23145 @noindent
23146 @kindex a i
23147 @pindex calc-integral
23148 @tindex integ
23149 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23150 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23151 respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23152 work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23153 large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23154 function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23155 (Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23156 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23157 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23158 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23159 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23160 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23161 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23162 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23163
23164 With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23165 integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23166 command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23167 lower limit and an upper limit.
23168
23169 @ifnottex
23170 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23171 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23172 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23173 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23174 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23175 @end ifnottex
23176 @tex
23177 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23178 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23179 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23180 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23181 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23182 @end tex
23183
23184 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23185 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23186 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23187 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23188 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23189 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23190 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23191 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23192 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23193 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23194 Calc's solution for
23195 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23196 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23197 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23198 constant factor of
23199 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23200 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23201 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23202
23203 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23204 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23205 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23206 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23207 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23208
23209 @vindex IntegLimit
23210 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23211 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23212 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23213 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23214 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23215 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23216 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23217 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23218 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23219 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23220 by creating an Emacs buffer called @code{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23221 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23222
23223 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23224 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23225 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23226 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23227 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23228
23229 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23230 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23231
23232 @noindent
23233 @vindex IntegRules
23234 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23235 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23236 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23237 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23238 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23239 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23240 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23241 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23242 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23243 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23244 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23245 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23246 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23247 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23248 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23249 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23250
23251 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23252 @ignore
23253 @starindex
23254 @end ignore
23255 @tindex Ei
23256 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23257 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23258 integral'' function
23259 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23260 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23261 was invented to describe it.
23262 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23263 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23264 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23265 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23266 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23267 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23268 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23269 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23270 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23271
23272 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23273 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23274 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23275 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23276 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23277 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23278 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23279 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23280 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23281 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23282 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23283 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23284 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23285
23286 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23287 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23288 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23289 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23290 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23291 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23292 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23293 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23294 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23295 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23296 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23297 it need not be.
23298
23299 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23300 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23301 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23302 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23303 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23304 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23305 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23306 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23307 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23308 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23309 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23310 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23311 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23312 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23313
23314 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23315 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23316 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23317 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23318 forever!)
23319
23320 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23321 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23322 every time the integrator uses @kbd{a s} to simplify an intermediate
23323 result. For example, putting the rule @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into
23324 @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to convert the @code{twice}
23325 function into a form it knows whenever integration is attempted.
23326
23327 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23328 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23329 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23330 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23331 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23332 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23333 do this.)
23334
23335 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23336 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23337 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23338 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23339 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23340 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23341 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23342 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23343 (It also does an @kbd{a s}, without @code{IntegSimpRules}, after that
23344 to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23345 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23346 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23347 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23348 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23349 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23350 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23351 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23352 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23353
23354 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23355 @subsection Numerical Integration
23356
23357 @noindent
23358 @kindex a I
23359 @pindex calc-num-integral
23360 @tindex ninteg
23361 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23362 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23363 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23364 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23365 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23366 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23367
23368 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23369 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23370 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23371 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23372 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23373 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23374 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23375 determine the value of the integral.
23376
23377 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23378 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23379 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23380 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23381 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23382 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23383
23384 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23385 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23386 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23387 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23388 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23389 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23390 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23391
23392 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23393 @subsection Taylor Series
23394
23395 @noindent
23396 @kindex a t
23397 @pindex calc-taylor
23398 @tindex taylor
23399 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23400 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23401 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23402 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23403 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23404 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23405 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23406 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23407 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23408
23409 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23410 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23411 Taylor series.
23412
23413 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23414 @section Solving Equations
23415
23416 @noindent
23417 @kindex a S
23418 @pindex calc-solve-for
23419 @tindex solve
23420 @cindex Equations, solving
23421 @cindex Solving equations
23422 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23423 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23424 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23425 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23426 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23427 form @expr{X = 0}.
23428
23429 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23430 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23431 be; for example, solving
23432 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23433 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23434 for @expr{b} is impossible
23435 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23436 produce the result
23437 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23438 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23439 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23440 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23441 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23442 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23443 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23444 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23445
23446 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23447 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23448 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23449 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23450
23451 @menu
23452 * Multiple Solutions::
23453 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23454 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23455 @end menu
23456
23457 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23458 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23459
23460 @noindent
23461 @kindex H a S
23462 @tindex fsolve
23463 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23464 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23465 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23466 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23467 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23468 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23469 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23470 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23471 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23472 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23473 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23474 of these variables.
23475
23476 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23477 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23478 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23479 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23480 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23481 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23482 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23483 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23484
23485 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23486 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23487 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23488 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23489 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23490 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23491 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23492 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23493
23494 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23495 @vindex GenCount
23496 @ignore
23497 @starindex
23498 @end ignore
23499 @tindex an
23500 @ignore
23501 @starindex
23502 @end ignore
23503 @tindex as
23504 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23505 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23506 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23507 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23508 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23509 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23510 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23511 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23512 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23513 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23514 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23515 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23516 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23517 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23518
23519 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23520 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23521
23522 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23523 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23524 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23525
23526 @kindex I a S
23527 @kindex H I a S
23528 @tindex finv
23529 @tindex ffinv
23530 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23531 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23532 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23533 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23534 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23535 fully general inverse, as described above.
23536
23537 @kindex a P
23538 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23539 @tindex roots
23540 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23541 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23542 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23543 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23544 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23545 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23546 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23547 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23548 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23549 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23550 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23551 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23552 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23553
23554 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23555 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23556 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23557 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23558 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23559 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23560 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23561 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23562 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23563 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23564 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23565 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23566 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23567 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23568 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23569 are all numbers (real or complex).
23570
23571 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23572 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23573
23574 @noindent
23575 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23576 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23577 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23578 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23579 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23580 at the prompt.)
23581
23582 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23583 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23584 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23585 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23586 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23587 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23588 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23589 command.
23590
23591 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23592 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23593 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23594 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23595 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23596 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23597 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23598 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23599 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23600 nonlinear systems.
23601
23602 @ignore
23603 @starindex
23604 @end ignore
23605 @tindex elim
23606 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23607 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23608 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23609 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23610 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
23611 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
23612 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
23613 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
23614 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
23615 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
23616 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
23617 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
23618
23619 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
23620 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
23621 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
23622 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
23623 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
23624 by one.
23625
23626 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
23627 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
23628 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
23629 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
23630 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
23631 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
23632 variables you requested.)
23633
23634 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
23635 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
23636 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
23637
23638 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
23639 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
23640
23641 @noindent
23642 @ignore
23643 @starindex
23644 @end ignore
23645 @tindex poly
23646 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
23647 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
23648 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
23649 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
23650 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
23651 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
23652 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
23653 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
23654 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
23655 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
23656 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
23657 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
23658
23659 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
23660 @cindex Degree of polynomial
23661 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
23662 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
23663 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
23664 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
23665 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
23666
23667 @ignore
23668 @starindex
23669 @end ignore
23670 @tindex gpoly
23671 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
23672 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
23673 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
23674 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
23675 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
23676 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
23677 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
23678 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
23679 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
23680 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
23681 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
23682 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
23683 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
23684 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
23685 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
23686 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
23687 is considered trivial.
23688
23689 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
23690 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
23691
23692 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
23693 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
23694 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
23695 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
23696 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
23697
23698 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
23699 discover:
23700
23701 @smallexample
23702 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
23703 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
23704 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
23705 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
23706 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
23707 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
23708 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
23709 @end smallexample
23710
23711 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
23712 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
23713 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
23714 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
23715 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
23716 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
23717 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
23718 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
23719
23720 @ignore
23721 @starindex
23722 @end ignore
23723 @tindex pdeg
23724 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
23725 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
23726 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
23727 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
23728 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
23729 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
23730 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
23731 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
23732 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
23733 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
23734 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
23735 (minus infinity).
23736
23737 @ignore
23738 @starindex
23739 @end ignore
23740 @tindex plead
23741 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
23742 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
23743 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
23744 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
23745 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
23746
23747 @ignore
23748 @starindex
23749 @end ignore
23750 @tindex pcont
23751 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
23752 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
23753 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
23754 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
23755 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
23756 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
23757 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
23758 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
23759 coefficient.
23760
23761 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
23762 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
23763 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
23764 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
23765 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
23766 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
23767 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
23768 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
23769 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
23770 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
23771
23772 @ignore
23773 @starindex
23774 @end ignore
23775 @tindex pprim
23776 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
23777 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
23778 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
23779 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
23780 terms.
23781
23782 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
23783 @section Numerical Solutions
23784
23785 @noindent
23786 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
23787 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
23788 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
23789 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
23790 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
23791
23792 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
23793 on numerical data.)
23794
23795 @menu
23796 * Root Finding::
23797 * Minimization::
23798 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
23799 @end menu
23800
23801 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
23802 @subsection Root Finding
23803
23804 @noindent
23805 @kindex a R
23806 @pindex calc-find-root
23807 @tindex root
23808 @cindex Newton's method
23809 @cindex Roots of equations
23810 @cindex Numerical root-finding
23811 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
23812 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
23813 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
23814 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
23815
23816 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
23817 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
23818 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
23819 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
23820 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
23821 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
23822 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
23823 this command.
23824
23825 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
23826 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
23827 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
23828 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
23829 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
23830 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
23831 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
23832 the equation yourself.)
23833
23834 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
23835 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
23836
23837 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
23838 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
23839 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
23840 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
23841 to real numbers inside that interval.
23842
23843 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
23844 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
23845 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
23846 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
23847 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
23848 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
23849 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
23850
23851 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
23852 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
23853 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
23854 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
23855 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
23856 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
23857
23858 @kindex H a R
23859 @tindex wroot
23860 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
23861 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
23862 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
23863 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
23864 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
23865
23866 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
23867 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
23868 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
23869 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
23870 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
23871
23872 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
23873 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
23874 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
23875 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
23876
23877 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
23878 @subsection Minimization
23879
23880 @noindent
23881 @kindex a N
23882 @kindex H a N
23883 @kindex a X
23884 @kindex H a X
23885 @pindex calc-find-minimum
23886 @pindex calc-find-maximum
23887 @tindex minimize
23888 @tindex maximize
23889 @cindex Minimization, numerical
23890 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
23891 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
23892 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
23893 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
23894 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
23895 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
23896 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
23897 with the minimum value itself.
23898
23899 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
23900 have more than one minimum; some, like
23901 @texline @math{x \sin x},
23902 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
23903 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
23904 ``global'' minimum of
23905 @texline @math{x \sin x}
23906 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
23907 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
23908 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
23909 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
23910 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
23911
23912 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
23913 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
23914 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
23915 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
23916 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
23917 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
23918 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
23919 any, that happens to lie in that range.
23920
23921 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
23922 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
23923 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
23924 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
23925 answer.
23926
23927 @ignore
23928 @mindex wmin@idots
23929 @end ignore
23930 @tindex wminimize
23931 @ignore
23932 @mindex wmax@idots
23933 @end ignore
23934 @tindex wmaximize
23935 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
23936 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
23937 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
23938
23939 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
23940 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
23941 negative of the formula you supply.
23942
23943 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
23944 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
23945 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
23946 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
23947 be minimized over the reals.
23948
23949 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
23950 @subsection Systems of Equations
23951
23952 @noindent
23953 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
23954 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
23955 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
23956 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
23957 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
23958 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
23959 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
23960 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
23961 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
23962 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
23963 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
23964 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
23965 no effect when solving a system of equations.
23966
23967 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
23968 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
23969 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
23970 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
23971 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
23972 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
23973 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
23974
23975 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
23976 @section Curve Fitting
23977
23978 @noindent
23979 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
23980 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
23981 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
23982 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
23983 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
23984 possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
23985 the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
23986
23987 If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
23988 description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
23989 plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
23990 ``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
23991
23992 @menu
23993 * Linear Fits::
23994 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
23995 * Error Estimates for Fits::
23996 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
23997 * Curve Fitting Details::
23998 * Interpolation::
23999 @end menu
24000
24001 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24002 @subsection Linear Fits
24003
24004 @noindent
24005 @kindex a F
24006 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24007 @tindex fit
24008 @cindex Linear regression
24009 @cindex Least-squares fits
24010 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24011 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24012 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24013 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24014 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24015 fit for the data.
24016
24017 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24018 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24019 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24020 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24021 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24022 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24023 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24024 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24025
24026 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24027 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24028 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24029 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24030
24031 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24032 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24033 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24034 @texline @math{2\times N}
24035 @infoline 2xN
24036 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24037 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24038 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24039 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24040
24041 If you happen to have an
24042 @texline @math{N\times2}
24043 @infoline Nx2
24044 matrix instead of a
24045 @texline @math{2\times N}
24046 @infoline 2xN
24047 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24048
24049 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24050 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24051
24052 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24053 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24054 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24055 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24056 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24057 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24058 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24059
24060 For example, suppose the data matrix
24061
24062 @ifnottex
24063 @example
24064 @group
24065 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24066 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24067 @end group
24068 @end example
24069 @end ifnottex
24070 @tex
24071 \turnoffactive
24072 \turnoffactive
24073 \beforedisplay
24074 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24075 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24076 $$
24077 \afterdisplay
24078 @end tex
24079
24080 @noindent
24081 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24082 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24083 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24084 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24085 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24086 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24087 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24088 formula.
24089
24090 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24091 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24092 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24093 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24094 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24095 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24096
24097 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24098 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24099 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24100 the equations that go into the trail.
24101
24102 @tex
24103 \bigskip
24104 @end tex
24105
24106 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24107 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24108 The result is:
24109
24110 @example
24111 2.6 + 2.2 x
24112 @end example
24113
24114 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24115 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24116
24117 @example
24118 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24119 @end example
24120
24121 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24122 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24123 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24124 error measure
24125
24126 @ifnottex
24127 @example
24128 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24129 @end example
24130 @end ifnottex
24131 @tex
24132 \turnoffactive
24133 \beforedisplay
24134 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24135 \afterdisplay
24136 @end tex
24137
24138 @noindent
24139 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24140 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24141 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24142 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24143 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24144 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24145 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24146 for which the error
24147 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24148 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24149 is as small as possible.
24150
24151 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24152 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24153
24154 @tex
24155 \bigskip
24156 @end tex
24157
24158 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24159 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24160 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24161 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24162 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24163
24164 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24165 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24166 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24167 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24168 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24169
24170 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24171 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24172
24173 @noindent
24174 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24175 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24176 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24177 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24178 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24179
24180 @example
24181 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24182 @end example
24183
24184 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24185 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24186 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24187 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24188 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24189 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24190 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24191 won't help.)
24192
24193 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24194 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24195 line slightly to improve the fit.
24196
24197 @example
24198 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24199 @end example
24200
24201 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24202 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24203 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24204 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24205 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24206
24207 @example
24208 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24209 @end example
24210
24211 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24212 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24213 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24214 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24215 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24216 results.
24217
24218 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24219 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24220 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24221 automatically.
24222
24223 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24224 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24225 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24226 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24227 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24228 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24229
24230 @tex
24231 \bigskip
24232 @end tex
24233
24234 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24235 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24236 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24237 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24238 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24239
24240 Given the data matrix,
24241
24242 @example
24243 @group
24244 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24245 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24246 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24247 @end group
24248 @end example
24249
24250 @noindent
24251 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24252 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24253 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24254
24255 @example
24256 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24257 @end example
24258
24259 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24260 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24261
24262 @tex
24263 \bigskip
24264 @end tex
24265
24266 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24267 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24268 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24269 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24270 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24271 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24272 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24273 This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24274 message.
24275
24276 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24277 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24278 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24279 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24280 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24281
24282 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24283 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24284
24285 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24286 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24287
24288 @noindent
24289 @kindex H a F
24290 @tindex efit
24291 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24292 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24293 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24294 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24295
24296 @example
24297 3. + 2. x
24298 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24299 @end example
24300
24301 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24302 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24303 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24304
24305 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24306 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24307 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24308 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24309 row contains error forms
24310 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24311 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24312 then the
24313 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24314 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24315 statistic is now,
24316
24317 @ifnottex
24318 @example
24319 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24320 @end example
24321 @end ifnottex
24322 @tex
24323 \turnoffactive
24324 \beforedisplay
24325 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24326 \afterdisplay
24327 @end tex
24328
24329 @noindent
24330 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24331 the fitting operation.
24332
24333 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24334 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24335 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24336 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24337 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24338 used for the data point.
24339
24340 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24341 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24342 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24343 estimates.
24344
24345 If the input contains error forms but all the
24346 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24347 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24348 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24349 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24350 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24351 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24352 is simply scaled uniformly by
24353 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24354 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24355 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24356 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24357 @kbd{H a F}.
24358
24359 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24360 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24361 interpreted.
24362
24363 @tex
24364 \bigskip
24365 @end tex
24366
24367 @kindex I a F
24368 @tindex xfit
24369 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24370 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24371
24372 @enumerate
24373 @item
24374 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24375 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24376 produced.
24377
24378 @item
24379 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24380 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24381 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24382 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24383 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24384
24385 @item
24386 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24387 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24388 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24389 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24390 are the variances
24391 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24392 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24393 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24394 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24395 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24396 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24397 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24398 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24399 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24400 are defined as
24401 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24402 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24403
24404 @item
24405 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24406 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24407 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24408 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24409
24410 @item
24411 The value of
24412 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24413 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24414 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24415 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24416 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24417 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24418 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24419 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24420
24421 @item
24422 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24423 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24424 function using
24425 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24426 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24427 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24428 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24429 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24430 particular,
24431 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24432 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24433 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24434 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24435 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24436
24437 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24438 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24439 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24440 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24441 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24442 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24443 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24444 over to use for a confidence test.
24445 @end enumerate
24446
24447 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24448 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24449
24450 @noindent
24451 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24452 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24453 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24454
24455 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24456
24457 @table @kbd
24458 @item 1
24459 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24460 @item 2-9
24461 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24462 @item e
24463 Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24464 @item E
24465 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24466 @item x
24467 Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24468 @item X
24469 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24470 @item l
24471 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24472 @item L
24473 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24474 @item ^
24475 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24476 @item p
24477 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24478 @item q
24479 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24480 @item g
24481 Gaussian.
24482 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24483 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24484 @item s
24485 Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24486 @texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24487 @infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24488 @item b
24489 Logistic bell curve.
24490 @texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24491 @infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24492 @item o
24493 Hubbert linearization.
24494 @texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24495 @infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24496 @end table
24497
24498 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24499 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24500 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24501 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24502 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24503
24504 All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24505 generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24506 the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24507 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24508 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24509 before the model key.
24510
24511 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24512 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24513 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24514 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24515 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24516 matches the problem.
24517
24518 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24519 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24520 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24521 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24522 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24523 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24524
24525 @tex
24526 \bigskip
24527 @end tex
24528
24529 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24530 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24531 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24532 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24533
24534 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24535 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24536 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24537 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24538 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24539 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24540 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24541 model.
24542
24543 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24544 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24545 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24546 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24547 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24548 and thus does not need a name.
24549
24550 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24551 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24552 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24553 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24554 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24555 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24556 variables.
24557
24558 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24559 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24560 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24561 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24562 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24563 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24564 in the model formula will become parameters.
24565
24566 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24567 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24568 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24569 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24570 a linear model.
24571
24572 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24573 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24574 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24575 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24576 which are parameters.
24577
24578 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24579 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24580 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24581 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24582 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24583 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24584
24585 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24586 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24587
24588 @tex
24589 \bigskip
24590 @end tex
24591
24592 @vindex Model1
24593 @vindex Model2
24594 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24595 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24596 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24597 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24598 accept for a model on the stack.
24599
24600 @tex
24601 \bigskip
24602 @end tex
24603
24604 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24605 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24606 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24607 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24608 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24609 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24610 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24611 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24612 @texline @math{3\times360}
24613 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24614 degrees.
24615 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
24616 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
24617 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
24618 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
24619 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
24620 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
24621 even approximately.
24622
24623 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
24624 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
24625 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
24626 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
24627 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
24628 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
24629 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
24630
24631 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
24632 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
24633
24634 @noindent
24635 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
24636 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
24637 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
24638 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
24639 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
24640
24641 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
24642 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
24643 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
24644 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
24645
24646 For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
24647 to try to put the problem into the form
24648
24649 @smallexample
24650 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
24651 @end smallexample
24652
24653 @noindent
24654 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
24655 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
24656 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
24657 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
24658 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
24659
24660 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
24661 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
24662 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
24663 can be rewritten as follows:
24664
24665 @example
24666 y = a x^b
24667 y = a exp(b ln(x))
24668 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
24669 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
24670 @end example
24671
24672 @noindent
24673 which matches the desired form with
24674 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
24675 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
24676 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
24677 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
24678 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
24679 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
24680 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
24681 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
24682 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
24683 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
24684 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
24685 and @expr{b = B}.
24686
24687 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
24688 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
24689
24690 @example
24691 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
24692 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
24693 @end example
24694
24695 @noindent
24696 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
24697 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
24698 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
24699 @expr{H = x^2}.
24700
24701 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
24702 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
24703 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
24704
24705 The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
24706 models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
24707 approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
24708 iterative method to refine the approximations.
24709
24710 Another model that cannot be put into general linear
24711 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
24712 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
24713 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
24714 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
24715 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
24716 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
24717 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
24718 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
24719 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
24720 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
24721 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
24722
24723 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
24724 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
24725 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
24726
24727 @tex
24728 \bigskip
24729 @end tex
24730
24731 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
24732 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
24733 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
24734 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24735 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24736 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
24737 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
24738 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
24739 command can do the same thing by brute force.
24740
24741 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
24742 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
24743 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
24744 to be minimized would be the value of
24745 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24746 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24747 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
24748
24749 @smallexample
24750 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
24751 @end smallexample
24752
24753 @noindent
24754 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
24755 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
24756 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
24757 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
24758 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
24759 were used by itself to solve the problem).
24760
24761 @tex
24762 \bigskip
24763 @end tex
24764
24765 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
24766 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
24767 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
24768 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
24769 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
24770 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
24771 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
24772 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
24773 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
24774 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
24775 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
24776 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
24777 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
24778 and so on.
24779
24780 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
24781 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
24782 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
24783 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
24784 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
24785 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
24786 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
24787 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
24788 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
24789
24790 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
24791 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
24792 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
24793 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
24794 nontrivial filter functions.
24795
24796 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
24797 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
24798 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
24799 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
24800 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
24801 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
24802 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
24803 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
24804 form. The error part of that result is used for
24805 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24806 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24807 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
24808 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
24809 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
24810 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
24811 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
24812 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
24813 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
24814 arithmetic with no error forms.
24815
24816 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
24817 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
24818 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
24819 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
24820 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
24821 @texline @math{\sigma}
24822 @infoline @expr{sigma}
24823 for the data point with no further ado.)
24824
24825 @tex
24826 \bigskip
24827 @end tex
24828
24829 @vindex FitRules
24830 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
24831 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
24832 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
24833 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
24834 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
24835 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
24836 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
24837
24838 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
24839
24840 @ignore
24841 @starindex
24842 @end ignore
24843 @tindex fitvar
24844 @ignore
24845 @starindex
24846 @end ignore
24847 @ignore
24848 @mindex @idots
24849 @end ignore
24850 @tindex fitparam
24851 @ignore
24852 @starindex
24853 @end ignore
24854 @ignore
24855 @mindex @null
24856 @end ignore
24857 @tindex fitmodel
24858 @ignore
24859 @starindex
24860 @end ignore
24861 @ignore
24862 @mindex @null
24863 @end ignore
24864 @tindex fitsystem
24865 @ignore
24866 @starindex
24867 @end ignore
24868 @ignore
24869 @mindex @null
24870 @end ignore
24871 @tindex fitdummy
24872 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
24873 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
24874 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
24875 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
24876 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
24877 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
24878 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
24879 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
24880 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
24881
24882 @smallexample
24883 @group
24884 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
24885 @end group
24886 @end smallexample
24887
24888 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
24889 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
24890 changes are possible.)
24891
24892 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
24893 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
24894
24895 @example
24896 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
24897 @end example
24898
24899 @noindent
24900 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
24901 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
24902 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
24903 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
24904 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
24905 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
24906 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
24907
24908 The power law model eventually boils down to
24909
24910 @smallexample
24911 @group
24912 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
24913 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
24914 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
24915 @end group
24916 @end smallexample
24917
24918 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
24919 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
24920 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
24921 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
24922 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
24923 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
24924 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
24925 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
24926 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
24927 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
24928 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
24929 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
24930 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
24931
24932 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
24933 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
24934 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
24935 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
24936 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
24937 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
24938 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
24939 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
24940 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
24941 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
24942 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
24943 raw parameters, for now.)
24944
24945 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
24946 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
24947 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
24948 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
24949 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
24950 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
24951 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
24952 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
24953 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
24954 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
24955 raw parameters needed.
24956
24957 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
24958 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
24959 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
24960 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
24961 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
24962 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
24963 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
24964 least-squares solver wants to see.
24965
24966 @ignore
24967 @starindex
24968 @end ignore
24969 @ignore
24970 @mindex hasfit@idots
24971 @end ignore
24972 @tindex hasfitparams
24973 @ignore
24974 @starindex
24975 @end ignore
24976 @ignore
24977 @mindex @null
24978 @end ignore
24979 @tindex hasfitvars
24980 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
24981 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
24982 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
24983 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
24984 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
24985 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
24986 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
24987 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
24988 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
24989
24990 @tex
24991 \bigskip
24992 @end tex
24993
24994 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
24995 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
24996 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
24997 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
24998 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
24999 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25000 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25001 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25002 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25003 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25004
25005 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25006 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25007 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25008 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25009 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25010
25011 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25012 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25013 and variables, as discussed previously.
25014
25015 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25016 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25017 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25018 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25019
25020 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25021 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25022
25023 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25024 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25025
25026 @kindex a p
25027 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25028 @tindex polint
25029 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25030 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25031 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25032 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25033 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25034 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25035 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25036 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25037 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25038
25039 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25040 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25041 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25042 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25043 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25044 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25045
25046 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25047 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25048
25049 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25050 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25051 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25052 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25053 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25054 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25055
25056 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25057 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25058
25059 @kindex H a p
25060 @tindex ratint
25061 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25062 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25063 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25064 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25065 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25066 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25067
25068 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25069 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25070 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25071 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25072 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25073 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25074
25075 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25076 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25077 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25078 capabilities to fit.)
25079
25080 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25081 @section Summations
25082
25083 @noindent
25084 @cindex Summation of a series
25085 @kindex a +
25086 @pindex calc-summation
25087 @tindex sum
25088 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25089 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25090 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25091 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25092 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25093 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25094 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25095 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25096 produces the result 55.
25097 @tex
25098 \turnoffactive
25099 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25100 @end tex
25101
25102 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25103 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25104 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25105 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25106 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25107 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25108 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25109 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25110 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25111
25112 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25113 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25114 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25115 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25116 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25117 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25118 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25119 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25120 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25121
25122 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25123 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25124 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25125 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25126 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25127 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25128 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25129 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25130 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25131 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25132
25133 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25134 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25135 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25136 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25137 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25138 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25139
25140 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25141 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25142 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25143 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25144 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25145 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25146 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25147 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25148
25149 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25150 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25151 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25152 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25153 valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25154 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25155
25156 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25157 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25158 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25159 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25160 after simplification as if by @kbd{a s}, evaluate to an integer.
25161
25162 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25163 not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25164 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25165 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25166 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25167 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25168 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25169 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25170
25171 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25172 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25173 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25174 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25175 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25176 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25177 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25178
25179 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25180 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25181 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25182 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25183 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25184 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25185 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25186 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25187 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25188 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25189 closed form.
25190
25191 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25192 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25193 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25194 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25195 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25196 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25197 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25198 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25199 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25200 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25201 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25202 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25203 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25204 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25205
25206 @cindex Alternating sums
25207 @kindex a -
25208 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25209 @tindex asum
25210 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25211 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25212 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25213 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25214 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25215 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25216 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25217 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25218 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25219 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25220 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25221 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25222
25223 @cindex Product of a sequence
25224 @kindex a *
25225 @pindex calc-product
25226 @tindex prod
25227 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25228 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25229 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25230 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25231 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25232
25233 @kindex a T
25234 @pindex calc-tabulate
25235 @tindex table
25236 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25237 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25238 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25239 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25240 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25241
25242 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25243 @section Logical Operations
25244
25245 @noindent
25246 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25247 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25248 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25249 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25250 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25251 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25252 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25253 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25254 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25255 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25256 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25257 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25258 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25259 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25260
25261 @kindex a =
25262 @pindex calc-equal-to
25263 @tindex eq
25264 @tindex =
25265 @tindex ==
25266 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25267 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25268 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25269 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25270 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25271 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25272 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25273 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25274 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25275
25276 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25277 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25278 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25279 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25280 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25281 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25282 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25283 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25284 zero if not.
25285
25286 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25287 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25288 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25289 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25290 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25291 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25292 variables).
25293
25294 @kindex a #
25295 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25296 @tindex neq
25297 @tindex !=
25298 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25299 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25300 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25301 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25302 distinct numbers.
25303
25304 @kindex a <
25305 @tindex lt
25306 @ignore
25307 @mindex @idots
25308 @end ignore
25309 @kindex a >
25310 @ignore
25311 @mindex @null
25312 @end ignore
25313 @kindex a [
25314 @ignore
25315 @mindex @null
25316 @end ignore
25317 @kindex a ]
25318 @pindex calc-less-than
25319 @pindex calc-greater-than
25320 @pindex calc-less-equal
25321 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25322 @ignore
25323 @mindex @null
25324 @end ignore
25325 @tindex gt
25326 @ignore
25327 @mindex @null
25328 @end ignore
25329 @tindex leq
25330 @ignore
25331 @mindex @null
25332 @end ignore
25333 @tindex geq
25334 @ignore
25335 @mindex @null
25336 @end ignore
25337 @tindex <
25338 @ignore
25339 @mindex @null
25340 @end ignore
25341 @tindex >
25342 @ignore
25343 @mindex @null
25344 @end ignore
25345 @tindex <=
25346 @ignore
25347 @mindex @null
25348 @end ignore
25349 @tindex >=
25350 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25351 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25352 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25353 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25354 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25355
25356 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25357 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25358 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25359 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25360 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25361 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25362 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25363 involve both equalities and inequalities, are not allowed.
25364
25365 @kindex a .
25366 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25367 @tindex rmeq
25368 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25369 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25370 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25371 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25372 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25373 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25374 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25375 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25376 righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25377 taking the lefthand side.
25378
25379 @kindex a &
25380 @pindex calc-logical-and
25381 @tindex land
25382 @tindex &&
25383 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25384 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25385 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25386 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25387 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25388
25389 @kindex a |
25390 @pindex calc-logical-or
25391 @tindex lor
25392 @tindex ||
25393 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25394 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25395 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25396 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25397 zero.
25398
25399 @kindex a !
25400 @pindex calc-logical-not
25401 @tindex lnot
25402 @tindex !
25403 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25404 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25405 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25406 number.
25407
25408 @kindex a :
25409 @pindex calc-logical-if
25410 @tindex if
25411 @ignore
25412 @mindex ? :
25413 @end ignore
25414 @tindex ?
25415 @ignore
25416 @mindex @null
25417 @end ignore
25418 @tindex :
25419 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25420 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25421 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25422 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25423 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25424 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25425 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25426 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25427 @code{condition}.
25428
25429 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25430 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25431 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25432 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25433
25434 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25435 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25436 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25437 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25438 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25439 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25440 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25441
25442 @kindex a @{
25443 @pindex calc-in-set
25444 @tindex in
25445 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25446 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25447 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25448 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25449 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25450 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25451 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25452 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25453 of this sort.
25454
25455 @ignore
25456 @starindex
25457 @end ignore
25458 @tindex typeof
25459 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25460 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25461 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25462
25463 @example
25464 1 Integer
25465 2 Fraction
25466 3 Floating-point number
25467 4 HMS form
25468 5 Rectangular complex number
25469 6 Polar complex number
25470 7 Error form
25471 8 Interval form
25472 9 Modulo form
25473 10 Date-only form
25474 11 Date/time form
25475 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25476 100 Variable
25477 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25478 102 Matrix
25479 @end example
25480
25481 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25482 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25483
25484 @ignore
25485 @starindex
25486 @end ignore
25487 @tindex integer
25488 @ignore
25489 @starindex
25490 @end ignore
25491 @tindex real
25492 @ignore
25493 @starindex
25494 @end ignore
25495 @tindex constant
25496 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25497 The @samp{real(a)} function
25498 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25499 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25500 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25501 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25502 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25503 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25504 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25505
25506 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25507 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25508 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25509 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25510 literally an integer constant.
25511
25512 @ignore
25513 @starindex
25514 @end ignore
25515 @tindex refers
25516 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25517 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25518 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25519 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25520 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25521 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25522
25523 @ignore
25524 @starindex
25525 @end ignore
25526 @tindex negative
25527 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25528 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25529 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25530 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25531 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25532 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25533 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25534 as a rewrite rule condition).
25535
25536 @ignore
25537 @starindex
25538 @end ignore
25539 @tindex variable
25540 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25541 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25542 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25543 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25544
25545 @ignore
25546 @starindex
25547 @end ignore
25548 @tindex nonvar
25549 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25550 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25551 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25552 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25553 often good enough.
25554
25555 @ignore
25556 @starindex
25557 @end ignore
25558 @tindex lin
25559 @ignore
25560 @starindex
25561 @end ignore
25562 @tindex linnt
25563 @ignore
25564 @starindex
25565 @end ignore
25566 @tindex islin
25567 @ignore
25568 @starindex
25569 @end ignore
25570 @tindex islinnt
25571 @cindex Linearity testing
25572 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25573 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25574 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25575 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25576 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25577 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25578 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25579 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25580 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25581 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25582 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25583 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25584 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25585 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25586 returns true.
25587
25588 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25589 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25590 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25591 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25592 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25593 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25594 linear in @expr{x}).
25595
25596 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25597 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25598 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25599 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25600 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25601 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25602 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25603 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25604 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25605 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25606
25607 @ignore
25608 @starindex
25609 @end ignore
25610 @tindex istrue
25611 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25612 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25613 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25614 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25615 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
25616 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
25617 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
25618 in symbolic form.)
25619
25620 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
25621 @section Rewrite Rules
25622
25623 @noindent
25624 @cindex Rewrite rules
25625 @cindex Transformations
25626 @cindex Pattern matching
25627 @kindex a r
25628 @pindex calc-rewrite
25629 @tindex rewrite
25630 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
25631 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
25632 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
25633 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
25634 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
25635 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
25636 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
25637 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
25638 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
25639
25640 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
25641 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
25642 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
25643 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
25644 Calc formulas.
25645
25646 @menu
25647 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
25648 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
25649 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
25650 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
25651 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
25652 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
25653 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
25654 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
25655 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
25656 * Matching Commands::
25657 * Automatic Rewrites::
25658 * Debugging Rewrites::
25659 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
25660 @end menu
25661
25662 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25663 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
25664
25665 @noindent
25666 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
25667 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
25668 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
25669 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
25670 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
25671 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
25672 assignments in special ways.
25673
25674 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
25675 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
25676 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
25677 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
25678 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
25679
25680 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
25681 rules.
25682
25683 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
25684 in several ways:
25685
25686 @enumerate
25687 @item
25688 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
25689 @item
25690 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
25691 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
25692 @item
25693 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
25694 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
25695 @item
25696 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
25697 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
25698 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
25699 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
25700 @item
25701 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
25702 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
25703 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
25704 @end enumerate
25705
25706 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
25707 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
25708 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
25709
25710 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
25711 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
25712 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
25713 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
25714 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
25715 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
25716
25717 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
25718 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
25719 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
25720 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
25721 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
25722 reason to store your rules in a variable.
25723
25724 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
25725 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
25726 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
25727
25728 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25729 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
25730
25731 @noindent
25732 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
25733 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
25734 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
25735 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
25736 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
25737 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
25738 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
25739 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
25740 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
25741 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
25742 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
25743
25744 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
25745 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
25746 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
25747 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
25748 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
25749
25750 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
25751 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
25752 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
25753 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
25754 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
25755
25756 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
25757 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
25758 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
25759 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
25760
25761 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
25762 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
25763 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
25764 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
25765 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
25766
25767 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
25768 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
25769 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
25770 change at a time.
25771
25772 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25773 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
25774
25775 @noindent
25776 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
25777 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
25778 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
25779 is present in the
25780 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
25781 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
25782 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
25783 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
25784 with @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}). If the result is a nonzero
25785 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
25786 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
25787 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
25788 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
25789 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
25790
25791 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
25792 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
25793 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
25794 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
25795 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
25796 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
25797 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
25798 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
25799 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
25800
25801 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
25802 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
25803 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
25804 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
25805 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
25806 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
25807 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
25808 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
25809 the condition.
25810
25811 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
25812 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
25813 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
25814
25815 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
25816 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
25817
25818 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
25819 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
25820 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
25821 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
25822 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
25823 matched.
25824
25825 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
25826 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
25827 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
25828 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
25829 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
25830 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
25831 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
25832 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
25833 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
25834
25835 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
25836 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
25837 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
25838 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
25839 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
25840 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
25841 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
25842 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
25843 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
25844
25845 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
25846 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
25847 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
25848 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
25849 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
25850 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
25851 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
25852 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
25853 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
25854
25855 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
25856 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
25857
25858 @noindent
25859 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
25860 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
25861 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
25862 account:
25863
25864 @smallexample
25865 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
25866 @end smallexample
25867
25868 For example, the rewrite rule:
25869
25870 @example
25871 a x + b x := (a + b) x
25872 @end example
25873
25874 @noindent
25875 will match formulas of the form,
25876
25877 @example
25878 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
25879 @end example
25880
25881 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
25882 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
25883
25884 @example
25885 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
25886 @end example
25887
25888 @noindent
25889 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
25890
25891 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
25892 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
25893 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
25894
25895 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
25896 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
25897 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
25898 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
25899 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
25900 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
25901 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
25902 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
25903
25904 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
25905 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
25906 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
25907 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
25908 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
25909 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
25910 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
25911 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
25912 from occurring.
25913
25914 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
25915 the rule
25916
25917 @example
25918 f(-x) := -f(x)
25919 @end example
25920
25921 @noindent
25922 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
25923 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
25924 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
25925 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
25926 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
25927 condition is:
25928
25929 @example
25930 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
25931 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
25932 @end example
25933
25934 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
25935 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
25936
25937 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
25938 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
25939 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
25940 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
25941
25942 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
25943 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
25944 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
25945 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
25946 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
25947 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
25948 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
25949 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
25950 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
25951 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
25952
25953 Even more subtle is the rule set
25954
25955 @example
25956 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
25957 @end example
25958
25959 @noindent
25960 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
25961 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
25962 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
25963 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
25964 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
25965 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
25966 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
25967 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
25968 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
25969 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
25970 rule will have to be added.
25971
25972 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
25973 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
25974 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
25975 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
25976 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
25977
25978 @example
25979 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
25980 @end example
25981
25982 @noindent
25983 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
25984 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
25985 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
25986 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
25987 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
25988 conjugate of a real number.)
25989
25990 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
25991
25992 @example
25993 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
25994 @end example
25995
25996 @noindent
25997 will match the formula
25998
25999 @example
26000 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26001 @end example
26002
26003 @noindent
26004 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26005 formulas like
26006
26007 @example
26008 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26009 @end example
26010
26011 @noindent
26012 producing, respectively,
26013
26014 @example
26015 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26016 @end example
26017
26018 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26019 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26020
26021 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26022 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26023 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26024 with @samp{a = -1}.
26025
26026 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26027
26028 @example
26029 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26030 @end example
26031
26032 @noindent
26033 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26034
26035 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26036 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26037 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26038 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26039 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26040 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26041 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26042 for a multiplication, not a division.
26043
26044 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26045 by 1,
26046
26047 @example
26048 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26049 @end example
26050
26051 @noindent
26052 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26053 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26054
26055 @example
26056 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26057 @end example
26058
26059 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26060 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26061
26062 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26063
26064 @example
26065 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26066 @end example
26067
26068 @noindent
26069 into the form
26070
26071 @example
26072 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26073 @end example
26074
26075 @noindent
26076 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26077 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26078 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26079 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26080 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26081
26082 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26083 following rule,
26084
26085 @example
26086 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26087 @end example
26088
26089 @noindent
26090 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26091 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26092 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26093 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26094 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26095 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26096 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26097
26098 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26099 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26100 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26101
26102 @example
26103 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26104 @end example
26105
26106 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26107 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26108 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26109 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26110 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26111 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26112 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26113 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26114
26115 @smallexample
26116 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26117 max min re im conj arg
26118 @end smallexample
26119
26120 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26121 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26122 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26123 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26124 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26125 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26126 For example,
26127
26128 @example
26129 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26130 @end example
26131
26132 @noindent
26133 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26134 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26135 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26136 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26137 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26138 further and use
26139
26140 @example
26141 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26142 @end example
26143
26144 @noindent
26145 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26146
26147 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26148 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26149 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26150
26151 @example
26152 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26153 @end example
26154
26155 @noindent
26156 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26157
26158 @example
26159 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26160 @end example
26161
26162 @noindent
26163 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26164 effect!
26165
26166 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26167 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26168 in the rule
26169
26170 @example
26171 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26172 @end example
26173
26174 @noindent
26175 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26176 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26177 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26178 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26179 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26180 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26181 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26182 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26183 marker on the righthand side:
26184
26185 @example
26186 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26187 @end example
26188
26189 @noindent
26190 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26191 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26192 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26193
26194 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26195 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26196
26197 @noindent
26198 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26199 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26200 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26201 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26202
26203 @ignore
26204 @starindex
26205 @end ignore
26206 @tindex import
26207 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26208 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26209 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26210 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26211 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26212 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26213 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26214 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26215 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26216 @texline @math{v_1},
26217 @infoline @expr{v1},
26218 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26219 @texline @math{x_1}
26220 @infoline @expr{x1}
26221 and so on. (If
26222 @texline @math{v_1}
26223 @infoline @expr{v1}
26224 is used as a function name, then
26225 @texline @math{x_1}
26226 @infoline @expr{x1}
26227 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26228 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26229 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26230 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26231 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26232
26233 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26234
26235 @table @samp
26236 @item quote(x)
26237 @ignore
26238 @starindex
26239 @end ignore
26240 @tindex quote
26241 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26242 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26243 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26244 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26245 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26246 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26247 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26248 as a result in this case.)
26249
26250 @item plain(x)
26251 @ignore
26252 @starindex
26253 @end ignore
26254 @tindex plain
26255 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26256 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26257 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26258 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26259 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26260 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26261 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26262 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26263
26264 @item opt(x,def)
26265 @ignore
26266 @starindex
26267 @end ignore
26268 @tindex opt
26269 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26270 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26271 the argument or element is optional.
26272 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26273 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26274 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26275 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26276 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26277 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26278
26279 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26280 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26281 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26282 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26283 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26284 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26285 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26286 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26287 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26288
26289 @item condition(x,c)
26290 @ignore
26291 @starindex
26292 @end ignore
26293 @tindex condition
26294 @tindex ::
26295 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26296 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26297
26298 @item pand(x,y)
26299 @ignore
26300 @starindex
26301 @end ignore
26302 @tindex pand
26303 @tindex &&&
26304 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26305 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26306 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26307
26308 @item por(x,y)
26309 @ignore
26310 @starindex
26311 @end ignore
26312 @tindex por
26313 @tindex |||
26314 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26315 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26316
26317 @item pnot(x)
26318 @ignore
26319 @starindex
26320 @end ignore
26321 @tindex pnot
26322 @tindex !!!
26323 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26324 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26325
26326 @item cons(h,t)
26327 @ignore
26328 @mindex cons
26329 @end ignore
26330 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26331 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26332 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26333 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26334 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26335 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26336 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26337
26338 @item rcons(t,h)
26339 @ignore
26340 @mindex rcons
26341 @end ignore
26342 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26343 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26344 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26345 to @expr{t}.
26346
26347 @item apply(f,args)
26348 @ignore
26349 @mindex apply
26350 @end ignore
26351 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26352 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26353 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26354 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26355 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26356 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26357 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26358 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26359 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26360 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26361 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26362 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26363 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26364 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26365 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26366
26367 @example
26368 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26369 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26370 @end example
26371
26372 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26373 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26374 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26375 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26376 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26377 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26378 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26379
26380 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26381 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26382 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26383
26384 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26385 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26386 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26387 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26388 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26389 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26390 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26391 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26392 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26393 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26394
26395 @item select(x)
26396 @ignore
26397 @starindex
26398 @end ignore
26399 @tindex select
26400 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26401 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26402 @end table
26403
26404 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26405
26406 @table @samp
26407 @item quote(x)
26408 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26409 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26410 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26411 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26412 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26413 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26414 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26415 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26416 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26417 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26418
26419 @item plain(x)
26420 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26421 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26422 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26423 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26424 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26425 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26426 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26427
26428 @item cons(h,t)
26429 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26430 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26431 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26432 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26433 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26434 have been turned off.
26435
26436 @item rcons(t,h)
26437 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26438 the vector @expr{t}.
26439
26440 @item apply(f,args)
26441 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26442 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26443 is also a regular Calc function.
26444
26445 @item eval(x)
26446 @ignore
26447 @starindex
26448 @end ignore
26449 @tindex eval
26450 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26451 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26452 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26453 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26454 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26455 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26456 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26457
26458 @item evalsimp(x)
26459 @ignore
26460 @starindex
26461 @end ignore
26462 @tindex evalsimp
26463 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26464 way, then algebraically simplified as if by the @kbd{a s} command.
26465
26466 @item evalextsimp(x)
26467 @ignore
26468 @starindex
26469 @end ignore
26470 @tindex evalextsimp
26471 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26472 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26473
26474 @item select(x)
26475 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26476 @end table
26477
26478 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26479
26480 @table @samp
26481 @item let(v := x)
26482 @ignore
26483 @starindex
26484 @end ignore
26485 @tindex let
26486 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26487 The @kbd{a s} command's simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26488 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26489 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26490 of simplification. The
26491 result of @expr{x} is then bound to the meta-variable @expr{v}. As
26492 usual, if this meta-variable has already been matched to something
26493 else the two values must be equal; if the meta-variable is new then
26494 it is bound to the result of the expression. This variable can then
26495 appear in later conditions, and on the righthand side of the rule.
26496 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26497 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26498 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26499 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26500 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26501 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26502
26503 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26504 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26505 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26506 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26507
26508 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26509 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26510 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26511 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26512 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26513 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26514 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26515 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26516 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26517 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26518 be bound to @code{ia}.
26519
26520 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26521 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26522 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26523 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26524 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26525 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26526 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26527 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26528 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26529 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26530
26531 @ignore
26532 @starindex
26533 @end ignore
26534 @tindex ierf
26535 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26536 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26537 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26538 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26539 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26540 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26541
26542 @example
26543 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26544 @end example
26545
26546 @item matches(v,p)
26547 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26548 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26549 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26550 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26551 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26552 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26553 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26554 rule.
26555
26556 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26557 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26558 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26559
26560 @item remember
26561 @vindex remember
26562 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26563 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26564 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26565 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26566 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26567 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26568 contains any variables.
26569
26570 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26571 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26572 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26573 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26574 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26575 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26576
26577 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26578 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26579 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26580 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26581 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26582 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26583 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26584
26585 @item remember(c)
26586 @ignore
26587 @starindex
26588 @end ignore
26589 @tindex remember
26590 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26591 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26592 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26593 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26594 @end table
26595
26596 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26597 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26598
26599 @noindent
26600 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26601 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26602 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26603 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26604 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26605
26606 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26607 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26608 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26609
26610 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26611 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26612 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26613 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26614
26615 @example
26616 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
26617 @end example
26618
26619 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
26620
26621 @example
26622 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
26623 @end example
26624
26625 @ignore
26626 @starindex
26627 @end ignore
26628 @tindex ends
26629 Here's another interesting example:
26630
26631 @example
26632 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
26633 @end example
26634
26635 @noindent
26636 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
26637 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
26638 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
26639
26640 @example
26641 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
26642 @end example
26643
26644 @noindent
26645 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
26646 one-element vector.
26647
26648 @tex
26649 \bigskip
26650 @end tex
26651
26652 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
26653 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
26654 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
26655
26656 @ignore
26657 @starindex
26658 @end ignore
26659 @tindex curve
26660 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
26661
26662 @example
26663 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
26664 @end example
26665
26666 @noindent
26667 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
26668
26669 Here is a larger example:
26670
26671 @example
26672 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
26673 @end example
26674
26675 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
26676 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
26677 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
26678
26679 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
26680 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
26681
26682 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
26683 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
26684 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
26685 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
26686 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
26687 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
26688 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
26689 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
26690
26691 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
26692 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
26693 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
26694 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
26695
26696 @example
26697 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
26698 @end example
26699
26700 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
26701 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
26702
26703 @tex
26704 \bigskip
26705 @end tex
26706
26707 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
26708 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
26709 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
26710
26711 For example,
26712
26713 @example
26714 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
26715 @end example
26716
26717 @noindent
26718 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
26719 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
26720 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
26721
26722 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
26723 then an equivalent rule would be:
26724
26725 @example
26726 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
26727 @end example
26728
26729 @noindent
26730 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
26731 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
26732 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
26733 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
26734 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
26735 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
26736 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
26737
26738 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
26739 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
26740
26741 @example
26742 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
26743 @end example
26744
26745 @noindent
26746 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
26747 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
26748
26749 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
26750 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
26751 matched last. Thus
26752
26753 @example
26754 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
26755 @end example
26756
26757 @noindent
26758 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
26759 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
26760 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
26761 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
26762 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
26763 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
26764
26765 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26766 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
26767
26768 @noindent
26769 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
26770 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
26771 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
26772 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
26773 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
26774 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
26775 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
26776 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
26777
26778 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
26779 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
26780 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
26781 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
26782 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
26783 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
26784 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
26785 anywhere in the formula.
26786
26787 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
26788 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
26789 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
26790 side actually comes out to something different than the original
26791 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
26792 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
26793 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
26794 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
26795 forms.
26796
26797 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
26798 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
26799 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
26800 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
26801 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
26802
26803 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
26804 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
26805 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
26806 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
26807
26808 @ignore
26809 @starindex
26810 @end ignore
26811 @ignore
26812 @mindex iter@idots
26813 @end ignore
26814 @tindex iterations
26815 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
26816 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
26817 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
26818 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
26819 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
26820 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
26821 rule set.
26822
26823 @example
26824 [ iterations(1),
26825 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
26826 @end example
26827
26828 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
26829 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
26830 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
26831 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
26832 that was matched.
26833
26834 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
26835
26836 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
26837 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
26838 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
26839
26840 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
26841 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
26842 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
26843 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
26844 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
26845 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
26846 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
26847 are omitted, 100 is used.
26848
26849 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26850 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
26851
26852 @noindent
26853 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
26854 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
26855 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
26856 phases occur during the rewriting process.
26857
26858 @ignore
26859 @starindex
26860 @end ignore
26861 @tindex phase
26862 @vindex all
26863 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
26864 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
26865 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
26866 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
26867 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
26868 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
26869
26870 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
26871 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
26872 ascending order. For example, the rule set
26873
26874 @example
26875 @group
26876 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
26877 phase(1),
26878 f1(x) := g1(x),
26879 phase(2),
26880 f2(x) := g2(x),
26881 phase(3),
26882 f3(x) := g3(x),
26883 phase(1,2),
26884 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
26885 @end group
26886 @end example
26887
26888 @noindent
26889 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
26890 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
26891 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
26892 and @code{f3}.
26893
26894 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
26895 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
26896 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
26897 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
26898 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
26899 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
26900 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
26901 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
26902 100 by default, is reached.)
26903
26904 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
26905 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
26906 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
26907 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
26908 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
26909 in the formula.
26910
26911 @ignore
26912 @starindex
26913 @end ignore
26914 @tindex schedule
26915 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
26916 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
26917 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
26918 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
26919 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
26920 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
26921 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
26922 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
26923 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
26924 moving on to phase 3.
26925
26926 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
26927 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
26928 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
26929 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
26930 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
26931 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
26932 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
26933 touches.
26934
26935 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
26936 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
26937 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
26938 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
26939 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
26940 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
26941 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
26942
26943 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
26944 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
26945 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
26946 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
26947 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
26948 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
26949
26950 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
26951 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
26952 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
26953 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
26954 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
26955 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
26956 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
26957 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
26958 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
26959 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
26960 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
26961
26962 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
26963 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
26964 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
26965 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
26966 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
26967 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
26968 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
26969
26970 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26971 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
26972
26973 @noindent
26974 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
26975 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
26976 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
26977 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
26978 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
26979
26980 @kindex j r
26981 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
26982 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
26983 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
26984 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
26985 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
26986 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
26987 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
26988 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
26989 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
26990
26991 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
26992 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
26993 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
26994 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
26995 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
26996 the selected sub-formula should appear.
26997
26998 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
26999 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27000 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27001 formula will be unselected.
27002
27003 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27004 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27005 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27006 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27007 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27008 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27009 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27010 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27011
27012 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27013 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27014 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27015 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27016
27017 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27018 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27019 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27020 at stack level 1.)
27021
27022 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27023 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27024 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27025 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27026 target and the rewrite rules).
27027
27028 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27029 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27030 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27031 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27032 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27033 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27034
27035 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27036 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27037 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27038 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27039 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27040 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27041 both with and without selections.
27042
27043 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27044 @subsection Matching Commands
27045
27046 @noindent
27047 @kindex a m
27048 @pindex calc-match
27049 @tindex match
27050 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27051 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27052 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27053 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27054 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27055 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27056 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27057 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27058 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27059 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27060 of the patterns.
27061
27062 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27063 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27064
27065 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27066
27067 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27068 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27069 all the positive vector elements.
27070
27071 @kindex I a m
27072 @tindex matchnot
27073 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27074 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27075
27076 @ignore
27077 @starindex
27078 @end ignore
27079 @tindex matches
27080 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27081 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27082 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27083 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27084
27085 @ignore
27086 @starindex
27087 @end ignore
27088 @tindex vmatches
27089 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27090 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27091 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27092 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27093 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27094
27095 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27096 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27097
27098 @noindent
27099 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27100 @vindex EvalRules
27101 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27102 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27103 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27104 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27105 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27106
27107 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27108 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27109 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27110 set would be,
27111
27112 @smallexample
27113 @group
27114 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27115 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27116 @end group
27117 @end smallexample
27118
27119 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27120 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27121 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27122 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27123 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27124 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27125 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27126
27127 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27128 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27129 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27130 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27131 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27132 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27133 applies rules from the top down.
27134
27135 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27136 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27137
27138 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27139 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27140 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27141 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27142 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27143 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27144 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27145 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27146 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27147 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27148 or ran too long'' message.
27149
27150 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27151 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27152 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27153 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27154 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27155 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27156 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27157 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27158 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27159 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27160 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27161 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27162 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27163
27164 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27165 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27166 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27167 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27168 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27169 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27170 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27171 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27172 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27173 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27174 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27175 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27176 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27177
27178 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27179 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27180 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27181 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27182
27183 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27184 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27185 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27186 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27187 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27188 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27189 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27190 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27191
27192 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27193 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27194 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27195 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27196 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27197 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27198 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27199 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27200 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27201 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27202 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27203 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27204 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27205 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27206
27207 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27208 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27209 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27210 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27211 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27212 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27213 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27214 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27215 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27216 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27217 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27218 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27219 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27220
27221 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27222 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27223
27224 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27225 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27226 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27227 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27228 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27229 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27230 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27231
27232 @smallexample
27233 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27234 @end smallexample
27235
27236 @noindent
27237 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27238 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27239 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27240 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27241
27242 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27243 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27244 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27245 but only when @kbd{a s} is used to simplify the formula. The variable
27246 @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose. The @kbd{a s} command
27247 will apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as
27248 well as all of its built-in simplifications.
27249
27250 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27251 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27252 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of @kbd{a s}.
27253 It then applies its own built-in simplifications throughout the
27254 formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with applying the
27255 default simplifications) until no further changes are possible.
27256
27257 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27258 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27259 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27260 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27261 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27262 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27263 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27264 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27265 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27266
27267 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27268 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27269
27270 @noindent
27271 If a buffer named @samp{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27272 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27273 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27274 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27275 noted.
27276
27277 Calc always appends to @samp{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27278 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27279
27280 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27281 @samp{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27282 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27283 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27284 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27285 be needlessly slow.
27286
27287 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27288 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27289
27290 @noindent
27291 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27292 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27293 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27294 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27295 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27296 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27297 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27298
27299 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27300 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27301 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27302 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27303 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27304 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27305 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27306
27307 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27308 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27309 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27310 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27311 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27312 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27313 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27314 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27315
27316 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27317 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27318 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27319 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27320 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27321 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27322 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27323 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27324 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27325 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27326
27327 @cindex Quaternions
27328 The following rule set, contributed by
27329 @texline Fran\c cois
27330 @infoline Francois
27331 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27332 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27333 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27334 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27335 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27336 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27337 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27338 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27339 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27340 @key{RET}}.
27341
27342 @smallexample
27343 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27344 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27345 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27346 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27347 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27348 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27349 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27350 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27351 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27352 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27353 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27354 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27355 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27356 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27357 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27358 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27359 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27360 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27361 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27362 @end smallexample
27363
27364 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27365 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27366 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27367 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27368 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27369 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27370 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27371
27372 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27373 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27374 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27375 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27376 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27377 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27378
27379 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27380 @chapter Operating on Units
27381
27382 @noindent
27383 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27384 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27385 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27386 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27387 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27388
27389 @menu
27390 * Basic Operations on Units::
27391 * The Units Table::
27392 * Predefined Units::
27393 * User-Defined Units::
27394 @end menu
27395
27396 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27397 @section Basic Operations on Units
27398
27399 @noindent
27400 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27401 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27402 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27403 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27404 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27405 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27406 formula.
27407
27408 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27409 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27410 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27411 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27412 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27413 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27414
27415 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27416 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27417 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27418 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27419 representation of one millimeter.
27420
27421 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27422 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27423 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27424
27425 @kindex u s
27426 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27427 @ignore
27428 @mindex usimpl@idots
27429 @end ignore
27430 @tindex usimplify
27431 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27432 simplifies a units
27433 expression. It uses @kbd{a s} (@code{calc-simplify}) to simplify the
27434 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27435 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27436 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27437 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27438 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27439 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27440 automatically at all times.
27441
27442 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27443 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27444 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27445 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27446 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27447 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27448 applied to units expressions, in which case
27449 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27450 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27451 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27452
27453 @kindex u c
27454 @pindex calc-convert-units
27455 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27456 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27457 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27458 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27459 with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27460 be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27461 the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27462 typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27463 @samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27464
27465 While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27466 approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27467 unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27468 isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27469 @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27470 while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27471 @samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27472
27473 If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27474 number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27475 units are left over. For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27476 produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27477 more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27478 acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27479 ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27480 input units.
27481
27482 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27483 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27484 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27485 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27486 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27487 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27488 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27489 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27490
27491 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27492 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27493 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27494 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27495 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27496 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27497
27498 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27499 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27500 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27501 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27502 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27503 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27504 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27505
27506 @cindex Composite units
27507 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27508 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27509 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27510 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27511 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27512 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27513 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27514 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27515 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27516 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27517 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27518 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27519 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27520
27521 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27522 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27523 to have, then for the new units. Assuming the old and new units you
27524 give are consistent with each other, the result also will not contain
27525 any units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}}
27526 converts the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27527
27528 @kindex u b
27529 @pindex calc-base-units
27530 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27531 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27532 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27533 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27534
27535 The @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u b} commands treat temperature units (like
27536 @samp{degC} and @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example,
27537 @kbd{u c} converts @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10
27538 degrees Celsius corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit.
27539
27540 @kindex u t
27541 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27542 @cindex Temperature conversion
27543 The @kbd{u t} (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command converts
27544 absolute temperatures. The value on the stack must be a simple units
27545 expression with units of temperature only. This command would convert
27546 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the equivalent temperature on the
27547 Fahrenheit scale.
27548
27549 @kindex u r
27550 @pindex calc-remove-units
27551 @kindex u x
27552 @pindex calc-extract-units
27553 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27554 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27555 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27556 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27557 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27558 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27559
27560 @kindex u a
27561 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27562 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27563 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27564 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27565 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27566 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27567 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27568 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27569 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27570 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27571
27572 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27573 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27574 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27575 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27576 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27577 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27578 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27579 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27580 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27581 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27582 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27583 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27584 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27585 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27586 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27587 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27588
27589 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27590 @section The Units Table
27591
27592 @noindent
27593 @kindex u v
27594 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27595 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27596 in another buffer called @code{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27597 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27598 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27599 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27600 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27601 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27602 and steradians.
27603
27604 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27605 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
27606 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
27607 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
27608 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
27609 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
27610
27611 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
27612 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
27613 argument to @kbd{u v}.
27614
27615 @kindex u V
27616 @pindex calc-view-units-table
27617 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
27618 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
27619 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
27620 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
27621 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
27622 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
27623 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
27624
27625 @kindex u g
27626 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
27627 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
27628 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
27629 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
27630 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
27631 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
27632 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
27633 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
27634 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
27635 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
27636
27637 @kindex u e
27638 @pindex calc-explain-units
27639 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
27640 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
27641 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
27642 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
27643 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
27644 column of the Units Table.
27645
27646 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
27647 @section Predefined Units
27648
27649 @noindent
27650 The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
27651 the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
27652 distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
27653 precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
27654 defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
27655 1/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
27656 vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
27657 redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
27658 example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
27659 radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
27660 based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
27661 change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
27662 of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
27663 International Prototype Kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
27664 kept at the Bureau International des Poids et Mesures in S@`evres,
27665 France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
27666 The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
27667 were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
27668 which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
27669 was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
27670 Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
27671 Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
27672
27673 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
27674 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
27675 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
27676 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
27677 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
27678 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
27679 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
27680 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
27681
27682 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
27683 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
27684 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
27685 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
27686 of the various temperature scales.
27687
27688 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
27689 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
27690
27691 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
27692 @tex
27693 for \AA ngstroms.
27694 @end tex
27695 @ifnottex
27696 for Angstroms.
27697 @end ifnottex
27698
27699 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
27700 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
27701 slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
27702 Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
27703 largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
27704 There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
27705 defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
27706 Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
27707 @code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
27708 than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
27709 @code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
27710 all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
27711
27712 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
27713 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
27714 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
27715 preferable to @code{e}.
27716
27717 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
27718 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
27719 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
27720
27721 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
27722 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
27723
27724 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
27725 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
27726
27727 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
27728 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
27729 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
27730 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
27731 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
27732 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
27733 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
27734 units.
27735
27736 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
27737 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
27738 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
27739 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
27740 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
27741 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
27742 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
27743 really is unitless.)
27744
27745 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
27746
27747 @node User-Defined Units, , Predefined Units, Units
27748 @section User-Defined Units
27749
27750 @noindent
27751 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
27752 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
27753
27754 @kindex u 0-9
27755 @pindex calc-quick-units
27756 @vindex Units
27757 @cindex @code{Units} variable
27758 @cindex Quick units
27759 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
27760 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
27761 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
27762 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
27763 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
27764 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
27765 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
27766 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
27767 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
27768 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
27769 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
27770 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
27771
27772 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
27773 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
27774 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
27775 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
27776 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
27777 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27778
27779 @kindex u d
27780 @pindex calc-define-unit
27781 @cindex User-defined units
27782 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
27783 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
27784 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
27785 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
27786 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
27787 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
27788 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
27789 appear in the Units Table.
27790
27791 @kindex u u
27792 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
27793 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
27794 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
27795 however.
27796
27797 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
27798 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
27799 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
27800 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
27801 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
27802
27803 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
27804 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
27805 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
27806 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
27807 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
27808 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
27809 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
27810 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
27811 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
27812
27813 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
27814 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
27815
27816 @kindex u p
27817 @pindex calc-permanent-units
27818 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
27819 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
27820 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
27821 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so that the
27822 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
27823 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
27824 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
27825 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
27826
27827 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
27828 @chapter Storing and Recalling
27829
27830 @noindent
27831 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
27832 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
27833 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
27834 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
27835
27836 @menu
27837 * Storing Variables::
27838 * Recalling Variables::
27839 * Operations on Variables::
27840 * Let Command::
27841 * Evaluates-To Operator::
27842 @end menu
27843
27844 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
27845 @section Storing Variables
27846
27847 @noindent
27848 @kindex s s
27849 @pindex calc-store
27850 @cindex Storing variables
27851 @cindex Quick variables
27852 @vindex q0
27853 @vindex q9
27854 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
27855 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
27856 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
27857 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
27858 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
27859
27860 @kindex s t
27861 @pindex calc-store-into
27862 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
27863 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
27864 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
27865
27866 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
27867 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
27868 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
27869 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
27870 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
27871 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
27872 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
27873 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
27874
27875 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
27876 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
27877 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
27878 righthand sides simultaneously.
27879
27880 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
27881 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
27882 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
27883 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
27884 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
27885 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
27886
27887 @kindex s 0-9
27888 @kindex t 0-9
27889 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
27890 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
27891 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
27892 for trail and time/date commands.)
27893
27894 @kindex s +
27895 @kindex s -
27896 @ignore
27897 @mindex @idots
27898 @end ignore
27899 @kindex s *
27900 @ignore
27901 @mindex @null
27902 @end ignore
27903 @kindex s /
27904 @ignore
27905 @mindex @null
27906 @end ignore
27907 @kindex s ^
27908 @ignore
27909 @mindex @null
27910 @end ignore
27911 @kindex s |
27912 @ignore
27913 @mindex @null
27914 @end ignore
27915 @kindex s n
27916 @ignore
27917 @mindex @null
27918 @end ignore
27919 @kindex s &
27920 @ignore
27921 @mindex @null
27922 @end ignore
27923 @kindex s [
27924 @ignore
27925 @mindex @null
27926 @end ignore
27927 @kindex s ]
27928 @pindex calc-store-plus
27929 @pindex calc-store-minus
27930 @pindex calc-store-times
27931 @pindex calc-store-div
27932 @pindex calc-store-power
27933 @pindex calc-store-concat
27934 @pindex calc-store-neg
27935 @pindex calc-store-inv
27936 @pindex calc-store-decr
27937 @pindex calc-store-incr
27938 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
27939 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
27940 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
27941 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
27942 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
27943 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
27944
27945 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
27946 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
27947 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
27948 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
27949 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
27950 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
27951 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
27952 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
27953 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
27954 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
27955 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
27956 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
27957 forwards and backwards:
27958
27959 @example
27960 @group
27961 s + v := v + a v := a + v
27962 s - v := v - a v := a - v
27963 s * v := v * a v := a * v
27964 s / v := v / a v := a / v
27965 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
27966 s | v := v | a v := a | v
27967 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
27968 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
27969 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
27970 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
27971 @end group
27972 @end example
27973
27974 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
27975 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
27976 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
27977 minus-two minus the variable.
27978
27979 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
27980 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
27981 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
27982
27983 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
27984 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
27985 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
27986 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
27987 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
27988 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
27989 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
27990
27991 @kindex s m
27992 @pindex calc-store-map
27993 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
27994 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
27995 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
27996 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
27997 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
27998 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
27999 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28000 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28001 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28002 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28003 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28004
28005 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28006 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28007 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28008 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28009 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28010 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28011 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28012
28013 @kindex s x
28014 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28015 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28016 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28017 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28018
28019 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28020 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28021 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28022
28023 @kindex s u
28024 @pindex calc-unstore
28025 @cindex Void variables
28026 @cindex Un-storing variables
28027 Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28028 they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28029 they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28030 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28031 void state.
28032
28033 @kindex s c
28034 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28035 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28036 value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28037 @kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28038 that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28039 evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28040 current precision.
28041
28042 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28043 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28044 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28045 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28046 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28047 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28048 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28049 normally void).
28050
28051 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28052 but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28053 precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28054 according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28055 from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28056 magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28057 @kbd{s c}.
28058
28059 @kindex s k
28060 @pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28061 If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28062 it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28063 @kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28064 for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28065 constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28066 you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28067 @code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28068 stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28069 variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28070 original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28071
28072 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28073 @section Recalling Variables
28074
28075 @noindent
28076 @kindex s r
28077 @pindex calc-recall
28078 @cindex Recalling variables
28079 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28080 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28081 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28082 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28083 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28084
28085 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28086 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28087 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28088 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28089 latter will produce an error message.
28090
28091 @kindex r 0-9
28092 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28093 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}. (The @kbd{r} prefix is otherwise unused
28094 in the current version of Calc.)
28095
28096 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28097 @section Other Operations on Variables
28098
28099 @noindent
28100 @kindex s e
28101 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28102 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28103 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28104 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28105 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28106 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28107 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28108 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28109 description of editing.
28110
28111 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28112 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28113 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28114 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28115 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28116 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28117 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28118 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28119 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28120 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28121
28122 @kindex s A
28123 @kindex s D
28124 @ignore
28125 @mindex @idots
28126 @end ignore
28127 @kindex s E
28128 @ignore
28129 @mindex @null
28130 @end ignore
28131 @kindex s F
28132 @ignore
28133 @mindex @null
28134 @end ignore
28135 @kindex s G
28136 @ignore
28137 @mindex @null
28138 @end ignore
28139 @kindex s H
28140 @ignore
28141 @mindex @null
28142 @end ignore
28143 @kindex s I
28144 @ignore
28145 @mindex @null
28146 @end ignore
28147 @kindex s L
28148 @ignore
28149 @mindex @null
28150 @end ignore
28151 @kindex s P
28152 @ignore
28153 @mindex @null
28154 @end ignore
28155 @kindex s R
28156 @ignore
28157 @mindex @null
28158 @end ignore
28159 @kindex s T
28160 @ignore
28161 @mindex @null
28162 @end ignore
28163 @kindex s U
28164 @ignore
28165 @mindex @null
28166 @end ignore
28167 @kindex s X
28168 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28169 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28170 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28171 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28172 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28173 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28174 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28175 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28176 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28177 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28178 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28179 @pindex calc-store-Units
28180 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28181 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28182 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28183
28184 @table @kbd
28185 @item s A
28186 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28187 @item s D
28188 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28189 @item s E
28190 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Default Simplifications}.
28191 @item s F
28192 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28193 @item s G
28194 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28195 @item s H
28196 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28197 @item s I
28198 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28199 @item s L
28200 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28201 @item s P
28202 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28203 @item s R
28204 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28205 @item s T
28206 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28207 @item s U
28208 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28209 @item s X
28210 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28211 @end table
28212
28213 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28214 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28215
28216 @kindex s p
28217 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28218 @cindex Storing variables
28219 @cindex Permanent variables
28220 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28221 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28222 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28223 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}), so
28224 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28225 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28226 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28227 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28228 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28229
28230 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28231 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28232 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28233 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28234 and @code{PlotRejects};
28235 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28236 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28237 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28238 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28239
28240 @kindex s i
28241 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28242 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28243 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28244 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28245 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28246 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28247 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28248 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28249 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28250 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28251 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28252
28253 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28254 @section The Let Command
28255
28256 @noindent
28257 @kindex s l
28258 @pindex calc-let
28259 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28260 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28261 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28262 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28263 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28264 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28265
28266 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28267 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28268 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28269 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28270 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28271 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28272 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28273 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28274 by these commands.
28275
28276 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28277 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28278 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28279
28280 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28281 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28282 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28283
28284 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28285 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
28286 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
28287 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
28288 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
28289 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
28290
28291 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
28292 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
28293
28294 @noindent
28295 @tindex evalto
28296 @tindex =>
28297 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
28298 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
28299 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
28300 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
28301 other language modes like Pascal and La@TeX{}.) This is a binary
28302 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
28303 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
28304
28305 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
28306 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
28307 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
28308 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
28309 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
28310 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
28311
28312 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
28313 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
28314 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
28315
28316 @kindex s =
28317 @pindex calc-evalto
28318 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
28319 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
28320 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
28321 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
28322 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
28323
28324 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
28325 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
28326 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
28327 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
28328 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
28329 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
28330 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
28331 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
28332 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
28333 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
28334 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
28335 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
28336 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
28337 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
28338 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
28339
28340 @kindex m C
28341 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
28342 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
28343 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
28344 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
28345 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
28346 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
28347 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
28348 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
28349
28350 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
28351 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
28352 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
28353 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
28354 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
28355 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
28356 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
28357
28358 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
28359 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
28360 formula @samp{x + y + x} is not handled by Calc's default
28361 simplifications, but the @kbd{a s} command will reduce it to
28362 the simpler form @samp{y + 2 x}. You can also type @kbd{m A}
28363 to enable an Algebraic Simplification mode in which the
28364 equivalent of @kbd{a s} is used on all of Calc's results.
28365 If you enter @samp{x + y + x =>} normally, the result will
28366 be @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x}. If you change to
28367 Algebraic Simplification mode, the result will be
28368 @samp{x + y + x => y + 2 x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a s}
28369 once will have no effect on @samp{x + y + x => x + y + x},
28370 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
28371 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
28372 affected by commands like @kbd{a s}.
28373
28374 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
28375 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
28376 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
28377 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
28378 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
28379 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
28380 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
28381 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
28382 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
28383 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
28384
28385 @smallexample
28386 @group
28387 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
28388 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
28389 . . .
28390
28391 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
28392 @end group
28393 @end smallexample
28394
28395 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
28396 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
28397 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
28398 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
28399 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
28400 side effects.
28401
28402 @kindex s :
28403 @pindex calc-assign
28404 @tindex assign
28405 @tindex :=
28406 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
28407 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
28408 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
28409 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
28410 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
28411 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
28412 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
28413 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
28414 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
28415
28416 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
28417 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
28418 treatment to @samp{=>}.
28419
28420 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
28421 @chapter Graphics
28422
28423 @noindent
28424 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
28425 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
28426 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
28427 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
28428 However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
28429 @samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
28430
28431 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
28432 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
28433 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable
28434 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some Lisp
28435 variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
28436 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are
28437 using the X window system, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
28438 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are not using X,
28439 Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display graphs using simple character
28440 graphics that will work on any terminal.
28441
28442 @menu
28443 * Basic Graphics::
28444 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
28445 * Managing Curves::
28446 * Graphics Options::
28447 * Devices::
28448 @end menu
28449
28450 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
28451 @section Basic Graphics
28452
28453 @noindent
28454 @kindex g f
28455 @pindex calc-graph-fast
28456 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
28457 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
28458 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
28459 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
28460 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
28461 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
28462 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
28463 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
28464 to indicate the points themselves.
28465
28466 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
28467 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
28468 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
28469
28470 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
28471 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
28472 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
28473
28474 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
28475 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
28476 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
28477 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
28478 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
28479 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
28480 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
28481 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
28482 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
28483
28484 @ignore
28485 @starindex
28486 @end ignore
28487 @tindex xy
28488 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
28489 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
28490 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
28491 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
28492 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
28493 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
28494 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
28495 will be a circle.
28496
28497 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
28498 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
28499 variables.
28500
28501 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
28502 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
28503 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
28504 is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
28505 error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
28506 appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
28507 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
28508 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
28509 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
28510
28511 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
28512 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
28513
28514 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
28515 @vindex PlotRejects
28516 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
28517 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
28518 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
28519 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
28520 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
28521 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
28522 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
28523 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
28524 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
28525 @code{PlotRejects}.
28526
28527 @kindex g c
28528 @pindex calc-graph-clear
28529 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
28530 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
28531 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
28532 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
28533 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
28534 window if there is one.
28535
28536 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
28537 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
28538
28539 @kindex g F
28540 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
28541 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
28542 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
28543 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
28544
28545 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
28546 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
28547 are several options for these values.
28548
28549 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
28550 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
28551 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
28552 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
28553 result is a surface plot where
28554 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
28555 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
28556 is the height of the point
28557 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
28558 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
28559 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
28560 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
28561 description of the @samp{set view} command.
28562
28563 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
28564 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
28565
28566 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
28567 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
28568 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
28569 of values from the input vectors.
28570
28571 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
28572 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
28573 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
28574 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
28575 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
28576 3D surface.
28577
28578 @ignore
28579 @starindex
28580 @end ignore
28581 @tindex xyz
28582 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
28583 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
28584 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
28585 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
28586 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
28587 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
28588 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
28589 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
28590 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
28591 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
28592 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
28593 vectors with more than 5 elements.
28594
28595 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
28596 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
28597 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
28598 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
28599 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
28600
28601 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
28602 variables containing the relevant data.
28603
28604 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
28605 @section Managing Curves
28606
28607 @noindent
28608 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
28609 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
28610 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
28611 by using these commands directly.
28612
28613 @kindex g a
28614 @pindex calc-graph-add
28615 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
28616 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
28617 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
28618 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
28619 on the same axes.
28620
28621 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
28622 will cause a special buffer, @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
28623 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
28624 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
28625 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
28626 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
28627 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
28628 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
28629 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
28630 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
28631 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
28632 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
28633 the contents of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28634
28635 @vindex PlotData1
28636 @vindex PlotData2
28637 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
28638 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
28639 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
28640 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
28641 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
28642 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
28643 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
28644 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
28645
28646 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
28647 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
28648 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
28649 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
28650 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
28651 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
28652
28653 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
28654 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
28655 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
28656
28657 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
28658 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
28659 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
28660 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
28661 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
28662 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
28663
28664 For example, to plot
28665 @texline @math{\sin n x}
28666 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
28667 for integers @expr{n}
28668 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
28669 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
28670 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
28671 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
28672 command.
28673
28674 @kindex g A
28675 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
28676 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
28677 to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
28678 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
28679 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
28680 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
28681 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
28682 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
28683 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
28684 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
28685 command to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
28686
28687 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
28688 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
28689 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
28690 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
28691 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
28692 check for this.)
28693
28694 @kindex g d
28695 @pindex calc-graph-delete
28696 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
28697 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
28698 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
28699 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
28700
28701 @kindex g H
28702 @pindex calc-graph-hide
28703 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
28704 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
28705 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
28706 point styles will be retained.
28707
28708 @kindex g j
28709 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
28710 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
28711 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
28712 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
28713 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
28714 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
28715 affect the last curve in the list.
28716
28717 @kindex g p
28718 @pindex calc-graph-plot
28719 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
28720 the graph described in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
28721 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
28722 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
28723 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
28724 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
28725 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
28726 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
28727 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
28728
28729 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
28730 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
28731 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
28732 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
28733 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
28734 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
28735 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
28736
28737 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
28738 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
28739 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
28740 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
28741 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
28742 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
28743 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
28744
28745 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
28746 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
28747 the current graph is three-dimensional.
28748
28749 @kindex g P
28750 @pindex calc-graph-print
28751 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
28752 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
28753 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
28754 or @samp{set output} commands in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
28755 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
28756 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
28757 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
28758 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
28759 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
28760 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
28761 always plot to the printer.
28762
28763 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
28764 @section Graphics Options
28765
28766 @noindent
28767 @kindex g g
28768 @pindex calc-graph-grid
28769 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
28770 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
28771 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
28772 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
28773 changes the setting in @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
28774 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
28775
28776 @kindex g b
28777 @pindex calc-graph-border
28778 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
28779 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
28780 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
28781
28782 @kindex g k
28783 @pindex calc-graph-key
28784 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
28785 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
28786 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
28787 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
28788 curves on the same graph.
28789
28790 @kindex g N
28791 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
28792 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
28793 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
28794 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
28795 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
28796 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
28797 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
28798 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
28799 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
28800 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
28801 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
28802 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
28803 will be computed for the surface.
28804
28805 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
28806 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
28807 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
28808 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
28809 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
28810 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
28811 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
28812 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
28813 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
28814
28815 @kindex g h
28816 @pindex calc-graph-header
28817 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
28818 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
28819 The default title is blank (no title).
28820
28821 @kindex g n
28822 @pindex calc-graph-name
28823 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
28824 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
28825 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
28826 list in the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
28827 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
28828 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
28829 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
28830 not used.
28831
28832 @kindex g t
28833 @kindex g T
28834 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
28835 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
28836 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
28837 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
28838 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
28839 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
28840 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
28841 but you can edit them into the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
28842 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
28843
28844 @kindex g r
28845 @kindex g R
28846 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
28847 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
28848 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
28849 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
28850 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
28851 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
28852 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
28853 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
28854 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
28855 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
28856 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
28857
28858 @kindex g l
28859 @kindex g L
28860 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
28861 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
28862 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
28863 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
28864 be logarithmic instead of linear.
28865
28866 @kindex g C-l
28867 @kindex g C-r
28868 @kindex g C-t
28869 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
28870 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
28871 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
28872 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
28873 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
28874 for the ``z'' axis.
28875
28876 @kindex g z
28877 @kindex g Z
28878 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
28879 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
28880 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
28881 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
28882 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
28883 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
28884 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
28885 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
28886 not available for 3D plots.
28887
28888 @kindex g s
28889 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
28890 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
28891 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
28892 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
28893 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
28894 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
28895 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
28896 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
28897 available for any device.
28898
28899 @kindex g S
28900 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
28901 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
28902 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
28903 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
28904 tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
28905 the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
28906 the error bars on or off.
28907
28908 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
28909 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
28910 @vindex LineStyles
28911 @vindex PointStyles
28912 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
28913 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
28914 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
28915 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
28916 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
28917 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
28918 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
28919 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
28920 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
28921 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
28922
28923 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
28924 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
28925 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
28926 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
28927 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
28928
28929 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
28930 @section Graphical Devices
28931
28932 @noindent
28933 @kindex g D
28934 @pindex calc-graph-device
28935 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
28936 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
28937 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
28938 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
28939 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
28940
28941 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
28942 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
28943 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
28944 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
28945 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
28946 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
28947 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), or otherwise @code{dumb} under
28948 GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0.
28949 This is the initial default value.
28950
28951 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
28952 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
28953 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
28954 to a buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
28955 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
28956 dumb terminals will be
28957 @texline @math{80\times24}
28958 @infoline 80x24
28959 characters. The graph is displayed in
28960 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
28961 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
28962 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
28963
28964 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
28965 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
28966 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
28967 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
28968 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
28969 graph. In the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
28970 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
28971 of the four directions.
28972
28973 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
28974 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
28975 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
28976 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
28977 plot on any text-only printer.
28978
28979 @kindex g O
28980 @pindex calc-graph-output
28981 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of
28982 the output file used by GNUPLOT. For some devices, notably @code{x11},
28983 there is no output file and this information is not used. Many other
28984 ``devices'' are really file formats like @code{postscript}; in these
28985 cases the output in the desired format goes into the file you name
28986 with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write
28987 to its standard output stream, i.e., to @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*}.
28988 This is the default setting.
28989
28990 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
28991 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
28992 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
28993 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
28994 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
28995 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
28996 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
28997 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
28998 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
28999
29000 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29001 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29002 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29003 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29004 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29005 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29006
29007 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29008 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29009 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29010 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29011 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29012 of the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29013
29014 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29015 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29016 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29017 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29018 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29019 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29020 You may wish to configure the default and
29021 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29022 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29023 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29024 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29025 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29026
29027 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29028 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29029 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29030 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29031 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29032 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29033 to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29034 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29035
29036 @kindex g x
29037 @pindex calc-graph-display
29038 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29039 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29040 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29041 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29042
29043 @kindex g X
29044 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29045 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29046 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29047 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29048 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29049 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29050 window in the upper-left corner of the screen.
29051
29052 The buffer called @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29053 session with GNUPLOT. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29054 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29055 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29056 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29057 something has gone wrong.
29058
29059 @kindex g C
29060 @pindex calc-graph-command
29061 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29062 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29063 GNUPLOT process. The @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29064 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29065 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29066
29067 @kindex g v
29068 @kindex g V
29069 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29070 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29071 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29072 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29073 and @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29074 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29075 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29076 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29077 buffer is hidden again.
29078
29079 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29080 @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29081 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29082 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29083 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29084 you have to add them to the @samp{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29085 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29086 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29087 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29088 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29089 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29090 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29091 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29092 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29093 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29094 with @kbd{g p}.
29095
29096 @kindex g q
29097 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29098 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29099 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29100 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29101 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29102 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29103 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29104
29105 @kindex g K
29106 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29107 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29108 except that it also views the @samp{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29109 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29110 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29111
29112 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29113 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29114
29115 @noindent
29116 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29117 other Emacs editing buffers.
29118
29119 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29120 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29121
29122 @menu
29123 * Killing From Stack::
29124 * Yanking Into Stack::
29125 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29126 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29127 * X Cut and Paste::
29128 @end menu
29129
29130 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29131 @section Killing from the Stack
29132
29133 @noindent
29134 @kindex C-k
29135 @pindex calc-kill
29136 @kindex M-k
29137 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29138 @kindex C-w
29139 @pindex calc-kill-region
29140 @kindex M-w
29141 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29142 @cindex Kill ring
29143 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the
29144 ``kill ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y}
29145 command. Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which
29146 kills one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point,
29147 and @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29148 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too. Also,
29149 @kbd{M-k} has been provided to complete the set; it puts the current line
29150 into the kill ring without deleting anything.
29151
29152 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29153 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below the
29154 bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack. Otherwise,
29155 they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. Calc's kill
29156 commands always operate on whole stack entries. (They act the same as their
29157 standard Emacs cousins except they ``round up'' the specified region to
29158 encompass full lines.) The text is copied into the kill ring exactly as
29159 it appears on the screen, including line numbers if they are enabled.
29160
29161 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29162 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29163 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29164 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29165 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29166 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29167 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29168 newline.
29169
29170 @node Yanking Into Stack, Grabbing From Buffers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29171 @section Yanking into the Stack
29172
29173 @noindent
29174 @kindex C-y
29175 @pindex calc-yank
29176 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29177 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29178 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29179 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29180 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29181 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29182 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29183 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29184 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29185 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29186 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29187 difference.)
29188
29189 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29190 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29191
29192 @noindent
29193 @kindex C-x * g
29194 @pindex calc-grab-region
29195 The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29196 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29197 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29198 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29199 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29200 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29201 If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29202 @kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29203
29204 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29205 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29206 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29207 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29208 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29209 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29210 delete given that prefix argument.
29211
29212 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29213 line.
29214
29215 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29216 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29217 @kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29218 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29219 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29220 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29221 vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29222 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29223
29224 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29225 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
29226
29227 @kindex C-x * r
29228 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
29229 The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
29230 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
29231 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
29232 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
29233 whose contents are parsed.
29234
29235 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
29236 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
29237 only if every row contains the same number of values.
29238
29239 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
29240 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
29241 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
29242 is ignored.
29243
29244 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
29245 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
29246 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
29247 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
29248 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
29249 @kbd{C-x * r} command.
29250
29251 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
29252 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
29253 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
29254 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
29255 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
29256 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
29257 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
29258 as @samp{[2*a]}.
29259
29260 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
29261 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
29262 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
29263 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
29264 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
29265
29266 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
29267 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
29268 @texline @math{1\times1}
29269 @infoline 1x1
29270 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
29271
29272 @kindex C-x * :
29273 @kindex C-x * _
29274 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
29275 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
29276 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
29277 The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
29278 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
29279 typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
29280 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
29281 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
29282 in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
29283 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
29284
29285 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
29286 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
29287 the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
29288 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
29289 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
29290
29291 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
29292 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
29293 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
29294 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
29295 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
29296 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
29297
29298 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
29299 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
29300 Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
29301 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
29302 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
29303 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
29304 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
29305
29306 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
29307 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
29308
29309 @noindent
29310 @kindex y
29311 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
29312 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
29313 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
29314 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
29315 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
29316 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
29317 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
29318 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
29319 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
29320
29321 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
29322 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
29323 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
29324 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
29325 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
29326 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
29327 latter strips off the trailing newline.
29328
29329 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
29330 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
29331 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
29332 @kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
29333 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
29334 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
29335 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
29336 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
29337 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
29338 @kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
29339
29340 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
29341 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
29342 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
29343 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
29344 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
29345 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
29346 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
29347 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
29348 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
29349 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
29350 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
29351 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
29352 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
29353 to overwriting one complete number with another.
29354
29355 @kindex C-x * y
29356 The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
29357 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
29358 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
29359
29360 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
29361 @section X Cut and Paste
29362
29363 @noindent
29364 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
29365 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
29366 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
29367
29368 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
29369 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
29370 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
29371 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
29372 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
29373 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
29374 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
29375 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
29376 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
29377 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
29378 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
29379
29380 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
29381 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
29382 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
29383 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
29384 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
29385 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
29386 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
29387 in the Calc window.
29388
29389 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
29390 @chapter Keypad Mode
29391
29392 @noindent
29393 @kindex C-x * k
29394 @pindex calc-keypad
29395 The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
29396 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
29397 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
29398 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
29399 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
29400 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
29401 calculations with the mouse.
29402
29403 @pindex full-calc-keypad
29404 If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
29405 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
29406 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
29407 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
29408 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
29409
29410 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
29411 the @samp{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
29412 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
29413 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
29414
29415 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
29416 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
29417 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
29418
29419 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
29420 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
29421 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
29422 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
29423 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
29424 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
29425 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
29426 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
29427
29428 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
29429 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
29430 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
29431 original buffer.
29432
29433 @menu
29434 * Keypad Main Menu::
29435 * Keypad Functions Menu::
29436 * Keypad Binary Menu::
29437 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
29438 * Keypad Modes Menu::
29439 @end menu
29440
29441 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
29442 @section Main Menu
29443
29444 @smallexample
29445 @group
29446 |----+-----Calc 2.1------+----1
29447 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
29448 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29449 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
29450 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29451 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
29452 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29453 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
29454 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
29455 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
29456 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29457 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
29458 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29459 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
29460 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
29461 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
29462 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
29463 @end group
29464 @end smallexample
29465
29466 @noindent
29467 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
29468 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
29469 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
29470 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
29471
29472 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
29473 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
29474 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
29475 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
29476 or any other function key.
29477
29478 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
29479 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
29480 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
29481 stack.
29482
29483 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
29484 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
29485 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
29486 below and in the following sections.
29487
29488 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
29489 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
29490
29491 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
29492 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
29493 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
29494
29495 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
29496 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
29497 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
29498 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
29499
29500 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
29501 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
29502 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
29503 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
29504 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
29505
29506 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
29507 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
29508 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
29509 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
29510
29511 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
29512 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
29513 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
29514 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
29515
29516 @table @kbd
29517 @item INV +/-
29518 is the same as @key{1/x}.
29519 @item INV +
29520 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
29521 @item INV -
29522 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
29523 @item INV *
29524 is the same as @key{y^x}.
29525 @item INV /
29526 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
29527 @item HYP/INV 1
29528 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
29529 @item HYP/INV 2
29530 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
29531 @item HYP/INV 3
29532 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
29533 @item INV/HYP 4
29534 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
29535 @item INV/HYP 5
29536 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
29537 @item INV 6
29538 is the same as @key{ABS}.
29539 @item INV 7
29540 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
29541 @item INV 8
29542 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
29543 @item INV 9
29544 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
29545 @item INV 0
29546 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
29547 @item INV .
29548 is the same as @key{PREC}.
29549 @item INV ENTER
29550 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
29551 @item HYP ENTER
29552 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
29553 @item INV HYP ENTER
29554 is the same as @key{OVER}.
29555 @item HYP +/-
29556 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
29557 @item HYP EEX
29558 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
29559 @item INV EEX
29560 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
29561 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
29562 by the two limits of the interval.
29563 @end table
29564
29565 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
29566 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
29567 hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
29568 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
29569 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
29570 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
29571
29572 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
29573 @section Functions Menu
29574
29575 @smallexample
29576 @group
29577 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
29578 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
29579 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29580 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
29581 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29582 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
29583 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29584 @end group
29585 @end smallexample
29586
29587 @noindent
29588 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
29589 prefix keys.
29590
29591 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
29592 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
29593
29594 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
29595 extracts the imaginary part.
29596
29597 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
29598 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
29599 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
29600 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
29601 same limit as last time.
29602
29603 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
29604
29605 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
29606 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29607 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
29608
29609 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
29610 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
29611
29612 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
29613 finds the previous prime.
29614
29615 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
29616 @section Binary Menu
29617
29618 @smallexample
29619 @group
29620 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
29621 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
29622 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29623 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
29624 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29625 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
29626 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29627 @end group
29628 @end smallexample
29629
29630 @noindent
29631 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
29632 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
29633 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
29634
29635 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
29636 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
29637
29638 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
29639 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
29640 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
29641 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
29642
29643 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
29644 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
29645 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
29646 The initial word size is 32 bits.
29647
29648 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
29649 @section Vectors Menu
29650
29651 @smallexample
29652 @group
29653 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
29654 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
29655 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29656 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
29657 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29658 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
29659 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29660 @end group
29661 @end smallexample
29662
29663 @noindent
29664 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
29665
29666 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
29667 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
29668 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
29669 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
29670 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
29671 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
29672 rows into a matrix.
29673
29674 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
29675 components separately.
29676
29677 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
29678 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
29679 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
29680 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
29681 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
29682
29683 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
29684 identity matrix.
29685
29686 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
29687
29688 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
29689
29690 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
29691 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
29692
29693 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
29694 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
29695 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
29696 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
29697
29698 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
29699 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
29700 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
29701
29702 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
29703 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
29704 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
29705
29706 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
29707 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
29708 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
29709 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
29710 all the elements of a vector.
29711
29712 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
29713 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
29714 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
29715 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
29716 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
29717 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
29718 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
29719 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
29720 the formula @samp{x^y}.
29721
29722 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
29723 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
29724 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
29725 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
29726 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
29727 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
29728 @expr{t}, respectively.
29729
29730 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
29731 @section Modes Menu
29732
29733 @smallexample
29734 @group
29735 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
29736 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
29737 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29738 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
29739 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29740 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
29741 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
29742 @end group
29743 @end smallexample
29744
29745 @noindent
29746 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
29747
29748 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
29749 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
29750 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
29751 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
29752 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
29753
29754 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
29755 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
29756 well as to the left.
29757
29758 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
29759 for trigonometric functions.
29760
29761 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
29762 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
29763 fractional or floating-point results.
29764
29765 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
29766 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
29767
29768 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
29769 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
29770 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
29771
29772 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
29773 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
29774
29775 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
29776 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
29777 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
29778 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
29779
29780 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
29781 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
29782 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
29783 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
29784 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
29785
29786 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
29787 @chapter Embedded Mode
29788
29789 @noindent
29790 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
29791 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
29792 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
29793 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
29794
29795 @menu
29796 * Basic Embedded Mode::
29797 * More About Embedded Mode::
29798 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
29799 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
29800 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
29801 @end menu
29802
29803 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
29804 @section Basic Embedded Mode
29805
29806 @noindent
29807 @kindex C-x * e
29808 @pindex calc-embedded
29809 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
29810 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
29811 Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
29812 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
29813 are visiting your own files.
29814
29815 Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
29816 of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
29817 in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to La@TeX{}.
29818 Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
29819 @code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
29820 @code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
29821 @code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
29822 and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29823 These can be overridden with Calc's mode
29824 changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
29825 suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
29826
29827 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
29828 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
29829 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
29830 understands are:
29831
29832 @enumerate
29833 @item
29834 The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
29835 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
29836 @item
29837 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
29838 @item
29839 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
29840 @item
29841 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
29842 @item
29843 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
29844 @end enumerate
29845
29846 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
29847 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
29848 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
29849
29850 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
29851 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
29852 that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
29853 line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
29854
29855 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
29856 by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
29857 argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
29858
29859 @kindex C-x * w
29860 @pindex calc-embedded-word
29861 The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
29862 mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
29863 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
29864 sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
29865 backward to delimit the formula.
29866
29867 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
29868 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
29869 Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
29870 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
29871 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
29872 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
29873 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
29874 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
29875 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
29876 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
29877 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
29878
29879 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
29880 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
29881 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
29882 an algebraic entry.
29883
29884 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
29885 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
29886 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
29887 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
29888 not affected by Embedded mode.
29889
29890 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
29891 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
29892 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
29893 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
29894 find you need to see the entire stack.
29895
29896 For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
29897 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
29898 inequality:
29899
29900 @example
29901 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
29902 @end example
29903
29904 @noindent
29905 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
29906 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
29907 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
29908 to match Calc's usual display style:
29909
29910 @example
29911 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
29912 @end example
29913
29914 @noindent
29915 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
29916 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
29917 Embedded mode.
29918
29919 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
29920 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
29921 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
29922 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
29923 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
29924 needs to be commuted.
29925
29926 @example
29927 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
29928 @end example
29929
29930 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
29931 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
29932 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
29933 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
29934
29935 @example
29936 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
29937 @end example
29938
29939 @noindent
29940 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
29941 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
29942 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
29943 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
29944 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
29945 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
29946 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
29947
29948 Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
29949 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
29950 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
29951 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
29952 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
29953 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
29954 Embedded mode is concerned.
29955
29956 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
29957 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
29958 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
29959 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
29960 press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
29961 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
29962 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
29963 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
29964 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
29965 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
29966
29967 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
29968 @section More About Embedded Mode
29969
29970 @noindent
29971 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
29972 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
29973 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
29974 written. If the formula contains any La@TeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
29975 it is parsed (i.e., read) in La@TeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
29976 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
29977 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
29978
29979 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
29980 the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a La@TeX{} formula when
29981 not in La@TeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
29982 whatever language mode is in effect.
29983
29984 @tex
29985 \bigskip
29986 @end tex
29987
29988 @kindex d p
29989 @pindex calc-show-plain
29990 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
29991 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
29992 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
29993 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
29994 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
29995 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
29996 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
29997 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
29998 version.
29999
30000 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30001 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30002 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and La@TeX{}, so if your formula is
30003 embedded in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} document its plain version will be
30004 invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30005 delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30006 in a comment for those modes, also.
30007 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30008 formula delimiters.
30009
30010 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30011 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30012 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30013 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30014 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30015 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30016 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30017 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30018
30019 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30020 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30021 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30022 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30023 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30024 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30025
30026 @tex
30027 \bigskip
30028 @end tex
30029
30030 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30031 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30032 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30033 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30034 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30035 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30036 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30037 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30038 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30039 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30040 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30041 ``plain'' mode.
30042
30043 @tex
30044 \bigskip
30045 @end tex
30046
30047 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30048 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30049 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30050 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30051 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30052
30053 @smallexample
30054 The derivative of
30055
30056 ln(ln(x))
30057
30058 is
30059
30060 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30061
30062 whose value at x = 2 is
30063
30064 @r{(the value)}
30065
30066 and at x = 3 is
30067
30068 @r{(the value)}
30069 @end smallexample
30070
30071 @kindex C-x * d
30072 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30073 The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30074 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30075 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30076 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30077 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30078
30079 For this example, you would start with just
30080
30081 @smallexample
30082 The derivative of
30083
30084 ln(ln(x))
30085 @end smallexample
30086
30087 @noindent
30088 and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30089 is
30090
30091 @smallexample
30092 The derivative of
30093
30094 ln(ln(x))
30095
30096
30097 ln(ln(x))
30098 @end smallexample
30099
30100 @noindent
30101 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30102 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30103 @kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30104 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30105 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30106 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30107
30108 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30109 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30110 various formulas and numbers.
30111
30112 @tex
30113 \bigskip
30114 @end tex
30115
30116 @kindex C-x * f
30117 @kindex C-x * '
30118 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30119 The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30120 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30121 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30122 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30123 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30124 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30125 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30126 @kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30127
30128 @kindex C-x * n
30129 @kindex C-x * p
30130 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30131 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30132 The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30133 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30134 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30135 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30136 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30137 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30138 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30139 @kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30140 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30141 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30142 formula, they just move the cursor.
30143
30144 @kindex C-x * `
30145 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30146 The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30147 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30148 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30149 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30150
30151 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30152 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30153
30154 @noindent
30155 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30156 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30157 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30158 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30159
30160 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30161
30162 @example
30163 foo := 5
30164 @end example
30165
30166 @noindent
30167 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30168 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30169 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30170 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30171 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30172
30173 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30174 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30175 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30176 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30177 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30178
30179 @example
30180 foo + 7 => 12
30181 @end example
30182
30183 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30184
30185 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30186 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30187
30188 @example
30189 foo := 17
30190
30191 foo + 7 => 24
30192 @end example
30193
30194 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30195 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30196 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30197 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30198 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30199
30200 @example
30201 17
30202
30203 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30204 @end example
30205
30206 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30207 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30208 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30209 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30210
30211 @kindex C-x * j
30212 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30213 The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30214 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30215 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30216 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30217 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30218 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30219
30220 @example
30221 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30222 @end example
30223
30224 @noindent
30225 in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
30226
30227 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
30228 mode.
30229
30230 @kindex C-x * u
30231 @pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
30232 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
30233 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
30234 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
30235 the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
30236 command is a convenient way to do this.
30237
30238 @example
30239 foo := 6
30240
30241 foo + 7 => 13
30242 @end example
30243
30244 Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
30245 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
30246 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
30247 not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
30248 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
30249 that formula will not be disturbed.
30250
30251 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
30252 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
30253 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
30254 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
30255 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
30256
30257 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
30258 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
30259
30260 @kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
30261 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
30262 file.
30263
30264 @kindex C-x * a
30265 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
30266 The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
30267 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
30268 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
30269 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
30270 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
30271 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
30272 changed.
30273
30274 It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
30275 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
30276 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
30277 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
30278 a few lines that look like this:
30279
30280 @example
30281 --- Local Variables: ---
30282 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
30283 --- End: ---
30284 @end example
30285
30286 @noindent
30287 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
30288 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
30289 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or La@TeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
30290 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
30291 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
30292 trailing strings.
30293
30294 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
30295 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
30296 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
30297 @kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
30298 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
30299 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
30300 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
30301 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
30302 Emacs manual}.
30303
30304 Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
30305 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
30306 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
30307 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
30308 saved.
30309
30310 Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
30311 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
30312 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
30313 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
30314 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
30315 @kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
30316
30317 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
30318 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
30319 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
30320 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
30321 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
30322 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
30323 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
30324 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
30325 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
30326 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
30327 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
30328 used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
30329 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
30330 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
30331 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
30332
30333 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
30334 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
30335 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
30336 following assignment is used.
30337
30338 @example
30339 x => 1
30340
30341 x := 1
30342
30343 x => 1
30344
30345 x := 2
30346
30347 x => 2
30348 @end example
30349
30350 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
30351 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
30352 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
30353 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
30354 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
30355 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
30356
30357 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
30358 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
30359 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
30360 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
30361 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
30362 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
30363 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
30364
30365 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
30366 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
30367 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
30368 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
30369 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
30370 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
30371 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
30372 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
30373 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
30374 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
30375 use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
30376
30377 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30378 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
30379
30380 @kindex m e
30381 @pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
30382 @noindent
30383 The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
30384 by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
30385 is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
30386 @code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
30387 (@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
30388 will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
30389
30390 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
30391 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
30392 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
30393 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
30394 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
30395 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
30396
30397 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
30398 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
30399 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
30400 delimiter of the formula.
30401
30402 @example
30403 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
30404 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30405 @end example
30406
30407 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
30408 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
30409 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
30410 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
30411 the file, or up to a line of the form
30412
30413 @example
30414 % [calc-defaults]
30415 @end example
30416
30417 @noindent
30418 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
30419 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
30420 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
30421
30422 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
30423 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
30424 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
30425 below).
30426
30427 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
30428 square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
30429 characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
30430 mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
30431 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
30432 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
30433 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
30434 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
30435 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
30436
30437 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
30438 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
30439 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
30440 one.
30441
30442 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
30443 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
30444 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
30445 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
30446 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
30447 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
30448 sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
30449 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
30450 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
30451
30452 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
30453 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
30454 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
30455 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
30456 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
30457 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
30458
30459 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
30460 that look like this, respectively:
30461
30462 @example
30463 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30464 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
30465 @end example
30466
30467 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
30468 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
30469 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
30470 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
30471 yet, is not relevant here.)
30472
30473 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
30474 of the file:
30475
30476 @example
30477 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
30478 @end example
30479
30480 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
30481 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
30482 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
30483 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
30484 formulas in the file.
30485
30486 Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
30487 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
30488 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
30489 a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
30490 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
30491
30492 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
30493 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
30494 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
30495 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
30496 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
30497 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
30498
30499 @example
30500 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
30501 1.23e2
30502
30503 456.
30504 @end example
30505
30506 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
30507 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
30508
30509 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
30510 which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
30511 (@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
30512 settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
30513 by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el})
30514 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
30515 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
30516 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
30517 annotations at all.
30518
30519 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
30520 for @code{Save} have no effect.
30521
30522 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30523 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
30524
30525 @noindent
30526 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
30527 variables described here. These variables are customizable
30528 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
30529 or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
30530 (Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
30531 the end of the file;
30532 @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
30533 Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
30534 major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30535
30536 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
30537 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
30538 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
30539 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
30540 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
30541 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
30542 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
30543 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
30544 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
30545 in detail.
30546
30547 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
30548 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
30549 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
30550 Lisp program.
30551
30552 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
30553 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
30554 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
30555 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
30556 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
30557 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
30558 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
30559 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
30560
30561 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
30562 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
30563 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
30564 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
30565 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
30566 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
30567
30568 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
30569 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
30570 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
30571 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
30572 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
30573 one or two dollar signs.
30574
30575 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
30576 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
30577 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
30578
30579 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
30580 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
30581 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
30582 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
30583 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
30584 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
30585 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
30586
30587 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
30588 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
30589 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
30590 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
30591 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
30592 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
30593 account for each of these six backslashes!)
30594
30595 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
30596 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
30597 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
30598 regular expression to match the above example would be
30599 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
30600 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
30601 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
30602 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
30603 case).
30604
30605 @vindex calc-embedded-open-word
30606 @vindex calc-embedded-close-word
30607 The @code{calc-embedded-open-word} and @code{calc-embedded-close-word}
30608 variables are similar expressions used when you type @kbd{C-x * w}
30609 instead of @kbd{C-x * e} to enable Embedded mode.
30610
30611 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
30612 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
30613 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
30614 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
30615 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
30616 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
30617 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
30618 be different for certain major modes.
30619
30620 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
30621 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
30622 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
30623 different for different major modes. Without
30624 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
30625 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
30626
30627 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
30628 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
30629 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
30630 @kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
30631 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
30632 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
30633 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
30634 the file.
30635
30636 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
30637 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
30638 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
30639 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
30640 @w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
30641 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
30642 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
30643
30644 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
30645 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
30646 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
30647 The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
30648 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
30649 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
30650 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
30651 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
30652 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
30653 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
30654 different for different major modes.
30655 This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
30656 lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
30657 make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
30658 formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
30659
30660 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
30661 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
30662 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
30663 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
30664 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
30665 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
30666 The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
30667 modes.
30668
30669 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
30670 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
30671 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
30672 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
30673 major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
30674 newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
30675
30676 @node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
30677 @chapter Programming
30678
30679 @noindent
30680 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
30681 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
30682
30683 @enumerate
30684 @item
30685 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
30686 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
30687 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
30688 as loops and conditionals.
30689
30690 @item
30691 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
30692 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
30693 as an interactive command.
30694
30695 @item
30696 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
30697 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
30698 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
30699 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
30700 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
30701
30702 @item
30703 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
30704 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
30705 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
30706 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
30707 rewrite rules.
30708 @end enumerate
30709
30710 @kindex z
30711 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
30712 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
30713 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
30714 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
30715 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
30716 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
30717 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
30718
30719 @menu
30720 * Creating User Keys::
30721 * Keyboard Macros::
30722 * Invocation Macros::
30723 * Algebraic Definitions::
30724 * Lisp Definitions::
30725 @end menu
30726
30727 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
30728 @section Creating User Keys
30729
30730 @noindent
30731 @kindex Z D
30732 @pindex calc-user-define
30733 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
30734 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
30735 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
30736
30737 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
30738 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
30739 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
30740 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
30741 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
30742 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
30743 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
30744 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
30745
30746 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
30747 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
30748
30749 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
30750 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
30751 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
30752
30753 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
30754 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
30755 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
30756 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
30757 of a letter if you wish.
30758
30759 @kindex Z U
30760 @pindex calc-user-undefine
30761 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
30762 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
30763 key we defined above.
30764
30765 @kindex Z P
30766 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
30767 @cindex Storing user definitions
30768 @cindex Permanent user definitions
30769 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
30770 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
30771 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
30772 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
30773 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
30774 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.calc.el}.) For example,
30775 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
30776 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
30777 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
30778 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
30779
30780 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
30781 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
30782 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
30783 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
30784 command will save all of these definitions.
30785 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
30786 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
30787 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
30788 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
30789 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
30790 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
30791 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
30792 or key bindings associated with the function.)
30793
30794 @kindex Z E
30795 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
30796 @cindex Editing user definitions
30797 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
30798 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
30799 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
30800 following sections.
30801
30802 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
30803 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
30804
30805 @noindent
30806 @kindex X
30807 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
30808 @cindex Keyboard macros
30809 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
30810 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
30811 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
30812 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
30813 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
30814 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
30815 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
30816 information.
30817
30818 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
30819 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
30820 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
30821 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
30822 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
30823 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
30824 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
30825 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
30826 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
30827 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
30828 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
30829 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
30830 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
30831
30832 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
30833 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
30834 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
30835 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
30836
30837 @menu
30838 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
30839 * Conditionals in Macros::
30840 * Loops in Macros::
30841 * Local Values in Macros::
30842 * Queries in Macros::
30843 @end menu
30844
30845 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
30846 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
30847
30848 @noindent
30849 @kindex Z K
30850 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
30851 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
30852 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
30853 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
30854 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
30855 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
30856 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
30857 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
30858 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
30859 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
30860 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
30861 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
30862 descriptive command name if you wish.
30863
30864 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
30865 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
30866 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
30867 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
30868
30869 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
30870 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
30871
30872 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
30873 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
30874 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
30875 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
30876 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
30877 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
30878 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
30879 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
30880 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
30881 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
30882 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
30883 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
30884 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
30885 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
30886 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
30887
30888 @kindex C-x * m
30889 @pindex read-kbd-macro
30890 The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
30891 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
30892 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
30893 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
30894
30895 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
30896 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
30897
30898 @noindent
30899 @kindex Z [
30900 @kindex Z ]
30901 @pindex calc-kbd-if
30902 @pindex calc-kbd-else
30903 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
30904 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
30905 @cindex Conditional structures
30906 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
30907 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
30908 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
30909 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
30910 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
30911 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
30912 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
30913
30914 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
30915 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
30916 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
30917 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
30918 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
30919 command is skipped.
30920
30921 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
30922 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
30923 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
30924 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
30925 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
30926 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
30927
30928 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
30929 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
30930
30931 @kindex Z :
30932 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
30933 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
30934 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
30935 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
30936 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
30937 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
30938 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
30939
30940 @kindex Z |
30941 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
30942 between any number of alternatives. For example,
30943 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
30944 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
30945 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
30946 it will execute @var{part3}.
30947
30948 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
30949 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
30950 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
30951 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
30952 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
30953 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
30954 does not.
30955
30956 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
30957 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
30958 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
30959 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
30960 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
30961 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
30962 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
30963 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
30964 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
30965
30966 @kindex Z C-g
30967 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
30968 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
30969 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
30970
30971 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
30972 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
30973
30974 @noindent
30975 @kindex Z <
30976 @kindex Z >
30977 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
30978 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
30979 @cindex Looping structures
30980 @cindex Iterative structures
30981 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
30982 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
30983 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
30984 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
30985 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
30986 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
30987 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
30988 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
30989 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
30990
30991 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
30992 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
30993 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
30994 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
30995 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
30996 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
30997 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
30998 in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
30999 macro.
31000
31001 @kindex Z /
31002 @pindex calc-break
31003 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31004 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31005 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31006 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31007 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31008 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31009 in the C language.
31010
31011 @kindex Z (
31012 @kindex Z )
31013 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31014 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31015 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31016 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31017 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31018 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31019 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31020 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31021 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31022 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31023 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31024
31025 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31026 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31027 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31028 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31029 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31030 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31031 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31032
31033 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31034 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31035 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31036 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31037 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31038 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31039
31040 @kindex Z @{
31041 @kindex Z @}
31042 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31043 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31044 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31045 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31046 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31047 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31048 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31049 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31050 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31051 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31052 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31053 this feature.)
31054
31055 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31056 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31057 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31058 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31059 as easily as in a macro definition.
31060
31061 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31062 conditional and looping commands.
31063
31064 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31065 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31066
31067 @noindent
31068 @cindex Local variables
31069 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31070 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31071 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31072 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31073 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31074 modes.
31075
31076 @kindex Z `
31077 @kindex Z '
31078 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31079 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31080 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31081 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31082 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31083 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31084
31085 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31086 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31087 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31088 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31089 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31090
31091 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31092 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31093 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31094 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31095 in exceptional conditions.
31096
31097 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31098 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31099 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31100 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31101 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31102 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31103 macros were involved.
31104
31105 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31106 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31107 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31108 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31109 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31110 thereof) are also saved.
31111
31112 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31113 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31114 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31115 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31116 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31117
31118 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31119 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31120 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31121 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31122 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31123 outside the construct.
31124
31125 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31126 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31127 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31128
31129 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31130 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31131
31132 @c @noindent
31133 @c @kindex Z =
31134 @c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31135 @c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31136 @c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31137 @c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31138 @c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31139 @c to turn such messages off.
31140
31141 @noindent
31142 @kindex Z #
31143 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31144 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31145 entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31146 execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31147 use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31148 taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31149 before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31150 pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31151 the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31152 prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31153 subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31154 accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31155
31156 As an example,
31157 @kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31158 input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31159 power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31160 will not be part of the macro.)
31161
31162 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31163 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31164 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31165 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31166 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31167 return control to the keyboard macro.
31168
31169 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31170 @section Invocation Macros
31171
31172 @kindex C-x * z
31173 @kindex Z I
31174 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31175 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31176 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31177 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31178 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31179 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31180 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31181 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31182 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31183 @kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31184
31185 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31186 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31187 by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31188 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31189 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31190 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31191
31192 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31193 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31194 do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31195 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31196 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31197
31198 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31199 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31200 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31201
31202 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31203 @section Programming with Formulas
31204
31205 @noindent
31206 @kindex Z F
31207 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31208 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31209 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31210 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31211 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31212 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31213 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31214 non-numeric arguments.
31215
31216 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31217 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31218 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31219 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31220 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31221 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31222 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31223
31224 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31225 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31226 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
31227 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
31228
31229 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
31230 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
31231 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
31232 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
31233 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
31234 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
31235 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
31236 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
31237 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
31238
31239 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
31240 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
31241 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
31242 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
31243 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
31244 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
31245 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
31246 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
31247 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
31248 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
31249 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
31250 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
31251
31252 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
31253 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
31254 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
31255 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
31256 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
31257 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
31258 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
31259
31260 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
31261 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
31262 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
31263 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
31264
31265 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
31266 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
31267 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
31268 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
31269 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
31270 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
31271 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
31272 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
31273 question.
31274
31275 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
31276 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
31277 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
31278 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
31279
31280 @kindex Z G
31281 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
31282 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
31283 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
31284 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
31285 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
31286 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
31287 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
31288 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
31289
31290 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31291 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
31292 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
31293 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
31294 @kbd{C-x k} to
31295 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
31296 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
31297 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
31298 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
31299
31300 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
31301 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
31302 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
31303
31304 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
31305 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
31306 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
31307 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
31308 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
31309 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
31310 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
31311 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
31312 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
31313
31314 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
31315 @section Programming with Lisp
31316
31317 @noindent
31318 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
31319 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
31320 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
31321 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
31322 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
31323 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
31324 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
31325 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
31326 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
31327
31328 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
31329 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
31330 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
31331 to program the Calculator.
31332
31333 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
31334 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
31335 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
31336 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
31337 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
31338
31339 @menu
31340 * Defining Functions::
31341 * Defining Simple Commands::
31342 * Defining Stack Commands::
31343 * Argument Qualifiers::
31344 * Example Definitions::
31345
31346 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
31347 * Internals::
31348 @end menu
31349
31350 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
31351 @subsection Defining New Functions
31352
31353 @noindent
31354 @findex defmath
31355 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
31356 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
31357 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
31358 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
31359 example,
31360
31361 @example
31362 (defmath myfact (n)
31363 (if (> n 0)
31364 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31365 1))
31366 @end example
31367
31368 @noindent
31369 This actually expands to the code,
31370
31371 @example
31372 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31373 (if (math-posp n)
31374 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31375 1))
31376 @end example
31377
31378 @noindent
31379 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
31380
31381 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
31382 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
31383 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
31384 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
31385
31386 @smallexample
31387 (defmath myfact (n)
31388 (if (> n 0)
31389 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31390 (if (= n 0)
31391 1
31392 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
31393 @end smallexample
31394
31395 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
31396 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
31397 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
31398 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
31399 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
31400 efficiently as possible.
31401
31402 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
31403 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
31404 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
31405 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
31406 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
31407 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
31408
31409 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
31410 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
31411 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
31412 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
31413 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
31414 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
31415 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
31416
31417 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
31418 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
31419 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
31420 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
31421 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
31422
31423 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
31424
31425 @itemize @bullet
31426 @item
31427 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
31428 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
31429 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
31430 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
31431 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
31432
31433 @item
31434 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
31435 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
31436 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
31437 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
31438 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
31439 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
31440 into one element of a matrix.
31441
31442 @item
31443 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
31444 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
31445 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
31446 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
31447 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
31448 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
31449 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
31450 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
31451 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
31452 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
31453 things, not just two.
31454
31455 @item
31456 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
31457 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
31458 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
31459 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
31460 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
31461
31462 @item
31463 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
31464 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
31465 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
31466 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
31467
31468 @item
31469 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
31470 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
31471 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
31472 inside the body of the function.
31473 @end itemize
31474
31475 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
31476 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
31477 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
31478 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
31479 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
31480
31481 @smallexample
31482 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
31483 (and (numberp x)
31484 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
31485 @end smallexample
31486
31487 expands to
31488
31489 @smallexample
31490 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
31491 (and (math-numberp x)
31492 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
31493 @end smallexample
31494
31495 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
31496 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
31497 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
31498 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
31499 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
31500
31501 @example
31502 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
31503 @end example
31504
31505 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
31506 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
31507 @file{~/.calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
31508 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
31509 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
31510 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
31511 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
31512 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
31513 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
31514 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
31515 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
31516
31517 @example
31518 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
31519 (defmath ... )
31520 (defmath ... )
31521 ))
31522 @end example
31523
31524 @noindent
31525 @vindex calc-define
31526 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
31527 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
31528 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
31529 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
31530 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
31531 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
31532 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
31533 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
31534 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
31535
31536 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
31537 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
31538 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
31539 after Calc itself is loaded.
31540
31541 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
31542 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
31543 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
31544 that the @samp{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
31545
31546 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
31547 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
31548 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
31549 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
31550 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
31551 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
31552 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
31553 protect against this situation, you can put
31554
31555 @example
31556 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31557 @end example
31558
31559 @findex calc-check-defines
31560 @noindent
31561 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
31562 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
31563 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
31564 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
31565
31566 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
31567 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
31568 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
31569 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
31570
31571 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
31572 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
31573
31574 @noindent
31575 @findex interactive
31576 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
31577 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
31578 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
31579 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
31580 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
31581 the command work in the Calc environment.
31582
31583 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
31584 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
31585
31586 @smallexample
31587 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31588 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
31589 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
31590 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31591 @end smallexample
31592
31593 This expands to the pair of definitions,
31594
31595 @smallexample
31596 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
31597 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31598 (interactive "p")
31599 (calc-wrapper
31600 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
31601
31602 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
31603 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31604 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
31605 @end smallexample
31606
31607 @noindent
31608 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
31609 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
31610 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
31611 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
31612
31613 @findex calc-wrapper
31614 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
31615 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
31616
31617 @smallexample
31618 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
31619 (unwind-protect
31620 (save-excursion
31621 (calc-select-buffer)
31622 @emph{body of function}
31623 @emph{renumber stack}
31624 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
31625 @emph{realign cursor and window}
31626 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
31627 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
31628 @end smallexample
31629
31630 @findex calc-select-buffer
31631 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @samp{*Calculator*}
31632 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
31633 the @samp{*Calc Trail*} window.
31634
31635 @findex calc-set-command-flag
31636 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
31637 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
31638 following command flags:
31639
31640 @table @code
31641 @item renum-stack
31642 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
31643 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
31644 @code{calc-push}.
31645
31646 @item clear-message
31647 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
31648 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
31649
31650 @item no-align
31651 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
31652
31653 @item position-point
31654 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
31655 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
31656 this command finishes.
31657
31658 @item keep-flags
31659 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
31660 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
31661
31662 @item do-edit
31663 Switch to buffer @samp{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
31664
31665 @item hold-trail
31666 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
31667 there.
31668 @end table
31669
31670 @kindex Y
31671 @kindex Y ?
31672 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
31673 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
31674 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
31675 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
31676 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
31677 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
31678 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
31679 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
31680 future versions of Calc.
31681
31682 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
31683 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
31684 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
31685 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
31686 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
31687 within your package.
31688
31689 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
31690 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
31691 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
31692 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
31693 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
31694 if necessary without having to modify the file.
31695
31696 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
31697 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
31698 decreases the precision.
31699
31700 @smallexample
31701 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
31702 ;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
31703
31704 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
31705 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
31706
31707 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
31708
31709 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
31710 'increase-precision)
31711 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
31712 'decrease-precision)
31713
31714 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
31715 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
31716 calc-Y-help-msgs))
31717
31718 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
31719 "Increase precision by DELTA."
31720 (interactive "p")
31721 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
31722
31723 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
31724 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
31725 (interactive "p")
31726 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
31727
31728 )) ; end of calc-define property
31729
31730 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
31731 @end smallexample
31732
31733 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
31734 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
31735
31736 @noindent
31737 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
31738 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
31739
31740 @example
31741 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
31742 @end example
31743
31744 @noindent
31745 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
31746 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
31747 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
31748 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
31749 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
31750 parameters is valid.
31751
31752 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
31753 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
31754 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
31755 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
31756 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
31757 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
31758
31759 As an example, the definition
31760
31761 @smallexample
31762 (defmath myfact (n)
31763 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31764 (interactive 1 "fact")
31765 (if (> n 0)
31766 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
31767 (and (= n 0) 1)))
31768 @end smallexample
31769
31770 @noindent
31771 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
31772 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
31773
31774 @smallexample
31775 (defun calc-myfact ()
31776 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31777 (interactive)
31778 (calc-slow-wrapper
31779 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
31780 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
31781
31782 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
31783 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
31784 (if (math-posp n)
31785 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
31786 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
31787 @end smallexample
31788
31789 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
31790 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
31791 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
31792 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
31793 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
31794
31795 @findex calc-top-list-n
31796 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
31797 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
31798 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
31799 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
31800
31801 @findex calc-enter-result
31802 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
31803 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
31804 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
31805 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
31806 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
31807 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
31808
31809 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
31810 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
31811 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
31812 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
31813 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
31814
31815 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
31816 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
31817 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
31818
31819 @example
31820 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
31821 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
31822 @var{body})
31823 @end example
31824
31825 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
31826 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
31827 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
31828
31829 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
31830 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
31831 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
31832 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
31833 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
31834
31835 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
31836 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
31837
31838 @noindent
31839 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
31840 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
31841
31842 @example
31843 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
31844 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
31845 &rest @var{param})
31846 @var{body})
31847 @end example
31848
31849 @noindent
31850 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
31851
31852 @example
31853 (@var{qual} @var{param})
31854 @end example
31855
31856 The following qualifiers are recognized:
31857
31858 @table @samp
31859 @item complete
31860 @findex complete
31861 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
31862 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
31863 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
31864 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
31865
31866 @item integer
31867 @findex integer
31868 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
31869 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
31870 formulas are rejected.
31871
31872 @item natnum
31873 @findex natnum
31874 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
31875
31876 @item fixnum
31877 @findex fixnum
31878 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
31879 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
31880 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
31881
31882 @item float
31883 @findex float
31884 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
31885 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
31886 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
31887
31888 @item @var{pred}
31889 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
31890 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
31891
31892 @item not-@var{pred}
31893 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
31894 @end table
31895
31896 For example,
31897
31898 @example
31899 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
31900 &rest (integer d))
31901 @var{body})
31902 @end example
31903
31904 @noindent
31905 expands to
31906
31907 @example
31908 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
31909 (and (math-matrixp b)
31910 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
31911 (or (math-constp b)
31912 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
31913 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
31914 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
31915 @var{body})
31916 @end example
31917
31918 @noindent
31919 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
31920 body of the function.
31921
31922 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
31923 @subsection Example Definitions
31924
31925 @noindent
31926 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
31927 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
31928 @pxref{Internals}.
31929
31930 @menu
31931 * Bit Counting Example::
31932 * Sine Example::
31933 @end menu
31934
31935 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
31936 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
31937
31938 @noindent
31939 @ignore
31940 @starindex
31941 @end ignore
31942 @tindex bcount
31943 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
31944 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
31945 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
31946 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
31947 create an intermediate set.
31948
31949 @smallexample
31950 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
31951 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
31952 (let ((count 0))
31953 (while (> n 0)
31954 (if (oddp n)
31955 (setq count (1+ count)))
31956 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
31957 count))
31958 @end smallexample
31959
31960 @noindent
31961 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
31962 Emacs Lisp function:
31963
31964 @smallexample
31965 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
31966 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
31967 (let ((count 0))
31968 (while (math-posp n)
31969 (if (math-oddp n)
31970 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
31971 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
31972 count))
31973 @end smallexample
31974
31975 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
31976 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
31977 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
31978 involve actual division.
31979
31980 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
31981 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
31982 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
31983 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
31984 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
31985
31986 @smallexample
31987 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
31988 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
31989 (let ((count 0))
31990 (while (not (fixnump n))
31991 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
31992 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
31993 n (car qr))))
31994 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
31995
31996 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
31997 (let ((count 0))
31998 (while (> n 0)
31999 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32000 n (lsh n -1)))
32001 count))
32002 @end smallexample
32003
32004 @noindent
32005 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32006 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32007 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32008 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32009 uses.
32010
32011 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32012 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32013 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32014 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32015 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32016 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32017 same thing with a single division by 512.
32018
32019 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32020 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32021
32022 @noindent
32023 @ignore
32024 @starindex
32025 @end ignore
32026 @tindex mysin
32027 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32028 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32029 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32030 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32031
32032 @smallexample
32033 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32034 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32035 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32036 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32037 newsum
32038 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32039 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32040 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32041 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32042 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32043 x (* x xnegsqr)
32044 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32045 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32046 (break)) ; then we are done.
32047 (setq sum newsum))
32048 sum))
32049 @end smallexample
32050
32051 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32052 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32053 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32054 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32055 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32056 by a separate algorithm.
32057
32058 @smallexample
32059 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32060 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32061 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32062 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32063 (cond ((complexp x)
32064 (mysin-complex x))
32065 ((< x 0)
32066 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32067 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32068
32069 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32070 (cond ((>= x 7)
32071 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32072 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32073 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32074 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32075 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32076 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32077 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32078 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32079 @end smallexample
32080
32081 @noindent
32082 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32083 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32084 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32085 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32086
32087 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32088 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32089 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32090 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32091 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32092 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32093 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32094 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32095 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32096 that this rule misses.
32097
32098 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32099 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32100 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32101 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32102
32103 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32104 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32105
32106 @noindent
32107 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32108 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32109 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32110 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32111 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32112 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32113 much simpler to use!
32114
32115 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32116 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32117
32118 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32119 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32120 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32121
32122 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32123 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32124 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32125 loaded and initialized for you.
32126
32127 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32128 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32129
32130 @ifinfo
32131 @example
32132
32133 @end example
32134 @end ifinfo
32135 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32136
32137 @noindent
32138 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32139 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32140 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32141 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32142
32143 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32144 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32145 one by one below.
32146
32147 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32148 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32149 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32150 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32151 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32152 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32153
32154 @ifinfo
32155 @example
32156
32157 @end example
32158 @end ifinfo
32159 @subsubsection Error Handling
32160
32161 @noindent
32162 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32163 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32164 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32165 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32166 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32167 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32168
32169 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32170 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32171 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32172 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32173
32174 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32175 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32176 ignored.
32177
32178 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32179 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32180 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32181
32182 @ifinfo
32183 @example
32184
32185 @end example
32186 @end ifinfo
32187 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32188
32189 @noindent
32190 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32191 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32192 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32193 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32194 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32195 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32196
32197 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32198 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32199 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32200
32201 @ifinfo
32202 @example
32203
32204 @end example
32205 @end ifinfo
32206 @subsubsection Default Modes
32207
32208 @noindent
32209 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32210 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32211 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32212 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32213 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32214 mode is used.
32215
32216 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32217 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32218 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32219
32220 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32221 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32222 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32223 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32224 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32225 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32226
32227 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
32228 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
32229 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
32230 of the default of 12.
32231
32232 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
32233 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
32234 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
32235 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
32236 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
32237
32238 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
32239 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
32240 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
32241 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
32242 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
32243 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
32244
32245 @ifinfo
32246 @example
32247
32248 @end example
32249 @end ifinfo
32250 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
32251
32252 @noindent
32253 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
32254 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
32255 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
32256 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
32257 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
32258
32259 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
32260 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
32261 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
32262 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
32263 structure.
32264
32265 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
32266 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
32267 an error if that object is not a constant).
32268
32269 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
32270 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
32271 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
32272 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
32273 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
32274 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
32275
32276 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
32277 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
32278 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
32279 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
32280
32281 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
32282 to format it as a string.
32283
32284 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
32285 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
32286 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
32287
32288 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
32289 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
32290 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
32291
32292 @ifinfo
32293 @example
32294
32295 @end example
32296 @end ifinfo
32297 @subsubsection Predicates
32298
32299 @noindent
32300 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
32301 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
32302 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
32303 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
32304
32305 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
32306 one value is less than another.
32307
32308 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
32309 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
32310 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
32311 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
32312 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
32313
32314 @ifinfo
32315 @example
32316
32317 @end example
32318 @end ifinfo
32319 @subsubsection Variable Values
32320
32321 @noindent
32322 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
32323 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
32324 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
32325 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
32326 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
32327 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
32328 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
32329
32330 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
32331 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
32332 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
32333 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
32334 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
32335 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
32336
32337 @example
32338 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
32339 @end example
32340
32341 @ifinfo
32342 @example
32343
32344 @end example
32345 @end ifinfo
32346 @subsubsection Stack Access
32347
32348 @noindent
32349 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
32350 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
32351 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
32352 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
32353 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
32354 usual way).
32355
32356 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
32357 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
32358 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
32359 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
32360 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
32361 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
32362 the stack.
32363
32364 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
32365 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
32366 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
32367 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
32368 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
32369
32370 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
32371 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
32372 as a string.
32373
32374 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
32375 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
32376 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
32377 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
32378 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
32379 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
32380
32381 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
32382 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
32383 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
32384
32385 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @samp{*Calculator*}
32386 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
32387 the stack buffer if necessary.
32388
32389 @ifinfo
32390 @example
32391
32392 @end example
32393 @end ifinfo
32394 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
32395
32396 @noindent
32397 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
32398 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
32399 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
32400 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
32401 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
32402 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
32403 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
32404
32405 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
32406 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
32407 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
32408 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
32409 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
32410
32411 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
32412 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
32413 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
32414
32415 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
32416
32417 @ifinfo
32418 @example
32419
32420 @end example
32421 @end ifinfo
32422 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
32423
32424 @noindent
32425 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
32426 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
32427 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
32428 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
32429 @code{calc-eval}.
32430
32431 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
32432 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
32433 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
32434 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
32435
32436 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
32437 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
32438 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
32439 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
32440 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
32441 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
32442 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
32443 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
32444 your original buffer when it is done.
32445
32446 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
32447 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
32448
32449 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
32450 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
32451
32452 @ifinfo
32453 @example
32454
32455 @end example
32456 @end ifinfo
32457 @subsubsection Example
32458
32459 @noindent
32460 @findex convert-temp
32461 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
32462 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
32463 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
32464 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
32465 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
32466 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
32467 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
32468
32469 @example
32470 (defun convert-temp ()
32471 (interactive)
32472 (save-excursion
32473 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
32474 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
32475 (bot1 (match-end 1))
32476 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
32477 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
32478 (bot2 (match-end 2))
32479 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
32480 (if (equal type "F")
32481 (setq type "C"
32482 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
32483 (setq type "F"
32484 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
32485 (goto-char top2)
32486 (delete-region top2 bot2)
32487 (insert-before-markers type)
32488 (goto-char top1)
32489 (delete-region top1 bot1)
32490 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
32491 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
32492 (insert number))))
32493 @end example
32494
32495 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
32496 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
32497 instead of after it.
32498
32499 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
32500 @subsection Calculator Internals
32501
32502 @noindent
32503 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
32504 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
32505 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
32506 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
32507 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
32508 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
32509 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
32510 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
32511
32512 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
32513 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
32514 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
32515 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
32516 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
32517 in the remaining component files.
32518
32519 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
32520 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
32521 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
32522 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
32523 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
32524 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
32525 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
32526 prove this file will already be loaded.
32527
32528 @menu
32529 * Data Type Formats::
32530 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
32531 * Stack Lisp Functions::
32532 * Predicates::
32533 * Computational Lisp Functions::
32534 * Vector Lisp Functions::
32535 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
32536 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
32537 * Hooks::
32538 @end menu
32539
32540 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
32541 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
32542
32543 @noindent
32544 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
32545 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
32546 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
32547 which is not a Lisp list.
32548
32549 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
32550 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for positive integers 1000000 or more, or
32551 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative integers
32552 @mathit{-1000000} or less. Each @var{d} is a base-1000 ``digit,'' a Lisp integer
32553 from 0 to 999. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
32554 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
32555 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} is stored as @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
32556
32557 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
32558 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
32559 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
32560 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
32561 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
32562 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
32563
32564 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
32565 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
32566 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
32567 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
32568 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
32569 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
32570
32571 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
32572 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
32573 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
32574 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
32575 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
32576 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
32577 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
32578 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
32579 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
32580 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
32581
32582 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
32583 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
32584 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
32585 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
32586 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
32587
32588 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
32589 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
32590 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
32591 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
32592 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
32593 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
32594 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
32595 negative real number.)
32596
32597 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
32598 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
32599 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
32600 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
32601 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
32602
32603 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
32604 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
32605 January 1, 1 AD. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
32606 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
32607
32608 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
32609 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
32610 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
32611
32612 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
32613 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
32614 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
32615 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
32616 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
32617 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
32618
32619 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
32620 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
32621 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
32622 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
32623 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
32624 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
32625 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
32626 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
32627 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
32628 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
32629
32630 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
32631 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
32632 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
32633 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
32634 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
32635 generally unused by Calc data structures.
32636
32637 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
32638 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
32639 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
32640 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
32641 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
32642 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
32643 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
32644 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
32645 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
32646 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
32647 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
32648 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
32649 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
32650 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
32651 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
32652 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
32653 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
32654 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
32655 the variable is used.
32656
32657 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
32658 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
32659 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
32660 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
32661 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
32662 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
32663 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
32664 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
32665 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
32666 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
32667 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
32668 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
32669 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
32670 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
32671 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
32672 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
32673 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
32674 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
32675 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
32676
32677 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
32678 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
32679
32680 @noindent
32681 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
32682 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
32683 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
32684 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
32685
32686 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
32687 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
32688 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
32689 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
32690 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
32691 @end defun
32692
32693 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
32694 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
32695 remove it from that list.
32696 @end defun
32697
32698 @defun calc-record-undo rec
32699 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
32700 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
32701 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
32702 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
32703 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
32704 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
32705 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
32706 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
32707 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
32708 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
32709 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
32710 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
32711 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
32712 @end defun
32713
32714 @defun calc-record-why msg args
32715 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
32716 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
32717 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
32718 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
32719 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
32720 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
32721 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
32722 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
32723 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
32724 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
32725 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
32726 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
32727 @end defun
32728
32729 @defun calc-is-inverse
32730 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
32731 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
32732 @end defun
32733
32734 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
32735 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
32736 @end defun
32737
32738 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
32739 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
32740
32741 @noindent
32742 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
32743 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
32744
32745 @defun calc-push-list vals n
32746 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
32747 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
32748 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
32749 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
32750 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
32751 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
32752 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
32753 is an empty list, nothing happens.
32754
32755 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
32756 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
32757 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
32758 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
32759 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
32760 @end defun
32761
32762 @defun calc-top-list n m
32763 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
32764 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
32765 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
32766 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
32767 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
32768 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
32769 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
32770 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
32771 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
32772 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
32773
32774 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
32775 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
32776 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
32777 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
32778 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
32779 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
32780 ``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
32781 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
32782 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
32783 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
32784 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
32785 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
32786 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
32787 @end defun
32788
32789 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
32790 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
32791 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
32792 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
32793
32794 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
32795 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
32796 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
32797 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
32798 contain selections.
32799 @end defun
32800
32801 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
32802 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
32803 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
32804 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
32805 will be used.
32806 @end defun
32807
32808 @defun calc-normalize n
32809 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
32810 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
32811 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
32812 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
32813 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
32814 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
32815 @end defun
32816
32817 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
32818 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
32819 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
32820 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
32821 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
32822 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
32823 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
32824 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
32825 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
32826 @code{calc-top-list}.
32827 @end defun
32828
32829 @defun calc-top-n m
32830 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
32831 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
32832 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
32833 @end defun
32834
32835 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
32836 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
32837 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
32838 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
32839 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
32840 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
32841 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
32842
32843 @smallexample
32844 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
32845 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
32846 @end smallexample
32847
32848 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
32849 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
32850 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
32851 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
32852 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
32853 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
32854 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
32855 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
32856 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
32857 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
32858 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
32859 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
32860 are present.
32861 @end defun
32862
32863 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
32864 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
32865 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
32866 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
32867 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
32868 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
32869
32870 @smallexample
32871 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
32872 (interactive "P")
32873 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
32874 @end smallexample
32875 @end defun
32876
32877 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
32878 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
32879 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
32880 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
32881 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
32882 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
32883 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
32884 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
32885 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
32886 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
32887 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
32888 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
32889 top element.
32890 @end defun
32891
32892 @defun calc-stack-size
32893 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
32894 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
32895 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
32896 @end defun
32897
32898 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
32899 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
32900 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
32901 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
32902 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
32903 line number, not the stack entry itself.
32904 @end defun
32905
32906 @defun calc-substack-height n
32907 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
32908 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
32909 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
32910 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
32911 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
32912 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
32913 entries.)
32914 @end defun
32915
32916 @defun calc-refresh
32917 Erase the @code{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
32918 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
32919 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
32920 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
32921 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
32922 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
32923 @end defun
32924
32925 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
32926 @subsubsection Predicates
32927
32928 @noindent
32929 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
32930 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
32931 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
32932 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
32933 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
32934 the full range of Calc data types.
32935
32936 @defun zerop x
32937 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
32938 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
32939 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
32940 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
32941 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
32942 @end defun
32943
32944 @defun negp x
32945 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
32946 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
32947 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
32948 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
32949 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
32950 @end defun
32951
32952 @defun posp x
32953 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
32954 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
32955 @end defun
32956
32957 @defun looks-negp x
32958 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
32959 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
32960 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
32961 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
32962 @end defun
32963
32964 @defun integerp x
32965 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
32966 @end defun
32967
32968 @defun fixnump x
32969 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
32970 @end defun
32971
32972 @defun natnump x
32973 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
32974 @end defun
32975
32976 @defun fixnatnump x
32977 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
32978 @end defun
32979
32980 @defun num-integerp x
32981 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
32982 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
32983 the decimal point.
32984 @end defun
32985
32986 @defun messy-integerp x
32987 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
32988 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
32989 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
32990 @end defun
32991
32992 @defun num-natnump x
32993 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
32994 @end defun
32995
32996 @defun evenp x
32997 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
32998 @end defun
32999
33000 @defun looks-evenp x
33001 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33002 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33003 @end defun
33004
33005 @defun oddp x
33006 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33007 @end defun
33008
33009 @defun ratp x
33010 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33011 fraction.
33012 @end defun
33013
33014 @defun realp x
33015 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33016 or floating-point number.
33017 @end defun
33018
33019 @defun anglep x
33020 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33021 @end defun
33022
33023 @defun floatp x
33024 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33025 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33026 is a float.
33027 @end defun
33028
33029 @defun complexp x
33030 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33031 (but not a real number).
33032 @end defun
33033
33034 @defun rect-complexp x
33035 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33036 @end defun
33037
33038 @defun polar-complexp x
33039 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33040 @end defun
33041
33042 @defun numberp x
33043 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33044 @end defun
33045
33046 @defun scalarp x
33047 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33048 @end defun
33049
33050 @defun vectorp x
33051 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33052 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33053 @end defun
33054
33055 @defun numvecp x
33056 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33057 @end defun
33058
33059 @defun matrixp x
33060 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33061 all of the same size.
33062 @end defun
33063
33064 @defun square-matrixp x
33065 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33066 @end defun
33067
33068 @defun objectp x
33069 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33070 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33071 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33072 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33073 @end defun
33074
33075 @defun objvecp x
33076 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33077 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33078 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33079 @end defun
33080
33081 @defun primp x
33082 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33083 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33084 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33085 and intervals.
33086 @end defun
33087
33088 @defun constp x
33089 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33090 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33091 components are @code{constp}.
33092 @end defun
33093
33094 @defun lessp x y
33095 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33096 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33097 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33098 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33099 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33100 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33101 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33102 @end defun
33103
33104 @defun beforep x y
33105 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33106 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33107 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33108 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33109 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33110 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33111 by @kbd{a s} to put the terms of a product into canonical order:
33112 This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to @samp{2 x y}.
33113 @end defun
33114
33115 @defun equal x y
33116 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33117 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33118 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33119 0 and 0.0 as different.
33120 @end defun
33121
33122 @defun math-equal x y
33123 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33124 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33125 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33126 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33127 @end defun
33128
33129 @defun equal-int x n
33130 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33131 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33132 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33133 whenever possible.
33134 @end defun
33135
33136 @defun nearly-equal x y
33137 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33138 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33139 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33140 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33141 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33142 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33143 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33144 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33145 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33146 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33147 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33148 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33149 @end defun
33150
33151 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33152 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33153 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33154 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33155 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33156 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33157 @var{y} must be real.
33158 @end defun
33159
33160 @defun is-true x
33161 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33162 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33163 or a provably non-zero formula.
33164 @end defun
33165
33166 @defun reject-arg val pred
33167 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33168 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33169 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33170 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33171 @end defun
33172
33173 @defun inexact-value
33174 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33175 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33176 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33177 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33178 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33179 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33180 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33181 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33182 @end defun
33183
33184 @defun overflow
33185 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33186 @end defun
33187
33188 @defun underflow
33189 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33190 @end defun
33191
33192 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33193 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33194
33195 @noindent
33196 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33197 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33198 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33199 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33200 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33201 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33202 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33203
33204 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33205 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33206 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33207 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33208 respectively, instead.
33209
33210 @defun normalize val
33211 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33212 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33213 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33214 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33215 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33216 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33217 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33218 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33219 return 6.
33220
33221 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33222 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
33223 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
33224 the formula still in symbolic form.
33225
33226 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
33227 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
33228 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
33229 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
33230 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
33231 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
33232 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
33233 on the stack.
33234 @end defun
33235
33236 @defun evaluate-expr expr
33237 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
33238 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
33239 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
33240 @end defun
33241
33242 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
33243 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
33244 digits. This is a macro which expands to
33245
33246 @smallexample
33247 (math-normalize
33248 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
33249 @var{body}))
33250 @end smallexample
33251
33252 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
33253 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
33254 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
33255 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
33256 @end defmac
33257
33258 @defun make-frac n d
33259 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
33260 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
33261 @end defun
33262
33263 @defun make-float mant exp
33264 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
33265 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
33266 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
33267 if @var{exp} is out of range.
33268 @end defun
33269
33270 @defun make-sdev x sigma
33271 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
33272 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
33273 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
33274 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
33275 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33276 @end defun
33277
33278 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
33279 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
33280 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
33281 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
33282 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
33283 @end defun
33284
33285 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
33286 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
33287 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
33288 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
33289 @end defun
33290
33291 @defun make-mod n m
33292 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
33293 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
33294 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
33295 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
33296 @end defun
33297
33298 @defun float x
33299 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
33300 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
33301 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33302 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
33303 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
33304 @end defun
33305
33306 @defun compare x y
33307 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
33308 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
33309 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
33310 undefined or cannot be determined.
33311 @end defun
33312
33313 @defun numdigs n
33314 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
33315 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
33316 considered to have zero digits.
33317 @end defun
33318
33319 @defun scale-int x n
33320 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
33321 digits with truncation toward zero.
33322 @end defun
33323
33324 @defun scale-rounding x n
33325 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
33326 integer rather than truncating.
33327 @end defun
33328
33329 @defun fixnum n
33330 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
33331 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
33332 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
33333 @end defun
33334
33335 @defun sqr x
33336 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
33337 @end defun
33338
33339 @defun quotient x y
33340 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
33341 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
33342 direction of rounding is undefined.
33343 @end defun
33344
33345 @defun idiv x y
33346 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
33347 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
33348 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
33349 slower than for @code{quotient}.
33350 @end defun
33351
33352 @defun imod x y
33353 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
33354 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
33355 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
33356 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
33357 @end defun
33358
33359 @defun idivmod x y
33360 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
33361 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
33362 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
33363 @end defun
33364
33365 @defun pow x y
33366 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
33367 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
33368 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
33369 @end defun
33370
33371 @defun abs-approx x
33372 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
33373 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
33374 the absolute values of the components.
33375 @end defun
33376
33377 @findex e
33378 @findex gamma-const
33379 @findex ln-2
33380 @findex ln-10
33381 @findex phi
33382 @findex pi-over-2
33383 @findex pi-over-4
33384 @findex pi-over-180
33385 @findex sqrt-two-pi
33386 @findex sqrt-e
33387 @findex two-pi
33388 @defun pi
33389 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
33390 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
33391 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
33392 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
33393 @code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
33394 current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
33395 first are essentially free.
33396 @end defun
33397
33398 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
33399 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
33400 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
33401 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
33402 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
33403 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
33404 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
33405 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
33406 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
33407 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
33408 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
33409 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
33410 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
33411 @end defmac
33412
33413 @findex half-circle
33414 @findex quarter-circle
33415 @defun full-circle symb
33416 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
33417 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
33418 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
33419 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
33420 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
33421 @end defun
33422
33423 @defun power-of-2 n
33424 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
33425 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
33426 particular @var{n} is expensive.
33427 @end defun
33428
33429 @defun integer-log2 n
33430 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
33431 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
33432 return @code{nil}.
33433 @end defun
33434
33435 @defun div-mod a b m
33436 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
33437 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
33438 @end defun
33439
33440 @defun pow-mod a b m
33441 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
33442 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
33443 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
33444 @end defun
33445
33446 @defun isqrt n
33447 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
33448 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
33449 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
33450 @end defun
33451
33452 @defun to-hms a ang
33453 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
33454 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
33455 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
33456 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
33457 @end defun
33458
33459 @defun from-hms a ang
33460 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
33461 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
33462 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
33463 is returned as-is.
33464 @end defun
33465
33466 @defun to-radians a
33467 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
33468 angular mode.
33469 @end defun
33470
33471 @defun from-radians a
33472 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
33473 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
33474 @end defun
33475
33476 @defun to-radians-2 a
33477 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
33478 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
33479 @end defun
33480
33481 @defun from-radians-2 a
33482 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
33483 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
33484 @end defun
33485
33486 @defun random-digit
33487 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
33488 @end defun
33489
33490 @defun random-digits n
33491 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
33492 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
33493 @end defun
33494
33495 @defun random-float
33496 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
33497 @end defun
33498
33499 @defun prime-test n iters
33500 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
33501 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
33502 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
33503 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
33504 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
33505 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
33506 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
33507 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
33508 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
33509 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
33510 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
33511 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
33512 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
33513 @end defun
33514
33515 @defun to-simple-fraction f
33516 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
33517 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
33518 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
33519 fast.
33520 @end defun
33521
33522 @defun to-fraction f tol
33523 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
33524 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
33525 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
33526 @end defun
33527
33528 @defun quarter-integer n
33529 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
33530 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
33531 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
33532 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
33533 returns @code{nil}.
33534 @end defun
33535
33536 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
33537 @subsubsection Vector Functions
33538
33539 @noindent
33540 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
33541 matrices.
33542
33543 @defun math-concat x y
33544 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
33545 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
33546 @end defun
33547
33548 @defun vec-length v
33549 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
33550 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
33551 rows in the matrix.
33552 @end defun
33553
33554 @defun mat-dimens m
33555 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
33556 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
33557 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
33558 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
33559 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
33560 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
33561 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
33562 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
33563 elements.
33564 @end defun
33565
33566 @defun dimension-error
33567 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
33568 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
33569 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
33570 @end defun
33571
33572 @defun build-vector args
33573 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
33574 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
33575 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
33576 @end defun
33577
33578 @defun make-vec obj dims
33579 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
33580 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
33581 filled with 27's.
33582 @end defun
33583
33584 @defun row-matrix v
33585 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
33586 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
33587 leave it alone.
33588 @end defun
33589
33590 @defun col-matrix v
33591 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
33592 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
33593 already a matrix, leave it alone.
33594 @end defun
33595
33596 @defun map-vec f v
33597 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
33598 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
33599 of vector @var{v}.
33600 @end defun
33601
33602 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
33603 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
33604 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
33605 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
33606 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
33607 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
33608 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
33609 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
33610 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
33611 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
33612 @end defun
33613
33614 @defun reduce-vec f v
33615 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
33616 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
33617 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
33618 @end defun
33619
33620 @defun reduce-cols f m
33621 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
33622 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
33623 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
33624 @end defun
33625
33626 @defun mat-row m n
33627 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
33628 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
33629 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
33630 @end defun
33631
33632 @defun mat-col m n
33633 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
33634 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
33635 @end defun
33636
33637 @defun mat-less-row m n
33638 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
33639 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
33640 @end defun
33641
33642 @defun mat-less-col m n
33643 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
33644 @end defun
33645
33646 @defun transpose m
33647 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
33648 @end defun
33649
33650 @defun flatten-vector v
33651 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
33652 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
33653 @end defun
33654
33655 @defun copy-matrix m
33656 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
33657 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
33658 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
33659 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
33660 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
33661 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
33662 @end defun
33663
33664 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
33665 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
33666 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
33667 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
33668 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
33669 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
33670 @var{m}.
33671 @end defun
33672
33673 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
33674 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
33675
33676 @noindent
33677 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
33678 Calculator.
33679
33680 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
33681 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
33682 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
33683 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
33684 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
33685 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
33686 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
33687 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
33688 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
33689 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
33690 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
33691 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
33692 their corresponding sub-formulas.
33693
33694 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
33695 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
33696 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
33697 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
33698 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
33699 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
33700 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
33701 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
33702 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
33703 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
33704 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
33705 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
33706 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
33707 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
33708 @end defun
33709
33710 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
33711 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
33712 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
33713 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
33714 the formula in-place.
33715 @end defun
33716
33717 @defun calc-find-selected-part
33718 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
33719 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
33720 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
33721 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
33722 @end defun
33723
33724 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
33725 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
33726 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
33727 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
33728 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
33729 to reflect the new selection.
33730 @end defun
33731
33732 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
33733 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
33734 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
33735 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
33736 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
33737 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
33738 @end defun
33739
33740 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
33741 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
33742 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
33743 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
33744 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
33745 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
33746 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
33747 This function does not take associativity into account.
33748 @end defun
33749
33750 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
33751 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
33752 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
33753 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
33754 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
33755 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
33756 return the whole expression.
33757 @end defun
33758
33759 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
33760 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
33761 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
33762 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
33763 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
33764 @end defun
33765
33766 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
33767 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
33768 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
33769 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
33770 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
33771 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
33772 function does not take associativity into account.
33773 @end defun
33774
33775 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
33776 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
33777 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
33778 @end defun
33779
33780 @defun simplify expr
33781 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying various algebraic rules.
33782 This is what the @w{@kbd{a s}} (@code{calc-simplify}) command uses. This
33783 always returns a copy of the expression; the structure @var{expr} points
33784 to remains unchanged in memory.
33785
33786 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
33787 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
33788 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
33789 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
33790 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
33791 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
33792 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
33793 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
33794 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
33795 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
33796 needed:@: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
33797 further simplifications were possible.
33798 @end defun
33799
33800 @defun simplify-extended expr
33801 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
33802 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
33803 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
33804 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
33805 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
33806 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
33807 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
33808 before taking any action.
33809 @end defun
33810
33811 @defun simplify-units expr
33812 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
33813 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
33814 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
33815 @end defun
33816
33817 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
33818 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
33819 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
33820 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
33821 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
33822 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
33823 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
33824 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
33825 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
33826 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
33827 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
33828 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
33829 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
33830 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
33831
33832 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
33833 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
33834 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
33835 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
33836 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
33837
33838 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
33839 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
33840 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
33841 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
33842
33843 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
33844 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
33845 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
33846 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
33847 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
33848
33849 @smallexample
33850 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
33851 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
33852 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
33853 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
33854 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
33855 (or math-living-dangerously
33856 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
33857 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
33858 @end smallexample
33859
33860 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
33861 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
33862 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
33863 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
33864 @end defmac
33865
33866 @defun common-constant-factor expr
33867 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
33868 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
33869 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
33870 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
33871 @end defun
33872
33873 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
33874 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
33875 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
33876 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
33877 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
33878 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
33879 square roots:
33880
33881 @smallexample
33882 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
33883 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
33884 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
33885 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
33886 (math-normalize
33887 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
33888 (math-cancel-common-factor
33889 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
33890 @end smallexample
33891 @end defun
33892
33893 @defun frac-gcd a b
33894 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
33895 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
33896 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
33897 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
33898 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
33899 @end defun
33900
33901 @defun map-tree func expr many
33902 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
33903 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
33904 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
33905 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
33906 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
33907 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
33908 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
33909 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
33910 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
33911 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
33912 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
33913 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
33914 @end defun
33915
33916 @defun compile-rewrites rules
33917 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
33918 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
33919 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
33920 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
33921 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
33922 message.
33923 @end defun
33924
33925 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
33926 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
33927 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
33928 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
33929 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
33930 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
33931 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
33932 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
33933 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
33934 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
33935 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
33936 @end defun
33937
33938 @defun rewrite-heads expr
33939 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
33940 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
33941 @end defun
33942
33943 @defun rewrite expr rules many
33944 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
33945 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
33946 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
33947 times.
33948 @end defun
33949
33950 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
33951 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
33952 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
33953 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
33954 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
33955 @end defun
33956
33957 @defun deriv expr var value symb
33958 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
33959 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
33960 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
33961 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
33962 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
33963 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
33964 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of undifferentiable
33965 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
33966 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
33967
33968 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
33969 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
33970 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
33971 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
33972 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
33973 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
33974 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
33975 is defined by
33976
33977 @smallexample
33978 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
33979 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
33980 @end smallexample
33981
33982 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
33983 @smallexample
33984 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
33985 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
33986 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
33987 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
33988 @end smallexample
33989 @end defun
33990
33991 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
33992 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
33993 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
33994 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
33995 @end defun
33996
33997 @defun integ expr var low high
33998 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
33999 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34000 @end defun
34001
34002 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34003 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34004 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34005 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34006 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34007 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34008 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34009 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34010 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34011 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34012 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34013
34014 @smallexample
34015 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34016 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34017 (and int
34018 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34019
34020 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34021 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34022 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34023 @end smallexample
34024
34025 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34026 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34027 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34028 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34029 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34030 result.
34031 @end defmac
34032
34033 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34034 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34035 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34036 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34037 @var{v}.
34038 @end defmac
34039
34040 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34041 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34042 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34043 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34044 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34045 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34046 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34047 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34048 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34049 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34050 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34051
34052 @smallexample
34053 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34054 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34055 @end smallexample
34056
34057 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34058 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34059 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34060 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34061 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34062 @end defun
34063
34064 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34065 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34066 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34067 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34068 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34069 @end defun
34070
34071 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34072 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34073 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34074 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34075 @end defun
34076
34077 @defun expr-contains expr var
34078 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34079 of @var{expr}.
34080
34081 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34082 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34083 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34084 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34085 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34086 @code{eq} to each other.
34087 @end defun
34088
34089 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34090 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34091 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34092 @end defun
34093
34094 @defun expr-depends expr var
34095 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34096 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34097 in common.
34098 @end defun
34099
34100 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34101 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34102 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34103 @end defun
34104
34105 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34106 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34107 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34108 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34109 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34110 @end defun
34111
34112 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34113 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34114 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34115 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34116 are ignored.
34117 @end defun
34118
34119 @defun expr-weight expr
34120 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34121 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34122 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34123 @end defun
34124
34125 @defun expr-height expr
34126 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34127 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34128 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34129 @end defun
34130
34131 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34132 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34133 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34134 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34135 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34136 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34137 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34138 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34139 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34140 a polynomial of degree 0.
34141 @end defun
34142
34143 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34144 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34145 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34146 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34147 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34148 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34149 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34150 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34151 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34152 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34153 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34154 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34155 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34156 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34157 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34158 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34159 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34160 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34161 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34162 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34163 @end defun
34164
34165 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34166 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34167 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34168 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34169 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34170 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34171 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34172 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34173 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34174 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34175 is found.
34176 @end defun
34177
34178 @defun poly-simplify poly
34179 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34180 clipping off trailing zeros.
34181 @end defun
34182
34183 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34184 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34185 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34186 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34187 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34188 @end defun
34189
34190 @defun poly-mul a b
34191 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34192 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34193 @end defun
34194
34195 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34196 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34197 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34198 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34199 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34200 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34201 @end defun
34202
34203 @defun check-unit-name var
34204 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34205 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34206 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34207 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34208 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34209 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34210 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34211 @end defun
34212
34213 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34214 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34215 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34216 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34217 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34218 @end defun
34219
34220 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34221 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34222 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34223 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
34224 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
34225 @end defun
34226
34227 @defun to-standard-units expr which
34228 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
34229 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
34230 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
34231 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
34232 is an expression to substitute for it.
34233 @end defun
34234
34235 @defun remove-units expr
34236 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
34237 This expression is generally normalized before use.
34238 @end defun
34239
34240 @defun extract-units expr
34241 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
34242 by ones.
34243 @end defun
34244
34245 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
34246 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
34247
34248 @noindent
34249 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
34250 Calc numbers and formulas.
34251
34252 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
34253 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
34254 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
34255 @end defun
34256
34257 @defun read-number str
34258 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
34259 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
34260 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
34261 @end defun
34262
34263 @defun read-expr str
34264 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
34265 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
34266 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
34267 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
34268 a string describing the problem.
34269 @end defun
34270
34271 @defun read-exprs str
34272 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
34273 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
34274 shown above is returned instead.
34275 @end defun
34276
34277 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
34278 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
34279 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
34280 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
34281 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
34282 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
34283 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
34284 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
34285 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
34286 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
34287 @code{calc-normalize} first.
34288
34289 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
34290 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
34291 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
34292 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
34293 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
34294 that actually appeared in the input.
34295 @end defun
34296
34297 @defun format-number a
34298 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
34299 @end defun
34300
34301 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
34302 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
34303 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
34304 This is a simple format designed
34305 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
34306 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
34307 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
34308 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
34309 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
34310 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
34311 @end defun
34312
34313 @defun format-nice-expr a width
34314 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
34315 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
34316 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
34317 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
34318 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
34319 @end defun
34320
34321 @defun format-value a width
34322 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
34323 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
34324 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
34325 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
34326 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
34327 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
34328 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
34329 window is used.
34330 @end defun
34331
34332 @defun compose-expr a prec
34333 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
34334 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
34335 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
34336 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
34337 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
34338 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
34339 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
34340 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
34341 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
34342 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
34343 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
34344 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
34345 normal function-call notation for that language.
34346 @end defun
34347
34348 @defun composition-to-string c w
34349 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
34350 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
34351 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
34352 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
34353 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
34354 @end defun
34355
34356 @defun comp-width c
34357 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
34358 @end defun
34359
34360 @defun comp-height c
34361 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
34362 @end defun
34363
34364 @defun comp-ascent c
34365 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
34366 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
34367 @end defun
34368
34369 @defun comp-descent c
34370 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
34371 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
34372 @end defun
34373
34374 @defun comp-first-char c
34375 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
34376 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
34377 return @code{nil}.
34378 @end defun
34379
34380 @defun comp-last-char c
34381 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
34382 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
34383 @end defun
34384
34385 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34386 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
34387 @comment
34388 @comment @noindent
34389 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
34390
34391 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
34392 @subsubsection Hooks
34393
34394 @noindent
34395 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
34396 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
34397 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
34398 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
34399 other customization-related variables are also described here.
34400
34401 @defvar calc-load-hook
34402 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
34403 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
34404 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
34405 @end defvar
34406
34407 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
34408 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
34409 @end defvar
34410
34411 @defvar calc-start-hook
34412 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
34413 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
34414 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
34415 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
34416 @end defvar
34417
34418 @defvar calc-mode-hook
34419 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
34420 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
34421 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
34422 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
34423 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
34424 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
34425 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
34426 been evaluated yet.
34427 @end defvar
34428
34429 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
34430 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
34431 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
34432 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
34433 per Emacs session.
34434 @end defvar
34435
34436 @defvar calc-end-hook
34437 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
34438 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
34439 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
34440 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
34441 @end defvar
34442
34443 @defvar calc-window-hook
34444 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
34445 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
34446 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
34447 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
34448 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
34449 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
34450 @end defvar
34451
34452 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
34453 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
34454 window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
34455 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
34456 must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
34457 @end defvar
34458
34459 @defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
34460 This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
34461 @end defvar
34462
34463 @defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
34464 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
34465 new buffer.
34466 @end defvar
34467
34468 @defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
34469 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
34470 new formula.
34471 @end defvar
34472
34473 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
34474 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
34475 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
34476 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
34477 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
34478 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
34479 @code{calc-edit} command.)
34480 @end defvar
34481
34482 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
34483 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
34484 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
34485 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
34486 message is inserted.
34487 @end defvar
34488
34489 @defvar calc-reset-hook
34490 This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
34491 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
34492 @end defvar
34493
34494 @defvar calc-other-modes
34495 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
34496 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
34497 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
34498 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
34499 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
34500 @end defvar
34501
34502 @defvar calc-mode-map
34503 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
34504 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
34505 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
34506 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
34507 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
34508 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
34509 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
34510 extensions are loaded.
34511 @end defvar
34512
34513 @defvar calc-digit-map
34514 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
34515 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
34516 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
34517 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
34518 @end defvar
34519
34520 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
34521 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
34522 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
34523 @end defvar
34524
34525 @defvar calc-store-var-map
34526 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
34527 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
34528 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
34529 @end defvar
34530
34531 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
34532 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
34533 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
34534 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
34535 @end defvar
34536
34537 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
34538 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
34539 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
34540 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
34541 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
34542 non-default variables are written out.
34543 @end defvar
34544
34545 @defvar calc-local-var-list
34546 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
34547 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
34548 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
34549 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
34550 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
34551 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
34552 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
34553 @end defvar
34554
34555 @node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
34556 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
34557 @include gpl.texi
34558
34559 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
34560 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
34561 @include doclicense.texi
34562
34563 @node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
34564 @appendix Customizing Calc
34565
34566 The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
34567 to use a different prefix, you can put
34568
34569 @example
34570 (global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
34571 @end example
34572
34573 @noindent
34574 in your .emacs file.
34575 (@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
34576 The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
34577 A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
34578 convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
34579 followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
34580 @kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
34581 character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
34582
34583 Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
34584 from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
34585 calculation, and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
34586 customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
34587 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
34588 will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
34589 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
34590 contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
34591 also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
34592 @xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
34593
34594 Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
34595 expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
34596 See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
34597 to see how regular expressions work.
34598
34599 @defvar calc-settings-file
34600 The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
34601 which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
34602 definitions.
34603 If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
34604 @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
34605 @code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
34606 exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
34607
34608 The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
34609 @end defvar
34610
34611 @defvar calc-gnuplot-name
34612 See @ref{Graphics}.@*
34613 The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
34614 GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
34615 system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
34616 variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
34617 to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
34618 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
34619 @end defvar
34620
34621 @defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
34622 @defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
34623 See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
34624 The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
34625 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
34626 display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
34627 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
34628 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
34629 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
34630 to display or print the output.
34631
34632 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
34633 and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
34634 @code{"lp %s"}.
34635 @end defvar
34636
34637 @defvar calc-language-alist
34638 See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
34639 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
34640 Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
34641 enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
34642 determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
34643 Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
34644 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
34645 the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
34646 @code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
34647 activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
34648 to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
34649
34650 The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
34651 @example
34652 ((latex-mode . latex)
34653 (tex-mode . tex)
34654 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
34655 (context-mode . tex)
34656 (nroff-mode . eqn)
34657 (pascal-mode . pascal)
34658 (c-mode . c)
34659 (c++-mode . c)
34660 (fortran-mode . fortran)
34661 (f90-mode . fortran))
34662 @end example
34663 @end defvar
34664
34665 @defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
34666 @defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
34667 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34668 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
34669 what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
34670 regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
34671 @kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
34672 activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
34673 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
34674
34675 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
34676 for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
34677 @samp{%} and a space.
34678
34679 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
34680 set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
34681 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34682 It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
34683 @var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34684 @example
34685 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
34686 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
34687 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
34688 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
34689 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34690 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34691 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
34692 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
34693 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34694 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
34695 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
34696 @end example
34697 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
34698 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
34699 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
34700 @end defvar
34701
34702 @defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
34703 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
34704 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
34705 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34706 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
34707 @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} control the region that Calc will
34708 activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
34709 They are regular expressions;
34710 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
34711 nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
34712 delimiters''.
34713
34714 The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
34715 Embedded mode understands by default are:
34716 @enumerate
34717 @item
34718 The @TeX{} and La@TeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
34719 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
34720 @item
34721 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
34722 @item
34723 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
34724 @item
34725 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
34726 @item
34727 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
34728 @end enumerate
34729
34730 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
34731 set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
34732 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
34733 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34734 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34735 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
34736 @var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34737 @code{nil}.
34738 @end defvar
34739
34740 @defvar calc-embedded-open-word
34741 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-word
34742 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-word-alist
34743 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34744 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-word} and
34745 @code{calc-embedded-close-word} control the region that Calc will
34746 activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * w}. They are
34747 regular expressions.
34748
34749 The default values of @code{calc-embedded-open-word} and
34750 @code{calc-embedded-close-word} are @code{"^\\|[^-+0-9.eE]"} and
34751 @code{"$\\|[^-+0-9.eE]"} respectively.
34752
34753 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-word-alist} is used to
34754 set @code{calc-embedded-open-word} and
34755 @code{calc-embedded-close-word} to different regular
34756 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34757 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34758 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-WORD-REGEXP}
34759 @var{CLOSE-WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
34760 @code{nil}.
34761 @end defvar
34762
34763 @defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
34764 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
34765 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
34766 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34767 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
34768 @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
34769 formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
34770 expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
34771 buffer as well as to recognize them.
34772
34773 The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
34774 @code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
34775 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
34776 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
34777 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
34778
34779 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
34780 set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
34781 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
34782 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34783 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34784 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
34785 @var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
34786 @example
34787 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
34788 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
34789 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
34790 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
34791 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34792 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34793 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
34794 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
34795 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34796 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
34797 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
34798 @end example
34799 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
34800 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
34801 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
34802 @end defvar
34803
34804 @defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
34805 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
34806 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
34807 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34808 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
34809 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
34810 inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
34811
34812 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
34813 @code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
34814 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
34815 this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
34816 file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
34817 also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
34818 if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
34819 typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
34820 closing newline are omitted.)
34821
34822 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
34823 set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
34824 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
34825 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34826 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34827 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
34828 @var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
34829 @code{nil}.
34830 @end defvar
34831
34832 @defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
34833 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
34834 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
34835 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
34836 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
34837 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
34838 and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
34839 these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
34840 necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
34841
34842 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
34843 and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
34844 @code{"\n"}.
34845 If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
34846 idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
34847 lines by themselves.
34848
34849 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
34850 set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
34851 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
34852 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
34853 It consists of a list of lists of the form
34854 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
34855 @var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
34856 @example
34857 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
34858 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
34859 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
34860 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
34861 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
34862 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
34863 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
34864 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
34865 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
34866 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
34867 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
34868 @end example
34869 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
34870 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
34871 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
34872 @end defvar
34873
34874 @defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
34875 The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
34876 whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic formulas
34877 in normal language modes. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence}
34878 is non-@code{nil}, then multiplication has precedence, and so for
34879 example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If
34880 @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{nil}, then
34881 multiplication has the same precedence as division, and so for example
34882 @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
34883 of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
34884 @end defvar
34885
34886 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
34887 @appendix Reporting Bugs
34888
34889 @noindent
34890 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
34891
34892 @example
34893 jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
34894 @end example
34895
34896 @noindent
34897 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
34898 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
34899 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
34900 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
34901 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
34902 regular mailbox.
34903
34904 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
34905 them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
34906 features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
34907 them right in.
34908
34909 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
34910 future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
34911 to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
34912 so any efforts can be coordinated.
34913
34914 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
34915 CVS tree. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
34916
34917 @c [summary]
34918 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
34919 @appendix Calc Summary
34920
34921 @noindent
34922 This section includes a complete list of Calc 2.1 keystroke commands.
34923 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
34924 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
34925 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
34926 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
34927 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
34928 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
34929 command name refer to notes at the end.
34930
34931 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
34932 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
34933 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
34934
34935 @iftex
34936 @begingroup
34937 @tex
34938 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
34939 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
34940 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
34941 \leavevmode%
34942 {\smallfonts
34943 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
34944 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
34945 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
34946 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
34947 \thinspace%
34948 {\tt#5}%
34949 {\sl#6}%
34950 }}%
34951 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
34952 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
34953 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
34954 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
34955 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
34956 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
34957 @end tex
34958 @let@:=@sumsep
34959 @let@r=@sumrow
34960 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
34961 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
34962 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
34963 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
34964 @end iftex
34965 @format
34966 @iftex
34967 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
34968 @let@c@sumbreak
34969 @end iftex
34970 @r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
34971 @r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
34972 @r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
34973 @r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
34974 @r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
34975 @r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
34976 @r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
34977 @r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
34978 @r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
34979 @r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
34980 @r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
34981 @r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
34982 @r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
34983 @r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
34984 @r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
34985 @r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
34986 @r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
34987 @r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
34988 @r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
34989 @r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
34990 @r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
34991 @r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
34992 @r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
34993 @r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
34994 @r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
34995 @r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
34996 @r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
34997 @r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
34998
34999 @c
35000 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35001 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35002 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35003 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35004 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35005 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35006 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35007 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35008 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35009
35010 @c
35011 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35012 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35013 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35014
35015 @c
35016 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35017 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35018 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35019 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35020 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35021 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35022 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35023 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35024 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35025 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35026 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35027 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35028 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35029 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35030 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35031 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35032 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35033
35034 @c
35035 @r{ ... a@: @key{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35036 @r{ ... a@: @key{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35037 @r{... a b@: @key{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35038 @r{. a b c@: M-@key{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35039 @r{... a b@: @key{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35040 @r{ ... a@: @key{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35041 @r{... a b@: M-@key{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35042 @r{ @: M-@key{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
35043 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35044
35045 @c
35046 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35047 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35048 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35049 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35050 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35051 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35052 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35053
35054 @c
35055 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35056 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35057 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35058 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35059 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35060 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35061 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35062
35063 @c
35064 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35065 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35066 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35067 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35068 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35069 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35070
35071 @c
35072 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35073 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35074 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35075 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35076 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35077 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35078 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35079
35080 @c
35081 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35082 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35083 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35084 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35085 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35086 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35087 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35088 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35089 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35090 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35091 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35092 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35093 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35094 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35095 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35096 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35097 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35098 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35099 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35100 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35101 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35102 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35103 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35104 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35105 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35106 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35107 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35108 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35109 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35110 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35111 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35112 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35113 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35114 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35115 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35116 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35117 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35118 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35119 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35120 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35121 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35122 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35123 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35124 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35125
35126 @c
35127 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35128 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35129 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35130 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35131 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35132 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35133 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35134 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35135 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35136 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35137 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35138 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
35139 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
35140
35141 @c
35142 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35143 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
35144 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
35145 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
35146
35147 @c
35148 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
35149 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
35150 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
35151 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
35152
35153 @c
35154 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
35155 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
35156 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
35157 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
35158 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
35159 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
35160 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
35161 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
35162 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
35163 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
35164 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
35165 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
35166 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
35167 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
35168 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
35169 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
35170 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
35171 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
35172 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
35173 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
35174
35175 @c
35176 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35177 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35178 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
35179 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
35180 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
35181 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
35182 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
35183 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
35184 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
35185 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
35186 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
35187 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
35188 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
35189 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
35190 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
35191 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
35192 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
35193 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
35194 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
35195
35196 @c
35197 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
35198 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
35199 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
35200 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35201 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
35202 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
35203 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
35204 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
35205 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35206 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
35207 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35208 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
35209 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
35210 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
35211 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
35212
35213 @c
35214 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
35215 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
35216 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
35217 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
35218 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
35219 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
35220 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35221 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
35222 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
35223 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
35224 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
35225 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
35226 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
35227 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
35228 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
35229 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
35230 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35231 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
35232 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
35233 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
35234 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
35235 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
35236 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
35237
35238 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
35239 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
35240 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
35241 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
35242
35243 @c
35244 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35245 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
35246 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
35247 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
35248 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
35249 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
35250 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
35251 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
35252 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
35253 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
35254 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
35255
35256 @c
35257 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
35258 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
35259
35260 @c
35261 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
35262
35263 @c
35264 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
35265 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
35266 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
35267 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
35268 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
35269 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
35270 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
35271 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
35272 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
35273 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
35274 @r{ @: d @key{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
35275 @r{ @: d @key{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
35276
35277 @c
35278 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
35279 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
35280 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
35281 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
35282
35283 @c
35284 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
35285 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
35286 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
35287 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
35288 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
35289 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
35290 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
35291 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
35292 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
35293 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
35294 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
35295 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
35296 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
35297 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
35298 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
35299 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
35300 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
35301 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
35302
35303 @c
35304 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
35305 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
35306 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
35307 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
35308 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
35309 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
35310 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
35311 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
35312 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
35313 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
35314 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
35315 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
35316
35317 @c
35318 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
35319 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
35320
35321 @c
35322 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
35323 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
35324 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
35325 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
35326 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
35327 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
35328 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
35329 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
35330 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
35331 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
35332 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
35333 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
35334
35335 @c
35336 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
35337 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
35338 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
35339 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
35340 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
35341 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
35342 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
35343 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
35344 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
35345 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35346 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
35347 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
35348 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
35349 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35350 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
35351 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
35352 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
35353
35354 @c
35355 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
35356 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
35357 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
35358 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
35359 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
35360 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
35361 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
35362 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
35363 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
35364 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
35365 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
35366 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
35367 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
35368 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
35369 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
35370 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
35371 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
35372 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
35373 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
35374
35375 @c
35376 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
35377 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
35378 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
35379 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
35380 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
35381 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
35382 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
35383 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
35384 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
35385 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
35386 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
35387 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
35388 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
35389 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
35390 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
35391 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
35392
35393 @c
35394 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
35395 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
35396 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
35397
35398 @c
35399 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
35400 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
35401 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
35402 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
35403 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35404 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
35405 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
35406 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35407 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35408 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
35409
35410 @c
35411 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
35412 @r{ @: j @key{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
35413 @r{ @: j @key{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
35414 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
35415 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
35416 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
35417
35418 @c
35419 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
35420 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
35421 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
35422 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
35423 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
35424
35425 @c
35426 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
35427 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
35428 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
35429 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
35430 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
35431 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
35432 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
35433 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
35434 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
35435 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
35436 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
35437 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
35438 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
35439 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
35440
35441 @c
35442 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
35443 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
35444 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
35445 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
35446 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
35447 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
35448 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
35449 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
35450 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
35451 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
35452 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
35453 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
35454
35455 @c
35456 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
35457 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
35458 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
35459 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
35460 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
35461 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
35462 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
35463 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
35464 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
35465 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
35466 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
35467 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
35468 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
35469 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
35470 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
35471 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
35472 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
35473 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
35474 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
35475 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
35476
35477 @c
35478 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
35479 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
35480 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
35481 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
35482 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
35483 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35484 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
35485 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
35486 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
35487 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
35488 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
35489 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
35490 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
35491
35492 @c
35493 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
35494 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
35495 @r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
35496 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
35497 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
35498 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
35499 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
35500 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
35501 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
35502 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
35503 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
35504 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
35505 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
35506 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
35507 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
35508
35509 @c
35510 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
35511 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
35512 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
35513 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
35514 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
35515 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
35516 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
35517 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
35518 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
35519 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
35520 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
35521
35522 @c
35523 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
35524 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
35525 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
35526 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
35527 @r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
35528 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
35529 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
35530 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
35531 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
35532 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
35533 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
35534 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
35535 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
35536 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
35537 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
35538 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
35539 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
35540
35541 @c
35542 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
35543 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
35544 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
35545 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
35546 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
35547 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
35548 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
35549 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
35550 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
35551 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
35552 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
35553 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
35554 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
35555
35556 @c
35557 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
35558 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
35559 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
35560 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
35561 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
35562 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
35563 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
35564 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
35565 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
35566 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
35567 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
35568
35569 @c
35570 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
35571 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
35572 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
35573 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
35574 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
35575
35576 @c
35577 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
35578 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
35579 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
35580 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
35581 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
35582 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
35583 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
35584 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
35585 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
35586 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
35587 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
35588 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
35589 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
35590
35591 @c
35592 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35593 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
35594 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
35595 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
35596 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
35597 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
35598 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
35599 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
35600 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
35601 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
35602 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
35603 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
35604 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
35605 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
35606 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
35607 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
35608 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
35609 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
35610 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
35611
35612 @c
35613 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
35614 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
35615
35616 @c
35617 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
35618 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
35619 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
35620 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
35621 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
35622 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
35623 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
35624 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
35625 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
35626 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
35627 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
35628 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
35629 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
35630 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
35631
35632 @c
35633 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
35634 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
35635 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
35636 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
35637 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
35638 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
35639 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
35640 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
35641 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
35642 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
35643 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
35644 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
35645 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
35646 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
35647 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
35648 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
35649
35650 @c
35651 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
35652 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
35653 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
35654
35655 @c
35656 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
35657 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
35658 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
35659 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
35660 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
35661 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
35662 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
35663 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
35664 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
35665 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
35666
35667 @c
35668 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
35669 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
35670 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
35671 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
35672 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
35673 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
35674
35675 @c
35676 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
35677
35678 @c
35679 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
35680 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
35681 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
35682 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
35683 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35684 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
35685 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
35686 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
35687 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
35688 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
35689 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
35690 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
35691 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
35692 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
35693 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
35694 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
35695 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
35696 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
35697 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
35698 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
35699 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
35700 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
35701 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
35702 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
35703 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
35704 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
35705 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
35706 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
35707 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
35708 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
35709 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
35710 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
35711
35712 @c
35713 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
35714 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
35715 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
35716 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
35717 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
35718 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
35719 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
35720 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
35721 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
35722 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
35723 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
35724 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
35725 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
35726 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
35727 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
35728 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
35729 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
35730 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
35731 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
35732 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
35733 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
35734 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
35735 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
35736 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
35737 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
35738 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
35739 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
35740 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
35741
35742 @c
35743 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
35744
35745 @c
35746 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
35747
35748 @c
35749 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
35750 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
35751 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
35752 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
35753
35754 @c
35755 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
35756 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
35757 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
35758 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
35759 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
35760 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
35761 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
35762
35763 @c
35764 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
35765
35766 @c
35767 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
35768 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
35769 @r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
35770
35771 @c
35772 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
35773 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
35774 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
35775 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
35776 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
35777 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
35778 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
35779 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
35780 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
35781 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
35782 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
35783
35784 @end format
35785
35786 @noindent
35787 NOTES
35788
35789 @enumerate
35790 @c 1
35791 @item
35792 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35793 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
35794 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
35795 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
35796
35797 @c 2
35798 @item
35799 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
35800 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
35801 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
35802
35803 @c 3
35804 @item
35805 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
35806 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
35807 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
35808
35809 @c 4
35810 @item
35811 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
35812
35813 @c 5
35814 @item
35815 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
35816 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
35817
35818 @c 6
35819 @item
35820 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
35821 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
35822
35823 @c 7
35824 @item
35825 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
35826 1=Default, 2=like @kbd{a s}, 3=like @kbd{a e}.
35827
35828 @c 8
35829 @item
35830 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
35831
35832 @c 9
35833 @item
35834 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
35835 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
35836
35837 @c 10
35838 @item
35839 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
35840 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
35841
35842 @c 11
35843 @item
35844 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
35845
35846 @c 12
35847 @item
35848 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
35849 prefix always clears the mode.
35850
35851 @c 13
35852 @item
35853 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
35854
35855 @c 14
35856 @item
35857 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
35858 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
35859 @iftex
35860 {@advance@tableindent10pt
35861 @end iftex
35862 @table @asis
35863 @item Integer
35864 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
35865 @item Float
35866 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
35867 @item 0.0
35868 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
35869 @item Error form
35870 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
35871 @item Interval
35872 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
35873 @item Vector
35874 Random element from the vector.
35875 @end table
35876 @iftex
35877 }
35878 @end iftex
35879
35880 @c 15
35881 @item
35882 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
35883 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
35884
35885 @c 16
35886 @item
35887 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
35888 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
35889
35890 @c 17
35891 @item
35892 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0-6, 0-31, or 0-366).
35893
35894 @c 18
35895 @item
35896 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
35897 the new units.
35898
35899 @c 19
35900 @item
35901 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
35902 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
35903
35904 @c 20
35905 @item
35906 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
35907 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
35908 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
35909 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
35910
35911 @c 21
35912 @item
35913 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
35914 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
35915 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
35916 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
35917
35918 @c 22
35919 @item
35920 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
35921 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
35922 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
35923 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
35924 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
35925 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
35926 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
35927 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
35928 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
35929
35930 @c 23
35931 @item
35932 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
35933 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
35934 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
35935 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
35936 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
35937 or @code{d} for ``down.''
35938
35939 @c 24
35940 @item
35941 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
35942 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
35943 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
35944 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
35945 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
35946 @iftex
35947 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
35948 @end iftex
35949 @table @cite
35950 @item -1
35951 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
35952 @item -2
35953 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
35954 @item -3
35955 (@var{3}) HMS form.
35956 @item -4
35957 (@var{2}) Error form.
35958 @item -5
35959 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
35960 @item -6
35961 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
35962 @item -7
35963 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
35964 @item -8
35965 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
35966 @item -9
35967 (@var{2}) Open interval.
35968 @item -10
35969 (@var{2}) Fraction.
35970 @item -11
35971 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
35972 @item -12
35973 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
35974 @item -13
35975 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
35976 @item -14
35977 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
35978 @item -15
35979 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
35980 @end table
35981 @iftex
35982 }
35983 @end iftex
35984
35985 @c 25
35986 @item
35987 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
35988 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
35989 the input vector.
35990
35991 @c 26
35992 @item
35993 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
35994
35995 @c 27
35996 @item
35997 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
35998
35999 @c 28
36000 @item
36001 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36002
36003 @c 29
36004 @item
36005 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36006
36007 @c 30
36008 @item
36009 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36010 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36011 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36012 of the result of the edit.
36013
36014 @c 31
36015 @item
36016 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36017
36018 @c 32
36019 @item
36020 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36021
36022 @c 33
36023 @item
36024 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36025 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36026
36027 @c 34
36028 @item
36029 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36030 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36031 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36032 backward by that many lines.
36033
36034 @c 35
36035 @item
36036 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36037 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36038 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36039 region between point and mark as a single formula.
36040
36041 @c 36
36042 @item
36043 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36044 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36045 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36046 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36047
36048 @c 37
36049 @item
36050 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36051
36052 @c 38
36053 @item
36054 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36055 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36056
36057 @c 39
36058 @item
36059 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36060 @expr{v - v_0}.
36061
36062 @c 40
36063 @item
36064 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36065 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36066 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36067 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36068 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36069
36070 @c 41
36071 @item
36072 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36073
36074 @c 42
36075 @item
36076 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36077 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36078
36079 @c 43
36080 @item
36081 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36082 value for this graph.
36083
36084 @c 44
36085 @item
36086 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36087
36088 @c 45
36089 @item
36090 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36091 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36092 otherwise.
36093
36094 @c 46
36095 @item
36096 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36097 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36098 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36099 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36100 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36101 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36102 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36103 to evaluate variables.
36104
36105 @c 47
36106 @item
36107 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36108 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
36109 assigns
36110 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
36111 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
36112
36113 @c 48
36114 @item
36115 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
36116 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
36117 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
36118 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
36119 and a vector from the stack.
36120
36121 @c 49
36122 @item
36123 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
36124 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
36125
36126 @c 50
36127 @item
36128 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
36129 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
36130 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
36131
36132 @c 51
36133 @item
36134 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
36135 default 2D resolution.
36136
36137 @c 52
36138 @item
36139 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
36140 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
36141 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
36142 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
36143 @end enumerate
36144
36145 @iftex
36146 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
36147 @page
36148 @endgroup
36149 @end iftex
36150
36151
36152 @c [end-summary]
36153
36154 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
36155 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
36156
36157 @printindex ky
36158
36159 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
36160 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
36161
36162 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
36163 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
36164 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
36165 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
36166
36167 @printindex pg
36168
36169 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
36170 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
36171
36172 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
36173 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
36174 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
36175 @iftex
36176 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
36177 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
36178 @end iftex
36179
36180 @printindex tp
36181
36182 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
36183 @unnumbered Concept Index
36184
36185 @printindex cp
36186
36187 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
36188 @unnumbered Index of Variables
36189
36190 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
36191 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
36192 corresponding Lisp variable.
36193
36194 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
36195 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
36196
36197 @printindex vr
36198
36199 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
36200 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
36201
36202 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
36203 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
36204 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
36205 @samp{math-}.
36206
36207 @printindex fn
36208
36209 @bye
36210
36211
36212 @ignore
36213 arch-tag: 77a71809-fa4d-40be-b2cc-da3e8fb137c0
36214 @end ignore